tm.texi revision 90075
1@c Copyright (C) 1988,1989,1992,1993,1994,1995,1996,1997,1998,1999,2000,2001,2002
2@c Free Software Foundation, Inc.
3@c This is part of the GCC manual.
4@c For copying conditions, see the file gcc.texi.
5
6@node Target Macros
7@chapter Target Description Macros and Functions
8@cindex machine description macros
9@cindex target description macros
10@cindex macros, target description
11@cindex @file{tm.h} macros
12
13In addition to the file @file{@var{machine}.md}, a machine description
14includes a C header file conventionally given the name
15@file{@var{machine}.h} and a C source file named @file{@var{machine}.c}.
16The header file defines numerous macros that convey the information
17about the target machine that does not fit into the scheme of the
18@file{.md} file.  The file @file{tm.h} should be a link to
19@file{@var{machine}.h}.  The header file @file{config.h} includes
20@file{tm.h} and most compiler source files include @file{config.h}.  The
21source file defines a variable @code{targetm}, which is a structure
22containing pointers to functions and data relating to the target
23machine.  @file{@var{machine}.c} should also contain their definitions,
24if they are not defined elsewhere in GCC, and other functions called
25through the macros defined in the @file{.h} file.
26
27@menu
28* Target Structure::    The @code{targetm} variable.
29* Driver::              Controlling how the driver runs the compilation passes.
30* Run-time Target::     Defining @samp{-m} options like @option{-m68000} and @option{-m68020}.
31* Per-Function Data::   Defining data structures for per-function information.
32* Storage Layout::      Defining sizes and alignments of data.
33* Type Layout::         Defining sizes and properties of basic user data types.
34* Escape Sequences::    Defining the value of target character escape sequences
35* Registers::           Naming and describing the hardware registers.
36* Register Classes::    Defining the classes of hardware registers.
37* Stack and Calling::   Defining which way the stack grows and by how much.
38* Varargs::		Defining the varargs macros.
39* Trampolines::         Code set up at run time to enter a nested function.
40* Library Calls::       Controlling how library routines are implicitly called.
41* Addressing Modes::    Defining addressing modes valid for memory operands.
42* Condition Code::      Defining how insns update the condition code.
43* Costs::               Defining relative costs of different operations.
44* Scheduling::          Adjusting the behavior of the instruction scheduler.
45* Sections::            Dividing storage into text, data, and other sections.
46* PIC::			Macros for position independent code.
47* Assembler Format::    Defining how to write insns and pseudo-ops to output.
48* Debugging Info::      Defining the format of debugging output.
49* Cross-compilation::   Handling floating point for cross-compilers.
50* Mode Switching::      Insertion of mode-switching instructions.
51* Target Attributes::   Defining target-specific uses of @code{__attribute__}.
52* Misc::                Everything else.
53@end menu
54
55@node Target Structure
56@section The Global @code{targetm} Variable
57@cindex target hooks
58@cindex target functions
59
60@deftypevar {struct gcc_target} targetm
61The target @file{.c} file must define the global @code{targetm} variable
62which contains pointers to functions and data relating to the target
63machine.  The variable is declared in @file{target.h};
64@file{target-def.h} defines the macro @code{TARGET_INITIALIZER} which is
65used to initialize the variable, and macros for the default initializers
66for elements of the structure.  The @file{.c} file should override those
67macros for which the default definition is inappropriate.  For example:
68@smallexample
69#include "target.h"
70#include "target-def.h"
71
72/* @r{Initialize the GCC target structure.}  */
73
74#undef TARGET_COMP_TYPE_ATTRIBUTES
75#define TARGET_COMP_TYPE_ATTRIBUTES @var{machine}_comp_type_attributes
76
77struct gcc_target targetm = TARGET_INITIALIZER;
78@end smallexample
79@end deftypevar
80
81Where a macro should be defined in the @file{.c} file in this manner to
82form part of the @code{targetm} structure, it is documented below as a
83``Target Hook'' with a prototype.  Many macros will change in future
84from being defined in the @file{.h} file to being part of the
85@code{targetm} structure.
86
87@node Driver
88@section Controlling the Compilation Driver, @file{gcc}
89@cindex driver
90@cindex controlling the compilation driver
91
92@c prevent bad page break with this line
93You can control the compilation driver.
94
95@table @code
96@findex SWITCH_TAKES_ARG
97@item SWITCH_TAKES_ARG (@var{char})
98A C expression which determines whether the option @option{-@var{char}}
99takes arguments.  The value should be the number of arguments that
100option takes--zero, for many options.
101
102By default, this macro is defined as
103@code{DEFAULT_SWITCH_TAKES_ARG}, which handles the standard options
104properly.  You need not define @code{SWITCH_TAKES_ARG} unless you
105wish to add additional options which take arguments.  Any redefinition
106should call @code{DEFAULT_SWITCH_TAKES_ARG} and then check for
107additional options.
108
109@findex WORD_SWITCH_TAKES_ARG
110@item WORD_SWITCH_TAKES_ARG (@var{name})
111A C expression which determines whether the option @option{-@var{name}}
112takes arguments.  The value should be the number of arguments that
113option takes--zero, for many options.  This macro rather than
114@code{SWITCH_TAKES_ARG} is used for multi-character option names.
115
116By default, this macro is defined as
117@code{DEFAULT_WORD_SWITCH_TAKES_ARG}, which handles the standard options
118properly.  You need not define @code{WORD_SWITCH_TAKES_ARG} unless you
119wish to add additional options which take arguments.  Any redefinition
120should call @code{DEFAULT_WORD_SWITCH_TAKES_ARG} and then check for
121additional options.
122
123@findex SWITCH_CURTAILS_COMPILATION
124@item SWITCH_CURTAILS_COMPILATION (@var{char})
125A C expression which determines whether the option @option{-@var{char}}
126stops compilation before the generation of an executable.  The value is
127boolean, nonzero if the option does stop an executable from being
128generated, zero otherwise.
129
130By default, this macro is defined as
131@code{DEFAULT_SWITCH_CURTAILS_COMPILATION}, which handles the standard
132options properly.  You need not define
133@code{SWITCH_CURTAILS_COMPILATION} unless you wish to add additional
134options which affect the generation of an executable.  Any redefinition
135should call @code{DEFAULT_SWITCH_CURTAILS_COMPILATION} and then check
136for additional options.
137
138@findex SWITCHES_NEED_SPACES
139@item SWITCHES_NEED_SPACES
140A string-valued C expression which enumerates the options for which
141the linker needs a space between the option and its argument.
142
143If this macro is not defined, the default value is @code{""}.
144
145@findex TARGET_OPTION_TRANSLATE_TABLE
146@item TARGET_OPTION_TRANSLATE_TABLE
147If defined, a list of pairs of strings, the first of which is a
148potential command line target to the @file{gcc} driver program, and the
149second of which is a space-separated (tabs and other whitespace are not
150supported) list of options with which to replace the first option.  The
151target defining this list is responsible for assuring that the results
152are valid.  Replacement options may not be the @code{--opt} style, they
153must be the @code{-opt} style.  It is the intention of this macro to
154provide a mechanism for substitution that affects the multilibs chosen,
155such as one option that enables many options, some of which select
156multilibs.  Example nonsensical definition, where @code{-malt-abi},
157@code{-EB}, and @code{-mspoo} cause different multilibs to be chosen:
158
159@example
160#define TARGET_OPTION_TRANSLATE_TABLE \
161@{ "-fast",   "-march=fast-foo -malt-abi -I/usr/fast-foo" @}, \
162@{ "-compat", "-EB -malign=4 -mspoo" @}
163@end example
164
165@findex CPP_SPEC
166@item CPP_SPEC
167A C string constant that tells the GCC driver program options to
168pass to CPP@.  It can also specify how to translate options you
169give to GCC into options for GCC to pass to the CPP@.
170
171Do not define this macro if it does not need to do anything.
172
173@findex CPLUSPLUS_CPP_SPEC
174@item CPLUSPLUS_CPP_SPEC
175This macro is just like @code{CPP_SPEC}, but is used for C++, rather
176than C@.  If you do not define this macro, then the value of
177@code{CPP_SPEC} (if any) will be used instead.
178
179@findex NO_BUILTIN_SIZE_TYPE
180@item NO_BUILTIN_SIZE_TYPE
181If this macro is defined, the preprocessor will not define the built-in macro
182@code{__SIZE_TYPE__}.  The macro @code{__SIZE_TYPE__} must then be defined
183by @code{CPP_SPEC} instead.
184
185This should be defined if @code{SIZE_TYPE} depends on target dependent flags
186which are not accessible to the preprocessor.  Otherwise, it should not
187be defined.
188
189@findex NO_BUILTIN_PTRDIFF_TYPE
190@item NO_BUILTIN_PTRDIFF_TYPE
191If this macro is defined, the preprocessor will not define the built-in macro
192@code{__PTRDIFF_TYPE__}.  The macro @code{__PTRDIFF_TYPE__} must then be
193defined by @code{CPP_SPEC} instead.
194
195This should be defined if @code{PTRDIFF_TYPE} depends on target dependent flags
196which are not accessible to the preprocessor.  Otherwise, it should not
197be defined.
198
199@findex NO_BUILTIN_WCHAR_TYPE
200@item NO_BUILTIN_WCHAR_TYPE
201If this macro is defined, the preprocessor will not define the built-in macro
202@code{__WCHAR_TYPE__}.  The macro @code{__WCHAR_TYPE__} must then be
203defined by @code{CPP_SPEC} instead.
204
205This should be defined if @code{WCHAR_TYPE} depends on target dependent flags
206which are not accessible to the preprocessor.  Otherwise, it should not
207be defined.
208
209@findex NO_BUILTIN_WINT_TYPE
210@item NO_BUILTIN_WINT_TYPE
211If this macro is defined, the preprocessor will not define the built-in macro
212@code{__WINT_TYPE__}.  The macro @code{__WINT_TYPE__} must then be
213defined by @code{CPP_SPEC} instead.
214
215This should be defined if @code{WINT_TYPE} depends on target dependent flags
216which are not accessible to the preprocessor.  Otherwise, it should not
217be defined.
218
219@findex SIGNED_CHAR_SPEC
220@item SIGNED_CHAR_SPEC
221A C string constant that tells the GCC driver program options to
222pass to CPP@.  By default, this macro is defined to pass the option
223@option{-D__CHAR_UNSIGNED__} to CPP if @code{char} will be treated as
224@code{unsigned char} by @code{cc1}.
225
226Do not define this macro unless you need to override the default
227definition.
228
229@findex CC1_SPEC
230@item CC1_SPEC
231A C string constant that tells the GCC driver program options to
232pass to @code{cc1}, @code{cc1plus}, @code{f771}, and the other language
233front ends.
234It can also specify how to translate options you give to GCC into options
235for GCC to pass to front ends.
236
237Do not define this macro if it does not need to do anything.
238
239@findex CC1PLUS_SPEC
240@item CC1PLUS_SPEC
241A C string constant that tells the GCC driver program options to
242pass to @code{cc1plus}.  It can also specify how to translate options you
243give to GCC into options for GCC to pass to the @code{cc1plus}.
244
245Do not define this macro if it does not need to do anything.
246Note that everything defined in CC1_SPEC is already passed to
247@code{cc1plus} so there is no need to duplicate the contents of
248CC1_SPEC in CC1PLUS_SPEC@.
249
250@findex ASM_SPEC
251@item ASM_SPEC
252A C string constant that tells the GCC driver program options to
253pass to the assembler.  It can also specify how to translate options
254you give to GCC into options for GCC to pass to the assembler.
255See the file @file{sun3.h} for an example of this.
256
257Do not define this macro if it does not need to do anything.
258
259@findex ASM_FINAL_SPEC
260@item ASM_FINAL_SPEC
261A C string constant that tells the GCC driver program how to
262run any programs which cleanup after the normal assembler.
263Normally, this is not needed.  See the file @file{mips.h} for
264an example of this.
265
266Do not define this macro if it does not need to do anything.
267
268@findex LINK_SPEC
269@item LINK_SPEC
270A C string constant that tells the GCC driver program options to
271pass to the linker.  It can also specify how to translate options you
272give to GCC into options for GCC to pass to the linker.
273
274Do not define this macro if it does not need to do anything.
275
276@findex LIB_SPEC
277@item LIB_SPEC
278Another C string constant used much like @code{LINK_SPEC}.  The difference
279between the two is that @code{LIB_SPEC} is used at the end of the
280command given to the linker.
281
282If this macro is not defined, a default is provided that
283loads the standard C library from the usual place.  See @file{gcc.c}.
284
285@findex LIBGCC_SPEC
286@item LIBGCC_SPEC
287Another C string constant that tells the GCC driver program
288how and when to place a reference to @file{libgcc.a} into the
289linker command line.  This constant is placed both before and after
290the value of @code{LIB_SPEC}.
291
292If this macro is not defined, the GCC driver provides a default that
293passes the string @option{-lgcc} to the linker.
294
295@findex STARTFILE_SPEC
296@item STARTFILE_SPEC
297Another C string constant used much like @code{LINK_SPEC}.  The
298difference between the two is that @code{STARTFILE_SPEC} is used at
299the very beginning of the command given to the linker.
300
301If this macro is not defined, a default is provided that loads the
302standard C startup file from the usual place.  See @file{gcc.c}.
303
304@findex ENDFILE_SPEC
305@item ENDFILE_SPEC
306Another C string constant used much like @code{LINK_SPEC}.  The
307difference between the two is that @code{ENDFILE_SPEC} is used at
308the very end of the command given to the linker.
309
310Do not define this macro if it does not need to do anything.
311
312@findex THREAD_MODEL_SPEC
313@item THREAD_MODEL_SPEC
314GCC @code{-v} will print the thread model GCC was configured to use.
315However, this doesn't work on platforms that are multilibbed on thread
316models, such as AIX 4.3.  On such platforms, define
317@code{THREAD_MODEL_SPEC} such that it evaluates to a string without
318blanks that names one of the recognized thread models.  @code{%*}, the
319default value of this macro, will expand to the value of
320@code{thread_file} set in @file{config.gcc}.
321
322@findex EXTRA_SPECS
323@item EXTRA_SPECS
324Define this macro to provide additional specifications to put in the
325@file{specs} file that can be used in various specifications like
326@code{CC1_SPEC}.
327
328The definition should be an initializer for an array of structures,
329containing a string constant, that defines the specification name, and a
330string constant that provides the specification.
331
332Do not define this macro if it does not need to do anything.
333
334@code{EXTRA_SPECS} is useful when an architecture contains several
335related targets, which have various @code{@dots{}_SPECS} which are similar
336to each other, and the maintainer would like one central place to keep
337these definitions.
338
339For example, the PowerPC System V.4 targets use @code{EXTRA_SPECS} to
340define either @code{_CALL_SYSV} when the System V calling sequence is
341used or @code{_CALL_AIX} when the older AIX-based calling sequence is
342used.
343
344The @file{config/rs6000/rs6000.h} target file defines:
345
346@example
347#define EXTRA_SPECS \
348  @{ "cpp_sysv_default", CPP_SYSV_DEFAULT @},
349
350#define CPP_SYS_DEFAULT ""
351@end example
352
353The @file{config/rs6000/sysv.h} target file defines:
354@smallexample
355#undef CPP_SPEC
356#define CPP_SPEC \
357"%@{posix: -D_POSIX_SOURCE @} \
358%@{mcall-sysv: -D_CALL_SYSV @} %@{mcall-aix: -D_CALL_AIX @} \
359%@{!mcall-sysv: %@{!mcall-aix: %(cpp_sysv_default) @}@} \
360%@{msoft-float: -D_SOFT_FLOAT@} %@{mcpu=403: -D_SOFT_FLOAT@}"
361
362#undef CPP_SYSV_DEFAULT
363#define CPP_SYSV_DEFAULT "-D_CALL_SYSV"
364@end smallexample
365
366while the @file{config/rs6000/eabiaix.h} target file defines
367@code{CPP_SYSV_DEFAULT} as:
368
369@smallexample
370#undef CPP_SYSV_DEFAULT
371#define CPP_SYSV_DEFAULT "-D_CALL_AIX"
372@end smallexample
373
374@findex LINK_LIBGCC_SPECIAL
375@item LINK_LIBGCC_SPECIAL
376Define this macro if the driver program should find the library
377@file{libgcc.a} itself and should not pass @option{-L} options to the
378linker.  If you do not define this macro, the driver program will pass
379the argument @option{-lgcc} to tell the linker to do the search and will
380pass @option{-L} options to it.
381
382@findex LINK_LIBGCC_SPECIAL_1
383@item LINK_LIBGCC_SPECIAL_1
384Define this macro if the driver program should find the library
385@file{libgcc.a}.  If you do not define this macro, the driver program will pass
386the argument @option{-lgcc} to tell the linker to do the search.
387This macro is similar to @code{LINK_LIBGCC_SPECIAL}, except that it does
388not affect @option{-L} options.
389
390@findex LINK_COMMAND_SPEC
391@item LINK_COMMAND_SPEC
392A C string constant giving the complete command line need to execute the
393linker.  When you do this, you will need to update your port each time a
394change is made to the link command line within @file{gcc.c}.  Therefore,
395define this macro only if you need to completely redefine the command
396line for invoking the linker and there is no other way to accomplish
397the effect you need.
398
399@findex LINK_ELIMINATE_DUPLICATE_LDIRECTORIES
400@item LINK_ELIMINATE_DUPLICATE_LDIRECTORIES
401A nonzero value causes @command{collect2} to remove duplicate @option{-L@var{directory}} search
402directories from linking commands.  Do not give it a nonzero value if
403removing duplicate search directories changes the linker's semantics.
404
405@findex MULTILIB_DEFAULTS
406@item MULTILIB_DEFAULTS
407Define this macro as a C expression for the initializer of an array of
408string to tell the driver program which options are defaults for this
409target and thus do not need to be handled specially when using
410@code{MULTILIB_OPTIONS}.
411
412Do not define this macro if @code{MULTILIB_OPTIONS} is not defined in
413the target makefile fragment or if none of the options listed in
414@code{MULTILIB_OPTIONS} are set by default.
415@xref{Target Fragment}.
416
417@findex RELATIVE_PREFIX_NOT_LINKDIR
418@item RELATIVE_PREFIX_NOT_LINKDIR
419Define this macro to tell @code{gcc} that it should only translate
420a @option{-B} prefix into a @option{-L} linker option if the prefix
421indicates an absolute file name.
422
423@findex STANDARD_EXEC_PREFIX
424@item STANDARD_EXEC_PREFIX
425Define this macro as a C string constant if you wish to override the
426standard choice of @file{/usr/local/lib/gcc-lib/} as the default prefix to
427try when searching for the executable files of the compiler.
428
429@findex MD_EXEC_PREFIX
430@item MD_EXEC_PREFIX
431If defined, this macro is an additional prefix to try after
432@code{STANDARD_EXEC_PREFIX}.  @code{MD_EXEC_PREFIX} is not searched
433when the @option{-b} option is used, or the compiler is built as a cross
434compiler.  If you define @code{MD_EXEC_PREFIX}, then be sure to add it
435to the list of directories used to find the assembler in @file{configure.in}.
436
437@findex STANDARD_STARTFILE_PREFIX
438@item STANDARD_STARTFILE_PREFIX
439Define this macro as a C string constant if you wish to override the
440standard choice of @file{/usr/local/lib/} as the default prefix to
441try when searching for startup files such as @file{crt0.o}.
442
443@findex MD_STARTFILE_PREFIX
444@item MD_STARTFILE_PREFIX
445If defined, this macro supplies an additional prefix to try after the
446standard prefixes.  @code{MD_EXEC_PREFIX} is not searched when the
447@option{-b} option is used, or when the compiler is built as a cross
448compiler.
449
450@findex MD_STARTFILE_PREFIX_1
451@item MD_STARTFILE_PREFIX_1
452If defined, this macro supplies yet another prefix to try after the
453standard prefixes.  It is not searched when the @option{-b} option is
454used, or when the compiler is built as a cross compiler.
455
456@findex INIT_ENVIRONMENT
457@item INIT_ENVIRONMENT
458Define this macro as a C string constant if you wish to set environment
459variables for programs called by the driver, such as the assembler and
460loader.  The driver passes the value of this macro to @code{putenv} to
461initialize the necessary environment variables.
462
463@findex LOCAL_INCLUDE_DIR
464@item LOCAL_INCLUDE_DIR
465Define this macro as a C string constant if you wish to override the
466standard choice of @file{/usr/local/include} as the default prefix to
467try when searching for local header files.  @code{LOCAL_INCLUDE_DIR}
468comes before @code{SYSTEM_INCLUDE_DIR} in the search order.
469
470Cross compilers do not search either @file{/usr/local/include} or its
471replacement.
472
473@findex MODIFY_TARGET_NAME
474@item MODIFY_TARGET_NAME
475Define this macro if you with to define command-line switches that modify the
476default target name
477
478For each switch, you can include a string to be appended to the first
479part of the configuration name or a string to be deleted from the
480configuration name, if present.  The definition should be an initializer
481for an array of structures.  Each array element should have three
482elements: the switch name (a string constant, including the initial
483dash), one of the enumeration codes @code{ADD} or @code{DELETE} to
484indicate whether the string should be inserted or deleted, and the string
485to be inserted or deleted (a string constant).
486
487For example, on a machine where @samp{64} at the end of the
488configuration name denotes a 64-bit target and you want the @option{-32}
489and @option{-64} switches to select between 32- and 64-bit targets, you would
490code
491
492@smallexample
493#define MODIFY_TARGET_NAME \
494  @{ @{ "-32", DELETE, "64"@}, \
495     @{"-64", ADD, "64"@}@}
496@end smallexample
497
498
499@findex SYSTEM_INCLUDE_DIR
500@item SYSTEM_INCLUDE_DIR
501Define this macro as a C string constant if you wish to specify a
502system-specific directory to search for header files before the standard
503directory.  @code{SYSTEM_INCLUDE_DIR} comes before
504@code{STANDARD_INCLUDE_DIR} in the search order.
505
506Cross compilers do not use this macro and do not search the directory
507specified.
508
509@findex STANDARD_INCLUDE_DIR
510@item STANDARD_INCLUDE_DIR
511Define this macro as a C string constant if you wish to override the
512standard choice of @file{/usr/include} as the default prefix to
513try when searching for header files.
514
515Cross compilers do not use this macro and do not search either
516@file{/usr/include} or its replacement.
517
518@findex STANDARD_INCLUDE_COMPONENT
519@item STANDARD_INCLUDE_COMPONENT
520The ``component'' corresponding to @code{STANDARD_INCLUDE_DIR}.
521See @code{INCLUDE_DEFAULTS}, below, for the description of components.
522If you do not define this macro, no component is used.
523
524@findex INCLUDE_DEFAULTS
525@item INCLUDE_DEFAULTS
526Define this macro if you wish to override the entire default search path
527for include files.  For a native compiler, the default search path
528usually consists of @code{GCC_INCLUDE_DIR}, @code{LOCAL_INCLUDE_DIR},
529@code{SYSTEM_INCLUDE_DIR}, @code{GPLUSPLUS_INCLUDE_DIR}, and
530@code{STANDARD_INCLUDE_DIR}.  In addition, @code{GPLUSPLUS_INCLUDE_DIR}
531and @code{GCC_INCLUDE_DIR} are defined automatically by @file{Makefile},
532and specify private search areas for GCC@.  The directory
533@code{GPLUSPLUS_INCLUDE_DIR} is used only for C++ programs.
534
535The definition should be an initializer for an array of structures.
536Each array element should have four elements: the directory name (a
537string constant), the component name (also a string constant), a flag
538for C++-only directories,
539and a flag showing that the includes in the directory don't need to be
540wrapped in @code{extern @samp{C}} when compiling C++.  Mark the end of
541the array with a null element.
542
543The component name denotes what GNU package the include file is part of,
544if any, in all upper-case letters.  For example, it might be @samp{GCC}
545or @samp{BINUTILS}.  If the package is part of a vendor-supplied
546operating system, code the component name as @samp{0}.
547
548For example, here is the definition used for VAX/VMS:
549
550@example
551#define INCLUDE_DEFAULTS \
552@{                                       \
553  @{ "GNU_GXX_INCLUDE:", "G++", 1, 1@},   \
554  @{ "GNU_CC_INCLUDE:", "GCC", 0, 0@},    \
555  @{ "SYS$SYSROOT:[SYSLIB.]", 0, 0, 0@},  \
556  @{ ".", 0, 0, 0@},                      \
557  @{ 0, 0, 0, 0@}                         \
558@}
559@end example
560@end table
561
562Here is the order of prefixes tried for exec files:
563
564@enumerate
565@item
566Any prefixes specified by the user with @option{-B}.
567
568@item
569The environment variable @code{GCC_EXEC_PREFIX}, if any.
570
571@item
572The directories specified by the environment variable @code{COMPILER_PATH}.
573
574@item
575The macro @code{STANDARD_EXEC_PREFIX}.
576
577@item
578@file{/usr/lib/gcc/}.
579
580@item
581The macro @code{MD_EXEC_PREFIX}, if any.
582@end enumerate
583
584Here is the order of prefixes tried for startfiles:
585
586@enumerate
587@item
588Any prefixes specified by the user with @option{-B}.
589
590@item
591The environment variable @code{GCC_EXEC_PREFIX}, if any.
592
593@item
594The directories specified by the environment variable @code{LIBRARY_PATH}
595(or port-specific name; native only, cross compilers do not use this).
596
597@item
598The macro @code{STANDARD_EXEC_PREFIX}.
599
600@item
601@file{/usr/lib/gcc/}.
602
603@item
604The macro @code{MD_EXEC_PREFIX}, if any.
605
606@item
607The macro @code{MD_STARTFILE_PREFIX}, if any.
608
609@item
610The macro @code{STANDARD_STARTFILE_PREFIX}.
611
612@item
613@file{/lib/}.
614
615@item
616@file{/usr/lib/}.
617@end enumerate
618
619@node Run-time Target
620@section Run-time Target Specification
621@cindex run-time target specification
622@cindex predefined macros
623@cindex target specifications
624
625@c prevent bad page break with this line
626Here are run-time target specifications.
627
628@table @code
629@findex CPP_PREDEFINES
630@item CPP_PREDEFINES
631Define this to be a string constant containing @option{-D} options to
632define the predefined macros that identify this machine and system.
633These macros will be predefined unless the @option{-ansi} option (or a
634@option{-std} option for strict ISO C conformance) is specified.
635
636In addition, a parallel set of macros are predefined, whose names are
637made by appending @samp{__} at the beginning and at the end.  These
638@samp{__} macros are permitted by the ISO standard, so they are
639predefined regardless of whether @option{-ansi} or a @option{-std} option
640is specified.
641
642For example, on the Sun, one can use the following value:
643
644@smallexample
645"-Dmc68000 -Dsun -Dunix"
646@end smallexample
647
648The result is to define the macros @code{__mc68000__}, @code{__sun__}
649and @code{__unix__} unconditionally, and the macros @code{mc68000},
650@code{sun} and @code{unix} provided @option{-ansi} is not specified.
651
652@findex extern int target_flags
653@item extern int target_flags;
654This declaration should be present.
655
656@cindex optional hardware or system features
657@cindex features, optional, in system conventions
658@item TARGET_@dots{}
659This series of macros is to allow compiler command arguments to
660enable or disable the use of optional features of the target machine.
661For example, one machine description serves both the 68000 and
662the 68020; a command argument tells the compiler whether it should
663use 68020-only instructions or not.  This command argument works
664by means of a macro @code{TARGET_68020} that tests a bit in
665@code{target_flags}.
666
667Define a macro @code{TARGET_@var{featurename}} for each such option.
668Its definition should test a bit in @code{target_flags}.  It is
669recommended that a helper macro @code{TARGET_MASK_@var{featurename}}
670is defined for each bit-value to test, and used in
671@code{TARGET_@var{featurename}} and @code{TARGET_SWITCHES}.  For
672example:
673
674@smallexample
675#define TARGET_MASK_68020 1
676#define TARGET_68020 (target_flags & TARGET_MASK_68020)
677@end smallexample
678
679One place where these macros are used is in the condition-expressions
680of instruction patterns.  Note how @code{TARGET_68020} appears
681frequently in the 68000 machine description file, @file{m68k.md}.
682Another place they are used is in the definitions of the other
683macros in the @file{@var{machine}.h} file.
684
685@findex TARGET_SWITCHES
686@item TARGET_SWITCHES
687This macro defines names of command options to set and clear
688bits in @code{target_flags}.  Its definition is an initializer
689with a subgrouping for each command option.
690
691Each subgrouping contains a string constant, that defines the option
692name, a number, which contains the bits to set in
693@code{target_flags}, and a second string which is the description
694displayed by @option{--help}.  If the number is negative then the bits specified
695by the number are cleared instead of being set.  If the description
696string is present but empty, then no help information will be displayed
697for that option, but it will not count as an undocumented option.  The
698actual option name is made by appending @samp{-m} to the specified name.
699Non-empty description strings should be marked with @code{N_(@dots{})} for
700@command{xgettext}.  In addition to the description for @option{--help},
701more detailed documentation for each option should be added to
702@file{invoke.texi}.
703
704One of the subgroupings should have a null string.  The number in
705this grouping is the default value for @code{target_flags}.  Any
706target options act starting with that value.
707
708Here is an example which defines @option{-m68000} and @option{-m68020}
709with opposite meanings, and picks the latter as the default:
710
711@smallexample
712#define TARGET_SWITCHES \
713  @{ @{ "68020", TARGET_MASK_68020, "" @},      \
714    @{ "68000", -TARGET_MASK_68020, \
715      N_("Compile for the 68000") @}, \
716    @{ "", TARGET_MASK_68020, "" @}@}
717@end smallexample
718
719@findex TARGET_OPTIONS
720@item TARGET_OPTIONS
721This macro is similar to @code{TARGET_SWITCHES} but defines names of command
722options that have values.  Its definition is an initializer with a
723subgrouping for each command option.
724
725Each subgrouping contains a string constant, that defines the fixed part
726of the option name, the address of a variable, and a description string
727(which should again be marked with @code{N_(@dots{})}).
728The variable, type @code{char *}, is set to the variable part of the
729given option if the fixed part matches.  The actual option name is made
730by appending @samp{-m} to the specified name.  Again, each option should
731also be documented in @file{invoke.texi}.
732
733Here is an example which defines @option{-mshort-data-@var{number}}.  If the
734given option is @option{-mshort-data-512}, the variable @code{m88k_short_data}
735will be set to the string @code{"512"}.
736
737@smallexample
738extern char *m88k_short_data;
739#define TARGET_OPTIONS \
740 @{ @{ "short-data-", &m88k_short_data, \
741     N_("Specify the size of the short data section") @} @}
742@end smallexample
743
744@findex TARGET_VERSION
745@item TARGET_VERSION
746This macro is a C statement to print on @code{stderr} a string
747describing the particular machine description choice.  Every machine
748description should define @code{TARGET_VERSION}.  For example:
749
750@smallexample
751#ifdef MOTOROLA
752#define TARGET_VERSION \
753  fprintf (stderr, " (68k, Motorola syntax)");
754#else
755#define TARGET_VERSION \
756  fprintf (stderr, " (68k, MIT syntax)");
757#endif
758@end smallexample
759
760@findex OVERRIDE_OPTIONS
761@item OVERRIDE_OPTIONS
762Sometimes certain combinations of command options do not make sense on
763a particular target machine.  You can define a macro
764@code{OVERRIDE_OPTIONS} to take account of this.  This macro, if
765defined, is executed once just after all the command options have been
766parsed.
767
768Don't use this macro to turn on various extra optimizations for
769@option{-O}.  That is what @code{OPTIMIZATION_OPTIONS} is for.
770
771@findex OPTIMIZATION_OPTIONS
772@item OPTIMIZATION_OPTIONS (@var{level}, @var{size})
773Some machines may desire to change what optimizations are performed for
774various optimization levels.   This macro, if defined, is executed once
775just after the optimization level is determined and before the remainder
776of the command options have been parsed.  Values set in this macro are
777used as the default values for the other command line options.
778
779@var{level} is the optimization level specified; 2 if @option{-O2} is
780specified, 1 if @option{-O} is specified, and 0 if neither is specified.
781
782@var{size} is nonzero if @option{-Os} is specified and zero otherwise.
783
784You should not use this macro to change options that are not
785machine-specific.  These should uniformly selected by the same
786optimization level on all supported machines.  Use this macro to enable
787machine-specific optimizations.
788
789@strong{Do not examine @code{write_symbols} in
790this macro!} The debugging options are not supposed to alter the
791generated code.
792
793@findex CAN_DEBUG_WITHOUT_FP
794@item CAN_DEBUG_WITHOUT_FP
795Define this macro if debugging can be performed even without a frame
796pointer.  If this macro is defined, GCC will turn on the
797@option{-fomit-frame-pointer} option whenever @option{-O} is specified.
798@end table
799
800@node Per-Function Data
801@section Defining data structures for per-function information.
802@cindex per-function data
803@cindex data structures
804
805If the target needs to store information on a per-function basis, GCC
806provides a macro and a couple of variables to allow this.  Note, just
807using statics to store the information is a bad idea, since GCC supports
808nested functions, so you can be halfway through encoding one function
809when another one comes along.
810
811GCC defines a data structure called @code{struct function} which
812contains all of the data specific to an individual function.  This
813structure contains a field called @code{machine} whose type is
814@code{struct machine_function *}, which can be used by targets to point
815to their own specific data.
816
817If a target needs per-function specific data it should define the type
818@code{struct machine_function} and also the macro
819@code{INIT_EXPANDERS}.  This macro should be used to initialize some or
820all of the function pointers @code{init_machine_status},
821@code{free_machine_status} and @code{mark_machine_status}.  These
822pointers are explained below.
823
824One typical use of per-function, target specific data is to create an
825RTX to hold the register containing the function's return address.  This
826RTX can then be used to implement the @code{__builtin_return_address}
827function, for level 0.
828
829Note---earlier implementations of GCC used a single data area to hold
830all of the per-function information.  Thus when processing of a nested
831function began the old per-function data had to be pushed onto a
832stack, and when the processing was finished, it had to be popped off the
833stack.  GCC used to provide function pointers called
834@code{save_machine_status} and @code{restore_machine_status} to handle
835the saving and restoring of the target specific information.  Since the
836single data area approach is no longer used, these pointers are no
837longer supported.
838
839The macro and function pointers are described below.
840
841@table @code
842@findex INIT_EXPANDERS
843@item   INIT_EXPANDERS
844Macro called to initialize any target specific information.  This macro
845is called once per function, before generation of any RTL has begun.
846The intention of this macro is to allow the initialization of the
847function pointers below.
848
849@findex init_machine_status
850@item   init_machine_status
851This is a @code{void (*)(struct function *)} function pointer.  If this
852pointer is non-@code{NULL} it will be called once per function, before function
853compilation starts, in order to allow the target to perform any target
854specific initialization of the @code{struct function} structure.  It is
855intended that this would be used to initialize the @code{machine} of
856that structure.
857
858@findex free_machine_status
859@item   free_machine_status
860This is a @code{void (*)(struct function *)} function pointer.  If this
861pointer is non-@code{NULL} it will be called once per function, after the
862function has been compiled, in order to allow any memory allocated
863during the @code{init_machine_status} function call to be freed.
864
865@findex mark_machine_status
866@item   mark_machine_status
867This is a @code{void (*)(struct function *)} function pointer.  If this
868pointer is non-@code{NULL} it will be called once per function in order to mark
869any data items in the @code{struct machine_function} structure which
870need garbage collection.
871
872@end table
873
874@node Storage Layout
875@section Storage Layout
876@cindex storage layout
877
878Note that the definitions of the macros in this table which are sizes or
879alignments measured in bits do not need to be constant.  They can be C
880expressions that refer to static variables, such as the @code{target_flags}.
881@xref{Run-time Target}.
882
883@table @code
884@findex BITS_BIG_ENDIAN
885@item BITS_BIG_ENDIAN
886Define this macro to have the value 1 if the most significant bit in a
887byte has the lowest number; otherwise define it to have the value zero.
888This means that bit-field instructions count from the most significant
889bit.  If the machine has no bit-field instructions, then this must still
890be defined, but it doesn't matter which value it is defined to.  This
891macro need not be a constant.
892
893This macro does not affect the way structure fields are packed into
894bytes or words; that is controlled by @code{BYTES_BIG_ENDIAN}.
895
896@findex BYTES_BIG_ENDIAN
897@item BYTES_BIG_ENDIAN
898Define this macro to have the value 1 if the most significant byte in a
899word has the lowest number.  This macro need not be a constant.
900
901@findex WORDS_BIG_ENDIAN
902@item WORDS_BIG_ENDIAN
903Define this macro to have the value 1 if, in a multiword object, the
904most significant word has the lowest number.  This applies to both
905memory locations and registers; GCC fundamentally assumes that the
906order of words in memory is the same as the order in registers.  This
907macro need not be a constant.
908
909@findex LIBGCC2_WORDS_BIG_ENDIAN
910@item LIBGCC2_WORDS_BIG_ENDIAN
911Define this macro if @code{WORDS_BIG_ENDIAN} is not constant.  This must be a
912constant value with the same meaning as @code{WORDS_BIG_ENDIAN}, which will be
913used only when compiling @file{libgcc2.c}.  Typically the value will be set
914based on preprocessor defines.
915
916@findex FLOAT_WORDS_BIG_ENDIAN
917@item FLOAT_WORDS_BIG_ENDIAN
918Define this macro to have the value 1 if @code{DFmode}, @code{XFmode} or
919@code{TFmode} floating point numbers are stored in memory with the word
920containing the sign bit at the lowest address; otherwise define it to
921have the value 0.  This macro need not be a constant.
922
923You need not define this macro if the ordering is the same as for
924multi-word integers.
925
926@findex BITS_PER_UNIT
927@item BITS_PER_UNIT
928Define this macro to be the number of bits in an addressable storage
929unit (byte); normally 8.
930
931@findex BITS_PER_WORD
932@item BITS_PER_WORD
933Number of bits in a word; normally 32.
934
935@findex MAX_BITS_PER_WORD
936@item MAX_BITS_PER_WORD
937Maximum number of bits in a word.  If this is undefined, the default is
938@code{BITS_PER_WORD}.  Otherwise, it is the constant value that is the
939largest value that @code{BITS_PER_WORD} can have at run-time.
940
941@findex UNITS_PER_WORD
942@item UNITS_PER_WORD
943Number of storage units in a word; normally 4.
944
945@findex MIN_UNITS_PER_WORD
946@item MIN_UNITS_PER_WORD
947Minimum number of units in a word.  If this is undefined, the default is
948@code{UNITS_PER_WORD}.  Otherwise, it is the constant value that is the
949smallest value that @code{UNITS_PER_WORD} can have at run-time.
950
951@findex POINTER_SIZE
952@item POINTER_SIZE
953Width of a pointer, in bits.  You must specify a value no wider than the
954width of @code{Pmode}.  If it is not equal to the width of @code{Pmode},
955you must define @code{POINTERS_EXTEND_UNSIGNED}.
956
957@findex POINTERS_EXTEND_UNSIGNED
958@item POINTERS_EXTEND_UNSIGNED
959A C expression whose value is greater than zero if pointers that need to be
960extended from being @code{POINTER_SIZE} bits wide to @code{Pmode} are to
961be zero-extended and zero if they are to be sign-extended.  If the value
962is less then zero then there must be an "ptr_extend" instruction that
963extends a pointer from @code{POINTER_SIZE} to @code{Pmode}.
964
965You need not define this macro if the @code{POINTER_SIZE} is equal
966to the width of @code{Pmode}.
967
968@findex PROMOTE_MODE
969@item PROMOTE_MODE (@var{m}, @var{unsignedp}, @var{type})
970A macro to update @var{m} and @var{unsignedp} when an object whose type
971is @var{type} and which has the specified mode and signedness is to be
972stored in a register.  This macro is only called when @var{type} is a
973scalar type.
974
975On most RISC machines, which only have operations that operate on a full
976register, define this macro to set @var{m} to @code{word_mode} if
977@var{m} is an integer mode narrower than @code{BITS_PER_WORD}.  In most
978cases, only integer modes should be widened because wider-precision
979floating-point operations are usually more expensive than their narrower
980counterparts.
981
982For most machines, the macro definition does not change @var{unsignedp}.
983However, some machines, have instructions that preferentially handle
984either signed or unsigned quantities of certain modes.  For example, on
985the DEC Alpha, 32-bit loads from memory and 32-bit add instructions
986sign-extend the result to 64 bits.  On such machines, set
987@var{unsignedp} according to which kind of extension is more efficient.
988
989Do not define this macro if it would never modify @var{m}.
990
991@findex PROMOTE_FUNCTION_ARGS
992@item PROMOTE_FUNCTION_ARGS
993Define this macro if the promotion described by @code{PROMOTE_MODE}
994should also be done for outgoing function arguments.
995
996@findex PROMOTE_FUNCTION_RETURN
997@item PROMOTE_FUNCTION_RETURN
998Define this macro if the promotion described by @code{PROMOTE_MODE}
999should also be done for the return value of functions.
1000
1001If this macro is defined, @code{FUNCTION_VALUE} must perform the same
1002promotions done by @code{PROMOTE_MODE}.
1003
1004@findex PROMOTE_FOR_CALL_ONLY
1005@item PROMOTE_FOR_CALL_ONLY
1006Define this macro if the promotion described by @code{PROMOTE_MODE}
1007should @emph{only} be performed for outgoing function arguments or
1008function return values, as specified by @code{PROMOTE_FUNCTION_ARGS}
1009and @code{PROMOTE_FUNCTION_RETURN}, respectively.
1010
1011@findex PARM_BOUNDARY
1012@item PARM_BOUNDARY
1013Normal alignment required for function parameters on the stack, in
1014bits.  All stack parameters receive at least this much alignment
1015regardless of data type.  On most machines, this is the same as the
1016size of an integer.
1017
1018@findex STACK_BOUNDARY
1019@item STACK_BOUNDARY
1020Define this macro to the minimum alignment enforced by hardware for the
1021stack pointer on this machine.  The definition is a C expression for the
1022desired alignment (measured in bits).  This value is used as a default
1023if @code{PREFERRED_STACK_BOUNDARY} is not defined.  On most machines,
1024this should be the same as @code{PARM_BOUNDARY}.
1025
1026@findex PREFERRED_STACK_BOUNDARY
1027@item PREFERRED_STACK_BOUNDARY
1028Define this macro if you wish to preserve a certain alignment for the
1029stack pointer, greater than what the hardware enforces.  The definition
1030is a C expression for the desired alignment (measured in bits).  This
1031macro must evaluate to a value equal to or larger than
1032@code{STACK_BOUNDARY}.
1033
1034@findex FORCE_PREFERRED_STACK_BOUNDARY_IN_MAIN
1035@item FORCE_PREFERRED_STACK_BOUNDARY_IN_MAIN
1036A C expression that evaluates true if @code{PREFERRED_STACK_BOUNDARY} is
1037not guaranteed by the runtime and we should emit code to align the stack
1038at the beginning of @code{main}.
1039
1040@cindex @code{PUSH_ROUNDING}, interaction with @code{PREFERRED_STACK_BOUNDARY}
1041If @code{PUSH_ROUNDING} is not defined, the stack will always be aligned
1042to the specified boundary.  If @code{PUSH_ROUNDING} is defined and specifies
1043a less strict alignment than @code{PREFERRED_STACK_BOUNDARY}, the stack may
1044be momentarily unaligned while pushing arguments.
1045
1046@findex FUNCTION_BOUNDARY
1047@item FUNCTION_BOUNDARY
1048Alignment required for a function entry point, in bits.
1049
1050@findex BIGGEST_ALIGNMENT
1051@item BIGGEST_ALIGNMENT
1052Biggest alignment that any data type can require on this machine, in bits.
1053
1054@findex MINIMUM_ATOMIC_ALIGNMENT
1055@item MINIMUM_ATOMIC_ALIGNMENT
1056If defined, the smallest alignment, in bits, that can be given to an
1057object that can be referenced in one operation, without disturbing any
1058nearby object.  Normally, this is @code{BITS_PER_UNIT}, but may be larger
1059on machines that don't have byte or half-word store operations.
1060
1061@findex BIGGEST_FIELD_ALIGNMENT
1062@item BIGGEST_FIELD_ALIGNMENT
1063Biggest alignment that any structure or union field can require on this
1064machine, in bits.  If defined, this overrides @code{BIGGEST_ALIGNMENT} for
1065structure and union fields only, unless the field alignment has been set
1066by the @code{__attribute__ ((aligned (@var{n})))} construct.
1067
1068@findex ADJUST_FIELD_ALIGN
1069@item ADJUST_FIELD_ALIGN (@var{field}, @var{computed})
1070An expression for the alignment of a structure field @var{field} if the
1071alignment computed in the usual way is @var{computed}.  GCC uses
1072this value instead of the value in @code{BIGGEST_ALIGNMENT} or
1073@code{BIGGEST_FIELD_ALIGNMENT}, if defined.
1074
1075@findex MAX_OFILE_ALIGNMENT
1076@item MAX_OFILE_ALIGNMENT
1077Biggest alignment supported by the object file format of this machine.
1078Use this macro to limit the alignment which can be specified using the
1079@code{__attribute__ ((aligned (@var{n})))} construct.  If not defined,
1080the default value is @code{BIGGEST_ALIGNMENT}.
1081
1082@findex DATA_ALIGNMENT
1083@item DATA_ALIGNMENT (@var{type}, @var{basic-align})
1084If defined, a C expression to compute the alignment for a variable in
1085the static store.  @var{type} is the data type, and @var{basic-align} is
1086the alignment that the object would ordinarily have.  The value of this
1087macro is used instead of that alignment to align the object.
1088
1089If this macro is not defined, then @var{basic-align} is used.
1090
1091@findex strcpy
1092One use of this macro is to increase alignment of medium-size data to
1093make it all fit in fewer cache lines.  Another is to cause character
1094arrays to be word-aligned so that @code{strcpy} calls that copy
1095constants to character arrays can be done inline.
1096
1097@findex CONSTANT_ALIGNMENT
1098@item CONSTANT_ALIGNMENT (@var{constant}, @var{basic-align})
1099If defined, a C expression to compute the alignment given to a constant
1100that is being placed in memory.  @var{constant} is the constant and
1101@var{basic-align} is the alignment that the object would ordinarily
1102have.  The value of this macro is used instead of that alignment to
1103align the object.
1104
1105If this macro is not defined, then @var{basic-align} is used.
1106
1107The typical use of this macro is to increase alignment for string
1108constants to be word aligned so that @code{strcpy} calls that copy
1109constants can be done inline.
1110
1111@findex LOCAL_ALIGNMENT
1112@item LOCAL_ALIGNMENT (@var{type}, @var{basic-align})
1113If defined, a C expression to compute the alignment for a variable in
1114the local store.  @var{type} is the data type, and @var{basic-align} is
1115the alignment that the object would ordinarily have.  The value of this
1116macro is used instead of that alignment to align the object.
1117
1118If this macro is not defined, then @var{basic-align} is used.
1119
1120One use of this macro is to increase alignment of medium-size data to
1121make it all fit in fewer cache lines.
1122
1123@findex EMPTY_FIELD_BOUNDARY
1124@item EMPTY_FIELD_BOUNDARY
1125Alignment in bits to be given to a structure bit-field that follows an
1126empty field such as @code{int : 0;}.
1127
1128Note that @code{PCC_BITFIELD_TYPE_MATTERS} also affects the alignment
1129that results from an empty field.
1130
1131@findex STRUCTURE_SIZE_BOUNDARY
1132@item STRUCTURE_SIZE_BOUNDARY
1133Number of bits which any structure or union's size must be a multiple of.
1134Each structure or union's size is rounded up to a multiple of this.
1135
1136If you do not define this macro, the default is the same as
1137@code{BITS_PER_UNIT}.
1138
1139@findex STRICT_ALIGNMENT
1140@item STRICT_ALIGNMENT
1141Define this macro to be the value 1 if instructions will fail to work
1142if given data not on the nominal alignment.  If instructions will merely
1143go slower in that case, define this macro as 0.
1144
1145@findex PCC_BITFIELD_TYPE_MATTERS
1146@item PCC_BITFIELD_TYPE_MATTERS
1147Define this if you wish to imitate the way many other C compilers handle
1148alignment of bit-fields and the structures that contain them.
1149
1150The behavior is that the type written for a bit-field (@code{int},
1151@code{short}, or other integer type) imposes an alignment for the
1152entire structure, as if the structure really did contain an ordinary
1153field of that type.  In addition, the bit-field is placed within the
1154structure so that it would fit within such a field, not crossing a
1155boundary for it.
1156
1157Thus, on most machines, a bit-field whose type is written as @code{int}
1158would not cross a four-byte boundary, and would force four-byte
1159alignment for the whole structure.  (The alignment used may not be four
1160bytes; it is controlled by the other alignment parameters.)
1161
1162If the macro is defined, its definition should be a C expression;
1163a nonzero value for the expression enables this behavior.
1164
1165Note that if this macro is not defined, or its value is zero, some
1166bit-fields may cross more than one alignment boundary.  The compiler can
1167support such references if there are @samp{insv}, @samp{extv}, and
1168@samp{extzv} insns that can directly reference memory.
1169
1170The other known way of making bit-fields work is to define
1171@code{STRUCTURE_SIZE_BOUNDARY} as large as @code{BIGGEST_ALIGNMENT}.
1172Then every structure can be accessed with fullwords.
1173
1174Unless the machine has bit-field instructions or you define
1175@code{STRUCTURE_SIZE_BOUNDARY} that way, you must define
1176@code{PCC_BITFIELD_TYPE_MATTERS} to have a nonzero value.
1177
1178If your aim is to make GCC use the same conventions for laying out
1179bit-fields as are used by another compiler, here is how to investigate
1180what the other compiler does.  Compile and run this program:
1181
1182@example
1183struct foo1
1184@{
1185  char x;
1186  char :0;
1187  char y;
1188@};
1189
1190struct foo2
1191@{
1192  char x;
1193  int :0;
1194  char y;
1195@};
1196
1197main ()
1198@{
1199  printf ("Size of foo1 is %d\n",
1200          sizeof (struct foo1));
1201  printf ("Size of foo2 is %d\n",
1202          sizeof (struct foo2));
1203  exit (0);
1204@}
1205@end example
1206
1207If this prints 2 and 5, then the compiler's behavior is what you would
1208get from @code{PCC_BITFIELD_TYPE_MATTERS}.
1209
1210@findex BITFIELD_NBYTES_LIMITED
1211@item BITFIELD_NBYTES_LIMITED
1212Like PCC_BITFIELD_TYPE_MATTERS except that its effect is limited to
1213aligning a bit-field within the structure.
1214
1215@findex MEMBER_TYPE_FORCES_BLK
1216@item MEMBER_TYPE_FORCES_BLK (@var{field})
1217Return 1 if a structure or array containing @var{field} should be accessed using
1218@code{BLKMODE}.
1219
1220Normally, this is not needed.  See the file @file{c4x.h} for an example
1221of how to use this macro to prevent a structure having a floating point
1222field from being accessed in an integer mode.
1223
1224@findex ROUND_TYPE_SIZE
1225@item ROUND_TYPE_SIZE (@var{type}, @var{computed}, @var{specified})
1226Define this macro as an expression for the overall size of a type
1227(given by @var{type} as a tree node) when the size computed in the
1228usual way is @var{computed} and the alignment is @var{specified}.
1229
1230The default is to round @var{computed} up to a multiple of @var{specified}.
1231
1232@findex ROUND_TYPE_SIZE_UNIT
1233@item ROUND_TYPE_SIZE_UNIT (@var{type}, @var{computed}, @var{specified})
1234Similar to @code{ROUND_TYPE_SIZE}, but sizes and alignments are
1235specified in units (bytes).  If you define @code{ROUND_TYPE_SIZE},
1236you must also define this macro and they must be defined consistently
1237with each other.
1238
1239@findex ROUND_TYPE_ALIGN
1240@item ROUND_TYPE_ALIGN (@var{type}, @var{computed}, @var{specified})
1241Define this macro as an expression for the alignment of a type (given
1242by @var{type} as a tree node) if the alignment computed in the usual
1243way is @var{computed} and the alignment explicitly specified was
1244@var{specified}.
1245
1246The default is to use @var{specified} if it is larger; otherwise, use
1247the smaller of @var{computed} and @code{BIGGEST_ALIGNMENT}
1248
1249@findex MAX_FIXED_MODE_SIZE
1250@item MAX_FIXED_MODE_SIZE
1251An integer expression for the size in bits of the largest integer
1252machine mode that should actually be used.  All integer machine modes of
1253this size or smaller can be used for structures and unions with the
1254appropriate sizes.  If this macro is undefined, @code{GET_MODE_BITSIZE
1255(DImode)} is assumed.
1256
1257@findex VECTOR_MODE_SUPPORTED_P
1258@item VECTOR_MODE_SUPPORTED_P(@var{mode})
1259Define this macro to be nonzero if the port is prepared to handle insns
1260involving vector mode @var{mode}.  At the very least, it must have move
1261patterns for this mode.
1262
1263@findex STACK_SAVEAREA_MODE
1264@item STACK_SAVEAREA_MODE (@var{save_level})
1265If defined, an expression of type @code{enum machine_mode} that
1266specifies the mode of the save area operand of a
1267@code{save_stack_@var{level}} named pattern (@pxref{Standard Names}).
1268@var{save_level} is one of @code{SAVE_BLOCK}, @code{SAVE_FUNCTION}, or
1269@code{SAVE_NONLOCAL} and selects which of the three named patterns is
1270having its mode specified.
1271
1272You need not define this macro if it always returns @code{Pmode}.  You
1273would most commonly define this macro if the
1274@code{save_stack_@var{level}} patterns need to support both a 32- and a
127564-bit mode.
1276
1277@findex STACK_SIZE_MODE
1278@item STACK_SIZE_MODE
1279If defined, an expression of type @code{enum machine_mode} that
1280specifies the mode of the size increment operand of an
1281@code{allocate_stack} named pattern (@pxref{Standard Names}).
1282
1283You need not define this macro if it always returns @code{word_mode}.
1284You would most commonly define this macro if the @code{allocate_stack}
1285pattern needs to support both a 32- and a 64-bit mode.
1286
1287@findex CHECK_FLOAT_VALUE
1288@item CHECK_FLOAT_VALUE (@var{mode}, @var{value}, @var{overflow})
1289A C statement to validate the value @var{value} (of type
1290@code{double}) for mode @var{mode}.  This means that you check whether
1291@var{value} fits within the possible range of values for mode
1292@var{mode} on this target machine.  The mode @var{mode} is always
1293a mode of class @code{MODE_FLOAT}.  @var{overflow} is nonzero if
1294the value is already known to be out of range.
1295
1296If @var{value} is not valid or if @var{overflow} is nonzero, you should
1297set @var{overflow} to 1 and then assign some valid value to @var{value}.
1298Allowing an invalid value to go through the compiler can produce
1299incorrect assembler code which may even cause Unix assemblers to crash.
1300
1301This macro need not be defined if there is no work for it to do.
1302
1303@findex TARGET_FLOAT_FORMAT
1304@item TARGET_FLOAT_FORMAT
1305A code distinguishing the floating point format of the target machine.
1306There are five defined values:
1307
1308@table @code
1309@findex IEEE_FLOAT_FORMAT
1310@item IEEE_FLOAT_FORMAT
1311This code indicates IEEE floating point.  It is the default; there is no
1312need to define this macro when the format is IEEE@.
1313
1314@findex VAX_FLOAT_FORMAT
1315@item VAX_FLOAT_FORMAT
1316This code indicates the ``D float'' format used on the VAX@.
1317
1318@findex IBM_FLOAT_FORMAT
1319@item IBM_FLOAT_FORMAT
1320This code indicates the format used on the IBM System/370.
1321
1322@findex C4X_FLOAT_FORMAT
1323@item C4X_FLOAT_FORMAT
1324This code indicates the format used on the TMS320C3x/C4x.
1325
1326@findex UNKNOWN_FLOAT_FORMAT
1327@item UNKNOWN_FLOAT_FORMAT
1328This code indicates any other format.
1329@end table
1330
1331The value of this macro is compared with @code{HOST_FLOAT_FORMAT}, which
1332is defined by the @command{configure} script, to determine whether the
1333target machine has the same format as the host machine.  If any other
1334formats are actually in use on supported machines, new codes should be
1335defined for them.
1336
1337The ordering of the component words of floating point values stored in
1338memory is controlled by @code{FLOAT_WORDS_BIG_ENDIAN}.
1339
1340@end table
1341
1342@node Type Layout
1343@section Layout of Source Language Data Types
1344
1345These macros define the sizes and other characteristics of the standard
1346basic data types used in programs being compiled.  Unlike the macros in
1347the previous section, these apply to specific features of C and related
1348languages, rather than to fundamental aspects of storage layout.
1349
1350@table @code
1351@findex INT_TYPE_SIZE
1352@item INT_TYPE_SIZE
1353A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{int} on the
1354target machine.  If you don't define this, the default is one word.
1355
1356@findex SHORT_TYPE_SIZE
1357@item SHORT_TYPE_SIZE
1358A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{short} on the
1359target machine.  If you don't define this, the default is half a word.
1360(If this would be less than one storage unit, it is rounded up to one
1361unit.)
1362
1363@findex LONG_TYPE_SIZE
1364@item LONG_TYPE_SIZE
1365A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{long} on the
1366target machine.  If you don't define this, the default is one word.
1367
1368@findex ADA_LONG_TYPE_SIZE
1369@item ADA_LONG_TYPE_SIZE
1370On some machines, the size used for the Ada equivalent of the type
1371@code{long} by a native Ada compiler differs from that used by C.  In
1372that situation, define this macro to be a C expression to be used for
1373the size of that type.  If you don't define this, the default is the
1374value of @code{LONG_TYPE_SIZE}.
1375
1376@findex MAX_LONG_TYPE_SIZE
1377@item MAX_LONG_TYPE_SIZE
1378Maximum number for the size in bits of the type @code{long} on the
1379target machine.  If this is undefined, the default is
1380@code{LONG_TYPE_SIZE}.  Otherwise, it is the constant value that is the
1381largest value that @code{LONG_TYPE_SIZE} can have at run-time.  This is
1382used in @code{cpp}.
1383
1384@findex LONG_LONG_TYPE_SIZE
1385@item LONG_LONG_TYPE_SIZE
1386A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{long long} on the
1387target machine.  If you don't define this, the default is two
1388words.  If you want to support GNU Ada on your machine, the value of this
1389macro must be at least 64.
1390
1391@findex CHAR_TYPE_SIZE
1392@item CHAR_TYPE_SIZE
1393A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{char} on the
1394target machine.  If you don't define this, the default is
1395@code{BITS_PER_UNIT}.
1396
1397@findex MAX_CHAR_TYPE_SIZE
1398@item MAX_CHAR_TYPE_SIZE
1399Maximum number for the size in bits of the type @code{char} on the
1400target machine.  If this is undefined, the default is
1401@code{CHAR_TYPE_SIZE}.  Otherwise, it is the constant value that is the
1402largest value that @code{CHAR_TYPE_SIZE} can have at run-time.  This is
1403used in @code{cpp}.
1404
1405@findex BOOL_TYPE_SIZE
1406@item BOOL_TYPE_SIZE
1407A C expression for the size in bits of the C++ type @code{bool} on the
1408target machine.  If you don't define this, the default is
1409@code{CHAR_TYPE_SIZE}.
1410
1411@findex FLOAT_TYPE_SIZE
1412@item FLOAT_TYPE_SIZE
1413A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{float} on the
1414target machine.  If you don't define this, the default is one word.
1415
1416@findex DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE
1417@item DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE
1418A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{double} on the
1419target machine.  If you don't define this, the default is two
1420words.
1421
1422@findex LONG_DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE
1423@item LONG_DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE
1424A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{long double} on
1425the target machine.  If you don't define this, the default is two
1426words.
1427
1428@findex MAX_LONG_DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE
1429Maximum number for the size in bits of the type @code{long double} on the
1430target machine.  If this is undefined, the default is
1431@code{LONG_DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE}.  Otherwise, it is the constant value that is
1432the largest value that @code{LONG_DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE} can have at run-time.
1433This is used in @code{cpp}.
1434
1435@findex INTEL_EXTENDED_IEEE_FORMAT
1436Define this macro to be 1 if the target machine uses 80-bit floating-point
1437values with 128-bit size and alignment.  This is used in @file{real.c}.
1438
1439@findex WIDEST_HARDWARE_FP_SIZE
1440@item WIDEST_HARDWARE_FP_SIZE
1441A C expression for the size in bits of the widest floating-point format
1442supported by the hardware.  If you define this macro, you must specify a
1443value less than or equal to the value of @code{LONG_DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE}.
1444If you do not define this macro, the value of @code{LONG_DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE}
1445is the default.
1446
1447@findex DEFAULT_SIGNED_CHAR
1448@item DEFAULT_SIGNED_CHAR
1449An expression whose value is 1 or 0, according to whether the type
1450@code{char} should be signed or unsigned by default.  The user can
1451always override this default with the options @option{-fsigned-char}
1452and @option{-funsigned-char}.
1453
1454@findex DEFAULT_SHORT_ENUMS
1455@item DEFAULT_SHORT_ENUMS
1456A C expression to determine whether to give an @code{enum} type
1457only as many bytes as it takes to represent the range of possible values
1458of that type.  A nonzero value means to do that; a zero value means all
1459@code{enum} types should be allocated like @code{int}.
1460
1461If you don't define the macro, the default is 0.
1462
1463@findex SIZE_TYPE
1464@item SIZE_TYPE
1465A C expression for a string describing the name of the data type to use
1466for size values.  The typedef name @code{size_t} is defined using the
1467contents of the string.
1468
1469The string can contain more than one keyword.  If so, separate them with
1470spaces, and write first any length keyword, then @code{unsigned} if
1471appropriate, and finally @code{int}.  The string must exactly match one
1472of the data type names defined in the function
1473@code{init_decl_processing} in the file @file{c-decl.c}.  You may not
1474omit @code{int} or change the order---that would cause the compiler to
1475crash on startup.
1476
1477If you don't define this macro, the default is @code{"long unsigned
1478int"}.
1479
1480@findex PTRDIFF_TYPE
1481@item PTRDIFF_TYPE
1482A C expression for a string describing the name of the data type to use
1483for the result of subtracting two pointers.  The typedef name
1484@code{ptrdiff_t} is defined using the contents of the string.  See
1485@code{SIZE_TYPE} above for more information.
1486
1487If you don't define this macro, the default is @code{"long int"}.
1488
1489@findex WCHAR_TYPE
1490@item WCHAR_TYPE
1491A C expression for a string describing the name of the data type to use
1492for wide characters.  The typedef name @code{wchar_t} is defined using
1493the contents of the string.  See @code{SIZE_TYPE} above for more
1494information.
1495
1496If you don't define this macro, the default is @code{"int"}.
1497
1498@findex WCHAR_TYPE_SIZE
1499@item WCHAR_TYPE_SIZE
1500A C expression for the size in bits of the data type for wide
1501characters.  This is used in @code{cpp}, which cannot make use of
1502@code{WCHAR_TYPE}.
1503
1504@findex MAX_WCHAR_TYPE_SIZE
1505@item MAX_WCHAR_TYPE_SIZE
1506Maximum number for the size in bits of the data type for wide
1507characters.  If this is undefined, the default is
1508@code{WCHAR_TYPE_SIZE}.  Otherwise, it is the constant value that is the
1509largest value that @code{WCHAR_TYPE_SIZE} can have at run-time.  This is
1510used in @code{cpp}.
1511
1512@findex GCOV_TYPE_SIZE
1513@item GCOV_TYPE_SIZE
1514A C expression for the size in bits of the type used for gcov counters on the
1515target machine.  If you don't define this, the default is one
1516@code{LONG_TYPE_SIZE} in case it is greater or equal to 64-bit and
1517@code{LONG_LONG_TYPE_SIZE} otherwise.  You may want to re-define the type to
1518ensure atomicity for counters in multithreaded programs.
1519
1520@findex WINT_TYPE
1521@item WINT_TYPE
1522A C expression for a string describing the name of the data type to
1523use for wide characters passed to @code{printf} and returned from
1524@code{getwc}.  The typedef name @code{wint_t} is defined using the
1525contents of the string.  See @code{SIZE_TYPE} above for more
1526information.
1527
1528If you don't define this macro, the default is @code{"unsigned int"}.
1529
1530@findex INTMAX_TYPE
1531@item INTMAX_TYPE
1532A C expression for a string describing the name of the data type that
1533can represent any value of any standard or extended signed integer type.
1534The typedef name @code{intmax_t} is defined using the contents of the
1535string.  See @code{SIZE_TYPE} above for more information.
1536
1537If you don't define this macro, the default is the first of
1538@code{"int"}, @code{"long int"}, or @code{"long long int"} that has as
1539much precision as @code{long long int}.
1540
1541@findex UINTMAX_TYPE
1542@item UINTMAX_TYPE
1543A C expression for a string describing the name of the data type that
1544can represent any value of any standard or extended unsigned integer
1545type.  The typedef name @code{uintmax_t} is defined using the contents
1546of the string.  See @code{SIZE_TYPE} above for more information.
1547
1548If you don't define this macro, the default is the first of
1549@code{"unsigned int"}, @code{"long unsigned int"}, or @code{"long long
1550unsigned int"} that has as much precision as @code{long long unsigned
1551int}.
1552
1553@findex TARGET_PTRMEMFUNC_VBIT_LOCATION
1554@item TARGET_PTRMEMFUNC_VBIT_LOCATION
1555The C++ compiler represents a pointer-to-member-function with a struct
1556that looks like:
1557
1558@example
1559  struct @{
1560    union @{
1561      void (*fn)();
1562      ptrdiff_t vtable_index;
1563    @};
1564    ptrdiff_t delta;
1565  @};
1566@end example
1567
1568@noindent
1569The C++ compiler must use one bit to indicate whether the function that
1570will be called through a pointer-to-member-function is virtual.
1571Normally, we assume that the low-order bit of a function pointer must
1572always be zero.  Then, by ensuring that the vtable_index is odd, we can
1573distinguish which variant of the union is in use.  But, on some
1574platforms function pointers can be odd, and so this doesn't work.  In
1575that case, we use the low-order bit of the @code{delta} field, and shift
1576the remainder of the @code{delta} field to the left.
1577
1578GCC will automatically make the right selection about where to store
1579this bit using the @code{FUNCTION_BOUNDARY} setting for your platform.
1580However, some platforms such as ARM/Thumb have @code{FUNCTION_BOUNDARY}
1581set such that functions always start at even addresses, but the lowest
1582bit of pointers to functions indicate whether the function at that
1583address is in ARM or Thumb mode.  If this is the case of your
1584architecture, you should define this macro to
1585@code{ptrmemfunc_vbit_in_delta}.
1586
1587In general, you should not have to define this macro.  On architectures
1588in which function addresses are always even, according to
1589@code{FUNCTION_BOUNDARY}, GCC will automatically define this macro to
1590@code{ptrmemfunc_vbit_in_pfn}.
1591
1592@findex TARGET_VTABLE_USES_DESCRIPTORS
1593@item TARGET_VTABLE_USES_DESCRIPTORS
1594Normally, the C++ compiler uses function pointers in vtables.  This
1595macro allows the target to change to use ``function descriptors'' 
1596instead.  Function descriptors are found on targets for whom a
1597function pointer is actually a small data structure.  Normally the
1598data structure consists of the actual code address plus a data 
1599pointer to which the function's data is relative.
1600
1601If vtables are used, the value of this macro should be the number
1602of words that the function descriptor occupies.
1603@end table
1604
1605@node Escape Sequences
1606@section Target Character Escape Sequences
1607@cindex escape sequences
1608
1609By default, GCC assumes that the C character escape sequences take on
1610their ASCII values for the target.  If this is not correct, you must
1611explicitly define all of the macros below.
1612
1613@table @code
1614@findex TARGET_BELL
1615@item TARGET_BELL
1616A C constant expression for the integer value for escape sequence
1617@samp{\a}.
1618
1619@findex TARGET_ESC
1620@item TARGET_ESC
1621A C constant expression for the integer value of the target escape
1622character.  As an extension, GCC evaluates the escape sequences
1623@samp{\e} and @samp{\E} to this.
1624
1625@findex TARGET_TAB
1626@findex TARGET_BS
1627@findex TARGET_NEWLINE
1628@item TARGET_BS
1629@itemx TARGET_TAB
1630@itemx TARGET_NEWLINE
1631C constant expressions for the integer values for escape sequences
1632@samp{\b}, @samp{\t} and @samp{\n}.
1633
1634@findex TARGET_VT
1635@findex TARGET_FF
1636@findex TARGET_CR
1637@item TARGET_VT
1638@itemx TARGET_FF
1639@itemx TARGET_CR
1640C constant expressions for the integer values for escape sequences
1641@samp{\v}, @samp{\f} and @samp{\r}.
1642@end table
1643
1644@node Registers
1645@section Register Usage
1646@cindex register usage
1647
1648This section explains how to describe what registers the target machine
1649has, and how (in general) they can be used.
1650
1651The description of which registers a specific instruction can use is
1652done with register classes; see @ref{Register Classes}.  For information
1653on using registers to access a stack frame, see @ref{Frame Registers}.
1654For passing values in registers, see @ref{Register Arguments}.
1655For returning values in registers, see @ref{Scalar Return}.
1656
1657@menu
1658* Register Basics::		Number and kinds of registers.
1659* Allocation Order::		Order in which registers are allocated.
1660* Values in Registers::		What kinds of values each reg can hold.
1661* Leaf Functions::		Renumbering registers for leaf functions.
1662* Stack Registers::		Handling a register stack such as 80387.
1663@end menu
1664
1665@node Register Basics
1666@subsection Basic Characteristics of Registers
1667
1668@c prevent bad page break with this line
1669Registers have various characteristics.
1670
1671@table @code
1672@findex FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER
1673@item FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER
1674Number of hardware registers known to the compiler.  They receive
1675numbers 0 through @code{FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER-1}; thus, the first
1676pseudo register's number really is assigned the number
1677@code{FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER}.
1678
1679@item FIXED_REGISTERS
1680@findex FIXED_REGISTERS
1681@cindex fixed register
1682An initializer that says which registers are used for fixed purposes
1683all throughout the compiled code and are therefore not available for
1684general allocation.  These would include the stack pointer, the frame
1685pointer (except on machines where that can be used as a general
1686register when no frame pointer is needed), the program counter on
1687machines where that is considered one of the addressable registers,
1688and any other numbered register with a standard use.
1689
1690This information is expressed as a sequence of numbers, separated by
1691commas and surrounded by braces.  The @var{n}th number is 1 if
1692register @var{n} is fixed, 0 otherwise.
1693
1694The table initialized from this macro, and the table initialized by
1695the following one, may be overridden at run time either automatically,
1696by the actions of the macro @code{CONDITIONAL_REGISTER_USAGE}, or by
1697the user with the command options @option{-ffixed-@var{reg}},
1698@option{-fcall-used-@var{reg}} and @option{-fcall-saved-@var{reg}}.
1699
1700@findex CALL_USED_REGISTERS
1701@item CALL_USED_REGISTERS
1702@cindex call-used register
1703@cindex call-clobbered register
1704@cindex call-saved register
1705Like @code{FIXED_REGISTERS} but has 1 for each register that is
1706clobbered (in general) by function calls as well as for fixed
1707registers.  This macro therefore identifies the registers that are not
1708available for general allocation of values that must live across
1709function calls.
1710
1711If a register has 0 in @code{CALL_USED_REGISTERS}, the compiler
1712automatically saves it on function entry and restores it on function
1713exit, if the register is used within the function.
1714
1715@findex CALL_REALLY_USED_REGISTERS
1716@item CALL_REALLY_USED_REGISTERS
1717@cindex call-used register
1718@cindex call-clobbered register
1719@cindex call-saved register
1720Like @code{CALL_USED_REGISTERS} except this macro doesn't require 
1721that the entire set of @code{FIXED_REGISTERS} be included.  
1722(@code{CALL_USED_REGISTERS} must be a superset of @code{FIXED_REGISTERS}).
1723This macro is optional.  If not specified, it defaults to the value 
1724of @code{CALL_USED_REGISTERS}.
1725
1726@findex HARD_REGNO_CALL_PART_CLOBBERED
1727@item HARD_REGNO_CALL_PART_CLOBBERED (@var{regno}, @var{mode})
1728@cindex call-used register
1729@cindex call-clobbered register
1730@cindex call-saved register
1731A C expression that is nonzero if it is not permissible to store a
1732value of mode @var{mode} in hard register number @var{regno} across a
1733call without some part of it being clobbered.  For most machines this
1734macro need not be defined.  It is only required for machines that do not
1735preserve the entire contents of a register across a call.
1736
1737@findex CONDITIONAL_REGISTER_USAGE
1738@findex fixed_regs
1739@findex call_used_regs
1740@item CONDITIONAL_REGISTER_USAGE
1741Zero or more C statements that may conditionally modify five variables
1742@code{fixed_regs}, @code{call_used_regs}, @code{global_regs},
1743@code{reg_names}, and @code{reg_class_contents}, to take into account
1744any dependence of these register sets on target flags.  The first three
1745of these are of type @code{char []} (interpreted as Boolean vectors).
1746@code{global_regs} is a @code{const char *[]}, and
1747@code{reg_class_contents} is a @code{HARD_REG_SET}.  Before the macro is
1748called, @code{fixed_regs}, @code{call_used_regs},
1749@code{reg_class_contents}, and @code{reg_names} have been initialized
1750from @code{FIXED_REGISTERS}, @code{CALL_USED_REGISTERS},
1751@code{REG_CLASS_CONTENTS}, and @code{REGISTER_NAMES}, respectively.
1752@code{global_regs} has been cleared, and any @option{-ffixed-@var{reg}},
1753@option{-fcall-used-@var{reg}} and @option{-fcall-saved-@var{reg}}
1754command options have been applied.
1755
1756You need not define this macro if it has no work to do.
1757
1758@cindex disabling certain registers
1759@cindex controlling register usage
1760If the usage of an entire class of registers depends on the target
1761flags, you may indicate this to GCC by using this macro to modify
1762@code{fixed_regs} and @code{call_used_regs} to 1 for each of the
1763registers in the classes which should not be used by GCC@.  Also define
1764the macro @code{REG_CLASS_FROM_LETTER} to return @code{NO_REGS} if it
1765is called with a letter for a class that shouldn't be used.
1766
1767(However, if this class is not included in @code{GENERAL_REGS} and all
1768of the insn patterns whose constraints permit this class are
1769controlled by target switches, then GCC will automatically avoid using
1770these registers when the target switches are opposed to them.)
1771
1772@findex NON_SAVING_SETJMP
1773@item NON_SAVING_SETJMP
1774If this macro is defined and has a nonzero value, it means that
1775@code{setjmp} and related functions fail to save the registers, or that
1776@code{longjmp} fails to restore them.  To compensate, the compiler
1777avoids putting variables in registers in functions that use
1778@code{setjmp}.
1779
1780@findex INCOMING_REGNO
1781@item INCOMING_REGNO (@var{out})
1782Define this macro if the target machine has register windows.  This C
1783expression returns the register number as seen by the called function
1784corresponding to the register number @var{out} as seen by the calling
1785function.  Return @var{out} if register number @var{out} is not an
1786outbound register.
1787
1788@findex OUTGOING_REGNO
1789@item OUTGOING_REGNO (@var{in})
1790Define this macro if the target machine has register windows.  This C
1791expression returns the register number as seen by the calling function
1792corresponding to the register number @var{in} as seen by the called
1793function.  Return @var{in} if register number @var{in} is not an inbound
1794register.
1795
1796@findex LOCAL_REGNO
1797@item LOCAL_REGNO (@var{regno})
1798Define this macro if the target machine has register windows.  This C
1799expression returns true if the register is call-saved but is in the
1800register window.  Unlike most call-saved registers, such registers
1801need not be explicitly restored on function exit or during non-local
1802gotos.
1803
1804@ignore
1805@findex PC_REGNUM
1806@item PC_REGNUM
1807If the program counter has a register number, define this as that
1808register number.  Otherwise, do not define it.
1809@end ignore
1810@end table
1811
1812@node Allocation Order
1813@subsection Order of Allocation of Registers
1814@cindex order of register allocation
1815@cindex register allocation order
1816
1817@c prevent bad page break with this line
1818Registers are allocated in order.
1819
1820@table @code
1821@findex REG_ALLOC_ORDER
1822@item REG_ALLOC_ORDER
1823If defined, an initializer for a vector of integers, containing the
1824numbers of hard registers in the order in which GCC should prefer
1825to use them (from most preferred to least).
1826
1827If this macro is not defined, registers are used lowest numbered first
1828(all else being equal).
1829
1830One use of this macro is on machines where the highest numbered
1831registers must always be saved and the save-multiple-registers
1832instruction supports only sequences of consecutive registers.  On such
1833machines, define @code{REG_ALLOC_ORDER} to be an initializer that lists
1834the highest numbered allocable register first.
1835
1836@findex ORDER_REGS_FOR_LOCAL_ALLOC
1837@item ORDER_REGS_FOR_LOCAL_ALLOC
1838A C statement (sans semicolon) to choose the order in which to allocate
1839hard registers for pseudo-registers local to a basic block.
1840
1841Store the desired register order in the array @code{reg_alloc_order}.
1842Element 0 should be the register to allocate first; element 1, the next
1843register; and so on.
1844
1845The macro body should not assume anything about the contents of
1846@code{reg_alloc_order} before execution of the macro.
1847
1848On most machines, it is not necessary to define this macro.
1849@end table
1850
1851@node Values in Registers
1852@subsection How Values Fit in Registers
1853
1854This section discusses the macros that describe which kinds of values
1855(specifically, which machine modes) each register can hold, and how many
1856consecutive registers are needed for a given mode.
1857
1858@table @code
1859@findex HARD_REGNO_NREGS
1860@item HARD_REGNO_NREGS (@var{regno}, @var{mode})
1861A C expression for the number of consecutive hard registers, starting
1862at register number @var{regno}, required to hold a value of mode
1863@var{mode}.
1864
1865On a machine where all registers are exactly one word, a suitable
1866definition of this macro is
1867
1868@smallexample
1869#define HARD_REGNO_NREGS(REGNO, MODE)            \
1870   ((GET_MODE_SIZE (MODE) + UNITS_PER_WORD - 1)  \
1871    / UNITS_PER_WORD)
1872@end smallexample
1873
1874@findex HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK
1875@item HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK (@var{regno}, @var{mode})
1876A C expression that is nonzero if it is permissible to store a value
1877of mode @var{mode} in hard register number @var{regno} (or in several
1878registers starting with that one).  For a machine where all registers
1879are equivalent, a suitable definition is
1880
1881@smallexample
1882#define HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK(REGNO, MODE) 1
1883@end smallexample
1884
1885You need not include code to check for the numbers of fixed registers,
1886because the allocation mechanism considers them to be always occupied.
1887
1888@cindex register pairs
1889On some machines, double-precision values must be kept in even/odd
1890register pairs.  You can implement that by defining this macro to reject
1891odd register numbers for such modes.
1892
1893The minimum requirement for a mode to be OK in a register is that the
1894@samp{mov@var{mode}} instruction pattern support moves between the
1895register and other hard register in the same class and that moving a
1896value into the register and back out not alter it.
1897
1898Since the same instruction used to move @code{word_mode} will work for
1899all narrower integer modes, it is not necessary on any machine for
1900@code{HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK} to distinguish between these modes, provided
1901you define patterns @samp{movhi}, etc., to take advantage of this.  This
1902is useful because of the interaction between @code{HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK}
1903and @code{MODES_TIEABLE_P}; it is very desirable for all integer modes
1904to be tieable.
1905
1906Many machines have special registers for floating point arithmetic.
1907Often people assume that floating point machine modes are allowed only
1908in floating point registers.  This is not true.  Any registers that
1909can hold integers can safely @emph{hold} a floating point machine
1910mode, whether or not floating arithmetic can be done on it in those
1911registers.  Integer move instructions can be used to move the values.
1912
1913On some machines, though, the converse is true: fixed-point machine
1914modes may not go in floating registers.  This is true if the floating
1915registers normalize any value stored in them, because storing a
1916non-floating value there would garble it.  In this case,
1917@code{HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK} should reject fixed-point machine modes in
1918floating registers.  But if the floating registers do not automatically
1919normalize, if you can store any bit pattern in one and retrieve it
1920unchanged without a trap, then any machine mode may go in a floating
1921register, so you can define this macro to say so.
1922
1923The primary significance of special floating registers is rather that
1924they are the registers acceptable in floating point arithmetic
1925instructions.  However, this is of no concern to
1926@code{HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK}.  You handle it by writing the proper
1927constraints for those instructions.
1928
1929On some machines, the floating registers are especially slow to access,
1930so that it is better to store a value in a stack frame than in such a
1931register if floating point arithmetic is not being done.  As long as the
1932floating registers are not in class @code{GENERAL_REGS}, they will not
1933be used unless some pattern's constraint asks for one.
1934
1935@findex MODES_TIEABLE_P
1936@item MODES_TIEABLE_P (@var{mode1}, @var{mode2})
1937A C expression that is nonzero if a value of mode
1938@var{mode1} is accessible in mode @var{mode2} without copying.
1939
1940If @code{HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK (@var{r}, @var{mode1})} and
1941@code{HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK (@var{r}, @var{mode2})} are always the same for
1942any @var{r}, then @code{MODES_TIEABLE_P (@var{mode1}, @var{mode2})}
1943should be nonzero.  If they differ for any @var{r}, you should define
1944this macro to return zero unless some other mechanism ensures the
1945accessibility of the value in a narrower mode.
1946
1947You should define this macro to return nonzero in as many cases as
1948possible since doing so will allow GCC to perform better register
1949allocation.
1950
1951@findex AVOID_CCMODE_COPIES
1952@item AVOID_CCMODE_COPIES
1953Define this macro if the compiler should avoid copies to/from @code{CCmode}
1954registers.  You should only define this macro if support for copying to/from
1955@code{CCmode} is incomplete.
1956@end table
1957
1958@node Leaf Functions
1959@subsection Handling Leaf Functions
1960
1961@cindex leaf functions
1962@cindex functions, leaf
1963On some machines, a leaf function (i.e., one which makes no calls) can run
1964more efficiently if it does not make its own register window.  Often this
1965means it is required to receive its arguments in the registers where they
1966are passed by the caller, instead of the registers where they would
1967normally arrive.
1968
1969The special treatment for leaf functions generally applies only when
1970other conditions are met; for example, often they may use only those
1971registers for its own variables and temporaries.  We use the term ``leaf
1972function'' to mean a function that is suitable for this special
1973handling, so that functions with no calls are not necessarily ``leaf
1974functions''.
1975
1976GCC assigns register numbers before it knows whether the function is
1977suitable for leaf function treatment.  So it needs to renumber the
1978registers in order to output a leaf function.  The following macros
1979accomplish this.
1980
1981@table @code
1982@findex LEAF_REGISTERS
1983@item LEAF_REGISTERS
1984Name of a char vector, indexed by hard register number, which
1985contains 1 for a register that is allowable in a candidate for leaf
1986function treatment.
1987
1988If leaf function treatment involves renumbering the registers, then the
1989registers marked here should be the ones before renumbering---those that
1990GCC would ordinarily allocate.  The registers which will actually be
1991used in the assembler code, after renumbering, should not be marked with 1
1992in this vector.
1993
1994Define this macro only if the target machine offers a way to optimize
1995the treatment of leaf functions.
1996
1997@findex LEAF_REG_REMAP
1998@item LEAF_REG_REMAP (@var{regno})
1999A C expression whose value is the register number to which @var{regno}
2000should be renumbered, when a function is treated as a leaf function.
2001
2002If @var{regno} is a register number which should not appear in a leaf
2003function before renumbering, then the expression should yield @minus{}1, which
2004will cause the compiler to abort.
2005
2006Define this macro only if the target machine offers a way to optimize the
2007treatment of leaf functions, and registers need to be renumbered to do
2008this.
2009@end table
2010
2011@findex current_function_is_leaf
2012@findex current_function_uses_only_leaf_regs
2013@code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_PROLOGUE} and
2014@code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_EPILOGUE} must usually treat leaf functions
2015specially.  They can test the C variable @code{current_function_is_leaf}
2016which is nonzero for leaf functions.  @code{current_function_is_leaf} is
2017set prior to local register allocation and is valid for the remaining
2018compiler passes.  They can also test the C variable
2019@code{current_function_uses_only_leaf_regs} which is nonzero for leaf
2020functions which only use leaf registers.
2021@code{current_function_uses_only_leaf_regs} is valid after reload and is
2022only useful if @code{LEAF_REGISTERS} is defined.
2023@c changed this to fix overfull.  ALSO:  why the "it" at the beginning
2024@c of the next paragraph?!  --mew 2feb93
2025
2026@node Stack Registers
2027@subsection Registers That Form a Stack
2028
2029There are special features to handle computers where some of the
2030``registers'' form a stack, as in the 80387 coprocessor for the 80386.
2031Stack registers are normally written by pushing onto the stack, and are
2032numbered relative to the top of the stack.
2033
2034Currently, GCC can only handle one group of stack-like registers, and
2035they must be consecutively numbered.
2036
2037@table @code
2038@findex STACK_REGS
2039@item STACK_REGS
2040Define this if the machine has any stack-like registers.
2041
2042@findex FIRST_STACK_REG
2043@item FIRST_STACK_REG
2044The number of the first stack-like register.  This one is the top
2045of the stack.
2046
2047@findex LAST_STACK_REG
2048@item LAST_STACK_REG
2049The number of the last stack-like register.  This one is the bottom of
2050the stack.
2051@end table
2052
2053@node Register Classes
2054@section Register Classes
2055@cindex register class definitions
2056@cindex class definitions, register
2057
2058On many machines, the numbered registers are not all equivalent.
2059For example, certain registers may not be allowed for indexed addressing;
2060certain registers may not be allowed in some instructions.  These machine
2061restrictions are described to the compiler using @dfn{register classes}.
2062
2063You define a number of register classes, giving each one a name and saying
2064which of the registers belong to it.  Then you can specify register classes
2065that are allowed as operands to particular instruction patterns.
2066
2067@findex ALL_REGS
2068@findex NO_REGS
2069In general, each register will belong to several classes.  In fact, one
2070class must be named @code{ALL_REGS} and contain all the registers.  Another
2071class must be named @code{NO_REGS} and contain no registers.  Often the
2072union of two classes will be another class; however, this is not required.
2073
2074@findex GENERAL_REGS
2075One of the classes must be named @code{GENERAL_REGS}.  There is nothing
2076terribly special about the name, but the operand constraint letters
2077@samp{r} and @samp{g} specify this class.  If @code{GENERAL_REGS} is
2078the same as @code{ALL_REGS}, just define it as a macro which expands
2079to @code{ALL_REGS}.
2080
2081Order the classes so that if class @var{x} is contained in class @var{y}
2082then @var{x} has a lower class number than @var{y}.
2083
2084The way classes other than @code{GENERAL_REGS} are specified in operand
2085constraints is through machine-dependent operand constraint letters.
2086You can define such letters to correspond to various classes, then use
2087them in operand constraints.
2088
2089You should define a class for the union of two classes whenever some
2090instruction allows both classes.  For example, if an instruction allows
2091either a floating point (coprocessor) register or a general register for a
2092certain operand, you should define a class @code{FLOAT_OR_GENERAL_REGS}
2093which includes both of them.  Otherwise you will get suboptimal code.
2094
2095You must also specify certain redundant information about the register
2096classes: for each class, which classes contain it and which ones are
2097contained in it; for each pair of classes, the largest class contained
2098in their union.
2099
2100When a value occupying several consecutive registers is expected in a
2101certain class, all the registers used must belong to that class.
2102Therefore, register classes cannot be used to enforce a requirement for
2103a register pair to start with an even-numbered register.  The way to
2104specify this requirement is with @code{HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK}.
2105
2106Register classes used for input-operands of bitwise-and or shift
2107instructions have a special requirement: each such class must have, for
2108each fixed-point machine mode, a subclass whose registers can transfer that
2109mode to or from memory.  For example, on some machines, the operations for
2110single-byte values (@code{QImode}) are limited to certain registers.  When
2111this is so, each register class that is used in a bitwise-and or shift
2112instruction must have a subclass consisting of registers from which
2113single-byte values can be loaded or stored.  This is so that
2114@code{PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS} can always have a possible value to return.
2115
2116@table @code
2117@findex enum reg_class
2118@item enum reg_class
2119An enumeral type that must be defined with all the register class names
2120as enumeral values.  @code{NO_REGS} must be first.  @code{ALL_REGS}
2121must be the last register class, followed by one more enumeral value,
2122@code{LIM_REG_CLASSES}, which is not a register class but rather
2123tells how many classes there are.
2124
2125Each register class has a number, which is the value of casting
2126the class name to type @code{int}.  The number serves as an index
2127in many of the tables described below.
2128
2129@findex N_REG_CLASSES
2130@item N_REG_CLASSES
2131The number of distinct register classes, defined as follows:
2132
2133@example
2134#define N_REG_CLASSES (int) LIM_REG_CLASSES
2135@end example
2136
2137@findex REG_CLASS_NAMES
2138@item REG_CLASS_NAMES
2139An initializer containing the names of the register classes as C string
2140constants.  These names are used in writing some of the debugging dumps.
2141
2142@findex REG_CLASS_CONTENTS
2143@item REG_CLASS_CONTENTS
2144An initializer containing the contents of the register classes, as integers
2145which are bit masks.  The @var{n}th integer specifies the contents of class
2146@var{n}.  The way the integer @var{mask} is interpreted is that
2147register @var{r} is in the class if @code{@var{mask} & (1 << @var{r})} is 1.
2148
2149When the machine has more than 32 registers, an integer does not suffice.
2150Then the integers are replaced by sub-initializers, braced groupings containing
2151several integers.  Each sub-initializer must be suitable as an initializer
2152for the type @code{HARD_REG_SET} which is defined in @file{hard-reg-set.h}.
2153In this situation, the first integer in each sub-initializer corresponds to
2154registers 0 through 31, the second integer to registers 32 through 63, and
2155so on.
2156
2157@findex REGNO_REG_CLASS
2158@item REGNO_REG_CLASS (@var{regno})
2159A C expression whose value is a register class containing hard register
2160@var{regno}.  In general there is more than one such class; choose a class
2161which is @dfn{minimal}, meaning that no smaller class also contains the
2162register.
2163
2164@findex BASE_REG_CLASS
2165@item BASE_REG_CLASS
2166A macro whose definition is the name of the class to which a valid
2167base register must belong.  A base register is one used in an address
2168which is the register value plus a displacement.
2169
2170@findex MODE_BASE_REG_CLASS
2171@item MODE_BASE_REG_CLASS (@var{mode})
2172This is a variation of the @code{BASE_REG_CLASS} macro which allows
2173the selection of a base register in a mode depenedent manner.  If
2174@var{mode} is VOIDmode then it should return the same value as
2175@code{BASE_REG_CLASS}.
2176
2177@findex INDEX_REG_CLASS
2178@item INDEX_REG_CLASS
2179A macro whose definition is the name of the class to which a valid
2180index register must belong.  An index register is one used in an
2181address where its value is either multiplied by a scale factor or
2182added to another register (as well as added to a displacement).
2183
2184@findex REG_CLASS_FROM_LETTER
2185@item REG_CLASS_FROM_LETTER (@var{char})
2186A C expression which defines the machine-dependent operand constraint
2187letters for register classes.  If @var{char} is such a letter, the
2188value should be the register class corresponding to it.  Otherwise,
2189the value should be @code{NO_REGS}.  The register letter @samp{r},
2190corresponding to class @code{GENERAL_REGS}, will not be passed
2191to this macro; you do not need to handle it.
2192
2193@findex REGNO_OK_FOR_BASE_P
2194@item REGNO_OK_FOR_BASE_P (@var{num})
2195A C expression which is nonzero if register number @var{num} is
2196suitable for use as a base register in operand addresses.  It may be
2197either a suitable hard register or a pseudo register that has been
2198allocated such a hard register.
2199
2200@findex REGNO_MODE_OK_FOR_BASE_P
2201@item REGNO_MODE_OK_FOR_BASE_P (@var{num}, @var{mode})
2202A C expression that is just like @code{REGNO_OK_FOR_BASE_P}, except that
2203that expression may examine the mode of the memory reference in
2204@var{mode}.  You should define this macro if the mode of the memory
2205reference affects whether a register may be used as a base register.  If
2206you define this macro, the compiler will use it instead of
2207@code{REGNO_OK_FOR_BASE_P}.
2208
2209@findex REGNO_OK_FOR_INDEX_P
2210@item REGNO_OK_FOR_INDEX_P (@var{num})
2211A C expression which is nonzero if register number @var{num} is
2212suitable for use as an index register in operand addresses.  It may be
2213either a suitable hard register or a pseudo register that has been
2214allocated such a hard register.
2215
2216The difference between an index register and a base register is that
2217the index register may be scaled.  If an address involves the sum of
2218two registers, neither one of them scaled, then either one may be
2219labeled the ``base'' and the other the ``index''; but whichever
2220labeling is used must fit the machine's constraints of which registers
2221may serve in each capacity.  The compiler will try both labelings,
2222looking for one that is valid, and will reload one or both registers
2223only if neither labeling works.
2224
2225@findex PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS
2226@item PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS (@var{x}, @var{class})
2227A C expression that places additional restrictions on the register class
2228to use when it is necessary to copy value @var{x} into a register in class
2229@var{class}.  The value is a register class; perhaps @var{class}, or perhaps
2230another, smaller class.  On many machines, the following definition is
2231safe:
2232
2233@example
2234#define PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS(X,CLASS) CLASS
2235@end example
2236
2237Sometimes returning a more restrictive class makes better code.  For
2238example, on the 68000, when @var{x} is an integer constant that is in range
2239for a @samp{moveq} instruction, the value of this macro is always
2240@code{DATA_REGS} as long as @var{class} includes the data registers.
2241Requiring a data register guarantees that a @samp{moveq} will be used.
2242
2243If @var{x} is a @code{const_double}, by returning @code{NO_REGS}
2244you can force @var{x} into a memory constant.  This is useful on
2245certain machines where immediate floating values cannot be loaded into
2246certain kinds of registers.
2247
2248@findex PREFERRED_OUTPUT_RELOAD_CLASS
2249@item PREFERRED_OUTPUT_RELOAD_CLASS (@var{x}, @var{class})
2250Like @code{PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS}, but for output reloads instead of
2251input reloads.  If you don't define this macro, the default is to use
2252@var{class}, unchanged.
2253
2254@findex LIMIT_RELOAD_CLASS
2255@item LIMIT_RELOAD_CLASS (@var{mode}, @var{class})
2256A C expression that places additional restrictions on the register class
2257to use when it is necessary to be able to hold a value of mode
2258@var{mode} in a reload register for which class @var{class} would
2259ordinarily be used.
2260
2261Unlike @code{PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS}, this macro should be used when
2262there are certain modes that simply can't go in certain reload classes.
2263
2264The value is a register class; perhaps @var{class}, or perhaps another,
2265smaller class.
2266
2267Don't define this macro unless the target machine has limitations which
2268require the macro to do something nontrivial.
2269
2270@findex SECONDARY_RELOAD_CLASS
2271@findex SECONDARY_INPUT_RELOAD_CLASS
2272@findex SECONDARY_OUTPUT_RELOAD_CLASS
2273@item SECONDARY_RELOAD_CLASS (@var{class}, @var{mode}, @var{x})
2274@itemx SECONDARY_INPUT_RELOAD_CLASS (@var{class}, @var{mode}, @var{x})
2275@itemx SECONDARY_OUTPUT_RELOAD_CLASS (@var{class}, @var{mode}, @var{x})
2276Many machines have some registers that cannot be copied directly to or
2277from memory or even from other types of registers.  An example is the
2278@samp{MQ} register, which on most machines, can only be copied to or
2279from general registers, but not memory.  Some machines allow copying all
2280registers to and from memory, but require a scratch register for stores
2281to some memory locations (e.g., those with symbolic address on the RT,
2282and those with certain symbolic address on the Sparc when compiling
2283PIC)@.  In some cases, both an intermediate and a scratch register are
2284required.
2285
2286You should define these macros to indicate to the reload phase that it may
2287need to allocate at least one register for a reload in addition to the
2288register to contain the data.  Specifically, if copying @var{x} to a
2289register @var{class} in @var{mode} requires an intermediate register,
2290you should define @code{SECONDARY_INPUT_RELOAD_CLASS} to return the
2291largest register class all of whose registers can be used as
2292intermediate registers or scratch registers.
2293
2294If copying a register @var{class} in @var{mode} to @var{x} requires an
2295intermediate or scratch register, @code{SECONDARY_OUTPUT_RELOAD_CLASS}
2296should be defined to return the largest register class required.  If the
2297requirements for input and output reloads are the same, the macro
2298@code{SECONDARY_RELOAD_CLASS} should be used instead of defining both
2299macros identically.
2300
2301The values returned by these macros are often @code{GENERAL_REGS}.
2302Return @code{NO_REGS} if no spare register is needed; i.e., if @var{x}
2303can be directly copied to or from a register of @var{class} in
2304@var{mode} without requiring a scratch register.  Do not define this
2305macro if it would always return @code{NO_REGS}.
2306
2307If a scratch register is required (either with or without an
2308intermediate register), you should define patterns for
2309@samp{reload_in@var{m}} or @samp{reload_out@var{m}}, as required
2310(@pxref{Standard Names}.  These patterns, which will normally be
2311implemented with a @code{define_expand}, should be similar to the
2312@samp{mov@var{m}} patterns, except that operand 2 is the scratch
2313register.
2314
2315Define constraints for the reload register and scratch register that
2316contain a single register class.  If the original reload register (whose
2317class is @var{class}) can meet the constraint given in the pattern, the
2318value returned by these macros is used for the class of the scratch
2319register.  Otherwise, two additional reload registers are required.
2320Their classes are obtained from the constraints in the insn pattern.
2321
2322@var{x} might be a pseudo-register or a @code{subreg} of a
2323pseudo-register, which could either be in a hard register or in memory.
2324Use @code{true_regnum} to find out; it will return @minus{}1 if the pseudo is
2325in memory and the hard register number if it is in a register.
2326
2327These macros should not be used in the case where a particular class of
2328registers can only be copied to memory and not to another class of
2329registers.  In that case, secondary reload registers are not needed and
2330would not be helpful.  Instead, a stack location must be used to perform
2331the copy and the @code{mov@var{m}} pattern should use memory as an
2332intermediate storage.  This case often occurs between floating-point and
2333general registers.
2334
2335@findex SECONDARY_MEMORY_NEEDED
2336@item SECONDARY_MEMORY_NEEDED (@var{class1}, @var{class2}, @var{m})
2337Certain machines have the property that some registers cannot be copied
2338to some other registers without using memory.  Define this macro on
2339those machines to be a C expression that is nonzero if objects of mode
2340@var{m} in registers of @var{class1} can only be copied to registers of
2341class @var{class2} by storing a register of @var{class1} into memory
2342and loading that memory location into a register of @var{class2}.
2343
2344Do not define this macro if its value would always be zero.
2345
2346@findex SECONDARY_MEMORY_NEEDED_RTX
2347@item SECONDARY_MEMORY_NEEDED_RTX (@var{mode})
2348Normally when @code{SECONDARY_MEMORY_NEEDED} is defined, the compiler
2349allocates a stack slot for a memory location needed for register copies.
2350If this macro is defined, the compiler instead uses the memory location
2351defined by this macro.
2352
2353Do not define this macro if you do not define
2354@code{SECONDARY_MEMORY_NEEDED}.
2355
2356@findex SECONDARY_MEMORY_NEEDED_MODE
2357@item SECONDARY_MEMORY_NEEDED_MODE (@var{mode})
2358When the compiler needs a secondary memory location to copy between two
2359registers of mode @var{mode}, it normally allocates sufficient memory to
2360hold a quantity of @code{BITS_PER_WORD} bits and performs the store and
2361load operations in a mode that many bits wide and whose class is the
2362same as that of @var{mode}.
2363
2364This is right thing to do on most machines because it ensures that all
2365bits of the register are copied and prevents accesses to the registers
2366in a narrower mode, which some machines prohibit for floating-point
2367registers.
2368
2369However, this default behavior is not correct on some machines, such as
2370the DEC Alpha, that store short integers in floating-point registers
2371differently than in integer registers.  On those machines, the default
2372widening will not work correctly and you must define this macro to
2373suppress that widening in some cases.  See the file @file{alpha.h} for
2374details.
2375
2376Do not define this macro if you do not define
2377@code{SECONDARY_MEMORY_NEEDED} or if widening @var{mode} to a mode that
2378is @code{BITS_PER_WORD} bits wide is correct for your machine.
2379
2380@findex SMALL_REGISTER_CLASSES
2381@item SMALL_REGISTER_CLASSES
2382On some machines, it is risky to let hard registers live across arbitrary
2383insns.  Typically, these machines have instructions that require values
2384to be in specific registers (like an accumulator), and reload will fail
2385if the required hard register is used for another purpose across such an
2386insn.
2387
2388Define @code{SMALL_REGISTER_CLASSES} to be an expression with a nonzero
2389value on these machines.  When this macro has a nonzero value, the
2390compiler will try to minimize the lifetime of hard registers.
2391
2392It is always safe to define this macro with a nonzero value, but if you
2393unnecessarily define it, you will reduce the amount of optimizations
2394that can be performed in some cases.  If you do not define this macro
2395with a nonzero value when it is required, the compiler will run out of
2396spill registers and print a fatal error message.  For most machines, you
2397should not define this macro at all.
2398
2399@findex CLASS_LIKELY_SPILLED_P
2400@item CLASS_LIKELY_SPILLED_P (@var{class})
2401A C expression whose value is nonzero if pseudos that have been assigned
2402to registers of class @var{class} would likely be spilled because
2403registers of @var{class} are needed for spill registers.
2404
2405The default value of this macro returns 1 if @var{class} has exactly one
2406register and zero otherwise.  On most machines, this default should be
2407used.  Only define this macro to some other expression if pseudos
2408allocated by @file{local-alloc.c} end up in memory because their hard
2409registers were needed for spill registers.  If this macro returns nonzero
2410for those classes, those pseudos will only be allocated by
2411@file{global.c}, which knows how to reallocate the pseudo to another
2412register.  If there would not be another register available for
2413reallocation, you should not change the definition of this macro since
2414the only effect of such a definition would be to slow down register
2415allocation.
2416
2417@findex CLASS_MAX_NREGS
2418@item CLASS_MAX_NREGS (@var{class}, @var{mode})
2419A C expression for the maximum number of consecutive registers
2420of class @var{class} needed to hold a value of mode @var{mode}.
2421
2422This is closely related to the macro @code{HARD_REGNO_NREGS}.  In fact,
2423the value of the macro @code{CLASS_MAX_NREGS (@var{class}, @var{mode})}
2424should be the maximum value of @code{HARD_REGNO_NREGS (@var{regno},
2425@var{mode})} for all @var{regno} values in the class @var{class}.
2426
2427This macro helps control the handling of multiple-word values
2428in the reload pass.
2429
2430@item CLASS_CANNOT_CHANGE_MODE
2431If defined, a C expression for a class that contains registers for
2432which the compiler may not change modes arbitrarily.
2433
2434@item CLASS_CANNOT_CHANGE_MODE_P(@var{from}, @var{to})
2435A C expression that is true if, for a register in
2436@code{CLASS_CANNOT_CHANGE_MODE}, the requested mode punning is invalid.
2437
2438For the example, loading 32-bit integer or floating-point objects into
2439floating-point registers on the Alpha extends them to 64-bits.
2440Therefore loading a 64-bit object and then storing it as a 32-bit object
2441does not store the low-order 32-bits, as would be the case for a normal
2442register.  Therefore, @file{alpha.h} defines @code{CLASS_CANNOT_CHANGE_MODE}
2443as @code{FLOAT_REGS} and @code{CLASS_CANNOT_CHANGE_MODE_P} restricts
2444mode changes to same-size modes.
2445
2446Compare this to IA-64, which extends floating-point values to 82-bits,
2447and stores 64-bit integers in a different format than 64-bit doubles.
2448Therefore @code{CLASS_CANNOT_CHANGE_MODE_P} is always true.
2449@end table
2450
2451Three other special macros describe which operands fit which constraint
2452letters.
2453
2454@table @code
2455@findex CONST_OK_FOR_LETTER_P
2456@item CONST_OK_FOR_LETTER_P (@var{value}, @var{c})
2457A C expression that defines the machine-dependent operand constraint
2458letters (@samp{I}, @samp{J}, @samp{K}, @dots{} @samp{P}) that specify
2459particular ranges of integer values.  If @var{c} is one of those
2460letters, the expression should check that @var{value}, an integer, is in
2461the appropriate range and return 1 if so, 0 otherwise.  If @var{c} is
2462not one of those letters, the value should be 0 regardless of
2463@var{value}.
2464
2465@findex CONST_DOUBLE_OK_FOR_LETTER_P
2466@item CONST_DOUBLE_OK_FOR_LETTER_P (@var{value}, @var{c})
2467A C expression that defines the machine-dependent operand constraint
2468letters that specify particular ranges of @code{const_double} values
2469(@samp{G} or @samp{H}).
2470
2471If @var{c} is one of those letters, the expression should check that
2472@var{value}, an RTX of code @code{const_double}, is in the appropriate
2473range and return 1 if so, 0 otherwise.  If @var{c} is not one of those
2474letters, the value should be 0 regardless of @var{value}.
2475
2476@code{const_double} is used for all floating-point constants and for
2477@code{DImode} fixed-point constants.  A given letter can accept either
2478or both kinds of values.  It can use @code{GET_MODE} to distinguish
2479between these kinds.
2480
2481@findex EXTRA_CONSTRAINT
2482@item EXTRA_CONSTRAINT (@var{value}, @var{c})
2483A C expression that defines the optional machine-dependent constraint
2484letters that can be used to segregate specific types of operands, usually
2485memory references, for the target machine.  Any letter that is not
2486elsewhere defined and not matched by @code{REG_CLASS_FROM_LETTER}
2487may be used.  Normally this macro will not be defined.
2488
2489If it is required for a particular target machine, it should return 1
2490if @var{value} corresponds to the operand type represented by the
2491constraint letter @var{c}.  If @var{c} is not defined as an extra
2492constraint, the value returned should be 0 regardless of @var{value}.
2493
2494For example, on the ROMP, load instructions cannot have their output
2495in r0 if the memory reference contains a symbolic address.  Constraint
2496letter @samp{Q} is defined as representing a memory address that does
2497@emph{not} contain a symbolic address.  An alternative is specified with
2498a @samp{Q} constraint on the input and @samp{r} on the output.  The next
2499alternative specifies @samp{m} on the input and a register class that
2500does not include r0 on the output.
2501@end table
2502
2503@node Stack and Calling
2504@section Stack Layout and Calling Conventions
2505@cindex calling conventions
2506
2507@c prevent bad page break with this line
2508This describes the stack layout and calling conventions.
2509
2510@menu
2511* Frame Layout::
2512* Exception Handling::
2513* Stack Checking::
2514* Frame Registers::
2515* Elimination::
2516* Stack Arguments::
2517* Register Arguments::
2518* Scalar Return::
2519* Aggregate Return::
2520* Caller Saves::
2521* Function Entry::
2522* Profiling::
2523* Tail Calls::
2524@end menu
2525
2526@node Frame Layout
2527@subsection Basic Stack Layout
2528@cindex stack frame layout
2529@cindex frame layout
2530
2531@c prevent bad page break with this line
2532Here is the basic stack layout.
2533
2534@table @code
2535@findex STACK_GROWS_DOWNWARD
2536@item STACK_GROWS_DOWNWARD
2537Define this macro if pushing a word onto the stack moves the stack
2538pointer to a smaller address.
2539
2540When we say, ``define this macro if @dots{},'' it means that the
2541compiler checks this macro only with @code{#ifdef} so the precise
2542definition used does not matter.
2543
2544@findex STACK_PUSH_CODE
2545@item STACK_PUSH_CODE
2546
2547This macro defines the operation used when something is pushed
2548on the stack.  In RTL, a push operation will be
2549@code{(set (mem (STACK_PUSH_CODE (reg sp))) ...)}
2550
2551The choices are @code{PRE_DEC}, @code{POST_DEC}, @code{PRE_INC},
2552and @code{POST_INC}.  Which of these is correct depends on
2553the stack direction and on whether the stack pointer points
2554to the last item on the stack or whether it points to the
2555space for the next item on the stack.
2556
2557The default is @code{PRE_DEC} when @code{STACK_GROWS_DOWNWARD} is
2558defined, which is almost always right, and @code{PRE_INC} otherwise,
2559which is often wrong.
2560
2561@findex FRAME_GROWS_DOWNWARD
2562@item FRAME_GROWS_DOWNWARD
2563Define this macro if the addresses of local variable slots are at negative
2564offsets from the frame pointer.
2565
2566@findex ARGS_GROW_DOWNWARD
2567@item ARGS_GROW_DOWNWARD
2568Define this macro if successive arguments to a function occupy decreasing
2569addresses on the stack.
2570
2571@findex STARTING_FRAME_OFFSET
2572@item STARTING_FRAME_OFFSET
2573Offset from the frame pointer to the first local variable slot to be allocated.
2574
2575If @code{FRAME_GROWS_DOWNWARD}, find the next slot's offset by
2576subtracting the first slot's length from @code{STARTING_FRAME_OFFSET}.
2577Otherwise, it is found by adding the length of the first slot to the
2578value @code{STARTING_FRAME_OFFSET}.
2579@c i'm not sure if the above is still correct.. had to change it to get
2580@c rid of an overfull.  --mew 2feb93
2581
2582@findex STACK_POINTER_OFFSET
2583@item STACK_POINTER_OFFSET
2584Offset from the stack pointer register to the first location at which
2585outgoing arguments are placed.  If not specified, the default value of
2586zero is used.  This is the proper value for most machines.
2587
2588If @code{ARGS_GROW_DOWNWARD}, this is the offset to the location above
2589the first location at which outgoing arguments are placed.
2590
2591@findex FIRST_PARM_OFFSET
2592@item FIRST_PARM_OFFSET (@var{fundecl})
2593Offset from the argument pointer register to the first argument's
2594address.  On some machines it may depend on the data type of the
2595function.
2596
2597If @code{ARGS_GROW_DOWNWARD}, this is the offset to the location above
2598the first argument's address.
2599
2600@findex STACK_DYNAMIC_OFFSET
2601@item STACK_DYNAMIC_OFFSET (@var{fundecl})
2602Offset from the stack pointer register to an item dynamically allocated
2603on the stack, e.g., by @code{alloca}.
2604
2605The default value for this macro is @code{STACK_POINTER_OFFSET} plus the
2606length of the outgoing arguments.  The default is correct for most
2607machines.  See @file{function.c} for details.
2608
2609@findex DYNAMIC_CHAIN_ADDRESS
2610@item DYNAMIC_CHAIN_ADDRESS (@var{frameaddr})
2611A C expression whose value is RTL representing the address in a stack
2612frame where the pointer to the caller's frame is stored.  Assume that
2613@var{frameaddr} is an RTL expression for the address of the stack frame
2614itself.
2615
2616If you don't define this macro, the default is to return the value
2617of @var{frameaddr}---that is, the stack frame address is also the
2618address of the stack word that points to the previous frame.
2619
2620@findex SETUP_FRAME_ADDRESSES
2621@item SETUP_FRAME_ADDRESSES
2622If defined, a C expression that produces the machine-specific code to
2623setup the stack so that arbitrary frames can be accessed.  For example,
2624on the Sparc, we must flush all of the register windows to the stack
2625before we can access arbitrary stack frames.  You will seldom need to
2626define this macro.
2627
2628@findex BUILTIN_SETJMP_FRAME_VALUE
2629@item BUILTIN_SETJMP_FRAME_VALUE
2630If defined, a C expression that contains an rtx that is used to store
2631the address of the current frame into the built in @code{setjmp} buffer.
2632The default value, @code{virtual_stack_vars_rtx}, is correct for most
2633machines.  One reason you may need to define this macro is if
2634@code{hard_frame_pointer_rtx} is the appropriate value on your machine.
2635
2636@findex RETURN_ADDR_RTX
2637@item RETURN_ADDR_RTX (@var{count}, @var{frameaddr})
2638A C expression whose value is RTL representing the value of the return
2639address for the frame @var{count} steps up from the current frame, after
2640the prologue.  @var{frameaddr} is the frame pointer of the @var{count}
2641frame, or the frame pointer of the @var{count} @minus{} 1 frame if
2642@code{RETURN_ADDR_IN_PREVIOUS_FRAME} is defined.
2643
2644The value of the expression must always be the correct address when
2645@var{count} is zero, but may be @code{NULL_RTX} if there is not way to
2646determine the return address of other frames.
2647
2648@findex RETURN_ADDR_IN_PREVIOUS_FRAME
2649@item RETURN_ADDR_IN_PREVIOUS_FRAME
2650Define this if the return address of a particular stack frame is accessed
2651from the frame pointer of the previous stack frame.
2652
2653@findex INCOMING_RETURN_ADDR_RTX
2654@item INCOMING_RETURN_ADDR_RTX
2655A C expression whose value is RTL representing the location of the
2656incoming return address at the beginning of any function, before the
2657prologue.  This RTL is either a @code{REG}, indicating that the return
2658value is saved in @samp{REG}, or a @code{MEM} representing a location in
2659the stack.
2660
2661You only need to define this macro if you want to support call frame
2662debugging information like that provided by DWARF 2.
2663
2664If this RTL is a @code{REG}, you should also define
2665@code{DWARF_FRAME_RETURN_COLUMN} to @code{DWARF_FRAME_REGNUM (REGNO)}.
2666
2667@findex INCOMING_FRAME_SP_OFFSET
2668@item INCOMING_FRAME_SP_OFFSET
2669A C expression whose value is an integer giving the offset, in bytes,
2670from the value of the stack pointer register to the top of the stack
2671frame at the beginning of any function, before the prologue.  The top of
2672the frame is defined to be the value of the stack pointer in the
2673previous frame, just before the call instruction.
2674
2675You only need to define this macro if you want to support call frame
2676debugging information like that provided by DWARF 2.
2677
2678@findex ARG_POINTER_CFA_OFFSET
2679@item ARG_POINTER_CFA_OFFSET (@var{fundecl})
2680A C expression whose value is an integer giving the offset, in bytes,
2681from the argument pointer to the canonical frame address (cfa).  The
2682final value should coincide with that calculated by
2683@code{INCOMING_FRAME_SP_OFFSET}.  Which is unfortunately not usable
2684during virtual register instantiation.
2685
2686The default value for this macro is @code{FIRST_PARM_OFFSET (fundecl)},
2687which is correct for most machines; in general, the arguments are found
2688immediately before the stack frame.  Note that this is not the case on
2689some targets that save registers into the caller's frame, such as SPARC
2690and rs6000, and so such targets need to define this macro.
2691
2692You only need to define this macro if the default is incorrect, and you
2693want to support call frame debugging information like that provided by
2694DWARF 2.
2695
2696@findex SMALL_STACK
2697@item SMALL_STACK
2698Define this macro if the stack size for the target is very small.  This
2699has the effect of disabling gcc's built-in @samp{alloca}, though
2700@samp{__builtin_alloca} is not affected.
2701@end table
2702
2703@node Exception Handling
2704@subsection Exception Handling Support
2705@cindex exception handling
2706
2707@table @code
2708@findex EH_RETURN_DATA_REGNO
2709@item EH_RETURN_DATA_REGNO (@var{N})
2710A C expression whose value is the @var{N}th register number used for
2711data by exception handlers, or @code{INVALID_REGNUM} if fewer than
2712@var{N} registers are usable.
2713
2714The exception handling library routines communicate with the exception
2715handlers via a set of agreed upon registers.  Ideally these registers
2716should be call-clobbered; it is possible to use call-saved registers,
2717but may negatively impact code size.  The target must support at least
27182 data registers, but should define 4 if there are enough free registers.
2719
2720You must define this macro if you want to support call frame exception
2721handling like that provided by DWARF 2.
2722
2723@findex EH_RETURN_STACKADJ_RTX
2724@item EH_RETURN_STACKADJ_RTX
2725A C expression whose value is RTL representing a location in which
2726to store a stack adjustment to be applied before function return.
2727This is used to unwind the stack to an exception handler's call frame.
2728It will be assigned zero on code paths that return normally.
2729
2730Typically this is a call-clobbered hard register that is otherwise
2731untouched by the epilogue, but could also be a stack slot.
2732
2733You must define this macro if you want to support call frame exception
2734handling like that provided by DWARF 2.
2735
2736@findex EH_RETURN_HANDLER_RTX
2737@item EH_RETURN_HANDLER_RTX
2738A C expression whose value is RTL representing a location in which
2739to store the address of an exception handler to which we should
2740return.  It will not be assigned on code paths that return normally.
2741
2742Typically this is the location in the call frame at which the normal
2743return address is stored.  For targets that return by popping an
2744address off the stack, this might be a memory address just below
2745the @emph{target} call frame rather than inside the current call
2746frame.  @code{EH_RETURN_STACKADJ_RTX} will have already been assigned,
2747so it may be used to calculate the location of the target call frame.
2748
2749Some targets have more complex requirements than storing to an
2750address calculable during initial code generation.  In that case
2751the @code{eh_return} instruction pattern should be used instead.
2752
2753If you want to support call frame exception handling, you must
2754define either this macro or the @code{eh_return} instruction pattern.
2755
2756@findex ASM_PREFERRED_EH_DATA_FORMAT
2757@item ASM_PREFERRED_EH_DATA_FORMAT(@var{code}, @var{global})
2758This macro chooses the encoding of pointers embedded in the exception
2759handling sections.  If at all possible, this should be defined such
2760that the exception handling section will not require dynamic relocations,
2761and so may be read-only.
2762
2763@var{code} is 0 for data, 1 for code labels, 2 for function pointers.
2764@var{global} is true if the symbol may be affected by dynamic relocations.
2765The macro should return a combination of the @code{DW_EH_PE_*} defines
2766as found in @file{dwarf2.h}.
2767
2768If this macro is not defined, pointers will not be encoded but
2769represented directly.
2770
2771@findex ASM_MAYBE_OUTPUT_ENCODED_ADDR_RTX
2772@item ASM_MAYBE_OUTPUT_ENCODED_ADDR_RTX(@var{file}, @var{encoding}, @var{size}, @var{addr}, @var{done})
2773This macro allows the target to emit whatever special magic is required
2774to represent the encoding chosen by @code{ASM_PREFERRED_EH_DATA_FORMAT}.
2775Generic code takes care of pc-relative and indirect encodings; this must
2776be defined if the target uses text-relative or data-relative encodings.
2777
2778This is a C statement that branches to @var{done} if the format was
2779handled.  @var{encoding} is the format chosen, @var{size} is the number
2780of bytes that the format occupies, @var{addr} is the @code{SYMBOL_REF}
2781to be emitted.
2782
2783@findex MD_FALLBACK_FRAME_STATE_FOR
2784@item MD_FALLBACK_FRAME_STATE_FOR(@var{context}, @var{fs}, @var{success})
2785This macro allows the target to add cpu and operating system specific
2786code to the call-frame unwinder for use when there is no unwind data
2787available.  The most common reason to implement this macro is to unwind
2788through signal frames.
2789
2790This macro is called from @code{uw_frame_state_for} in @file{unwind-dw2.c}
2791and @file{unwind-ia64.c}.  @var{context} is an @code{_Unwind_Context};
2792@var{fs} is an @code{_Unwind_FrameState}.  Examine @code{context->ra}
2793for the address of the code being executed and @code{context->cfa} for
2794the stack pointer value.  If the frame can be decoded, the register save
2795addresses should be updated in @var{fs} and the macro should branch to
2796@var{success}.  If the frame cannot be decoded, the macro should do 
2797nothing.
2798@end table
2799
2800@node Stack Checking
2801@subsection Specifying How Stack Checking is Done
2802
2803GCC will check that stack references are within the boundaries of
2804the stack, if the @option{-fstack-check} is specified, in one of three ways:
2805
2806@enumerate
2807@item
2808If the value of the @code{STACK_CHECK_BUILTIN} macro is nonzero, GCC
2809will assume that you have arranged for stack checking to be done at
2810appropriate places in the configuration files, e.g., in
2811@code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_PROLOGUE}.  GCC will do not other special
2812processing.
2813
2814@item
2815If @code{STACK_CHECK_BUILTIN} is zero and you defined a named pattern
2816called @code{check_stack} in your @file{md} file, GCC will call that
2817pattern with one argument which is the address to compare the stack
2818value against.  You must arrange for this pattern to report an error if
2819the stack pointer is out of range.
2820
2821@item
2822If neither of the above are true, GCC will generate code to periodically
2823``probe'' the stack pointer using the values of the macros defined below.
2824@end enumerate
2825
2826Normally, you will use the default values of these macros, so GCC
2827will use the third approach.
2828
2829@table @code
2830@findex STACK_CHECK_BUILTIN
2831@item STACK_CHECK_BUILTIN
2832A nonzero value if stack checking is done by the configuration files in a
2833machine-dependent manner.  You should define this macro if stack checking
2834is require by the ABI of your machine or if you would like to have to stack
2835checking in some more efficient way than GCC's portable approach.
2836The default value of this macro is zero.
2837
2838@findex STACK_CHECK_PROBE_INTERVAL
2839@item STACK_CHECK_PROBE_INTERVAL
2840An integer representing the interval at which GCC must generate stack
2841probe instructions.  You will normally define this macro to be no larger
2842than the size of the ``guard pages'' at the end of a stack area.  The
2843default value of 4096 is suitable for most systems.
2844
2845@findex STACK_CHECK_PROBE_LOAD
2846@item STACK_CHECK_PROBE_LOAD
2847A integer which is nonzero if GCC should perform the stack probe
2848as a load instruction and zero if GCC should use a store instruction.
2849The default is zero, which is the most efficient choice on most systems.
2850
2851@findex STACK_CHECK_PROTECT
2852@item STACK_CHECK_PROTECT
2853The number of bytes of stack needed to recover from a stack overflow,
2854for languages where such a recovery is supported.  The default value of
285575 words should be adequate for most machines.
2856
2857@findex STACK_CHECK_MAX_FRAME_SIZE
2858@item STACK_CHECK_MAX_FRAME_SIZE
2859The maximum size of a stack frame, in bytes.  GCC will generate probe
2860instructions in non-leaf functions to ensure at least this many bytes of
2861stack are available.  If a stack frame is larger than this size, stack
2862checking will not be reliable and GCC will issue a warning.  The
2863default is chosen so that GCC only generates one instruction on most
2864systems.  You should normally not change the default value of this macro.
2865
2866@findex STACK_CHECK_FIXED_FRAME_SIZE
2867@item STACK_CHECK_FIXED_FRAME_SIZE
2868GCC uses this value to generate the above warning message.  It
2869represents the amount of fixed frame used by a function, not including
2870space for any callee-saved registers, temporaries and user variables.
2871You need only specify an upper bound for this amount and will normally
2872use the default of four words.
2873
2874@findex STACK_CHECK_MAX_VAR_SIZE
2875@item STACK_CHECK_MAX_VAR_SIZE
2876The maximum size, in bytes, of an object that GCC will place in the
2877fixed area of the stack frame when the user specifies
2878@option{-fstack-check}.
2879GCC computed the default from the values of the above macros and you will
2880normally not need to override that default.
2881@end table
2882
2883@need 2000
2884@node Frame Registers
2885@subsection Registers That Address the Stack Frame
2886
2887@c prevent bad page break with this line
2888This discusses registers that address the stack frame.
2889
2890@table @code
2891@findex STACK_POINTER_REGNUM
2892@item STACK_POINTER_REGNUM
2893The register number of the stack pointer register, which must also be a
2894fixed register according to @code{FIXED_REGISTERS}.  On most machines,
2895the hardware determines which register this is.
2896
2897@findex FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM
2898@item FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM
2899The register number of the frame pointer register, which is used to
2900access automatic variables in the stack frame.  On some machines, the
2901hardware determines which register this is.  On other machines, you can
2902choose any register you wish for this purpose.
2903
2904@findex HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM
2905@item HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM
2906On some machines the offset between the frame pointer and starting
2907offset of the automatic variables is not known until after register
2908allocation has been done (for example, because the saved registers are
2909between these two locations).  On those machines, define
2910@code{FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM} the number of a special, fixed register to
2911be used internally until the offset is known, and define
2912@code{HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM} to be the actual hard register number
2913used for the frame pointer.
2914
2915You should define this macro only in the very rare circumstances when it
2916is not possible to calculate the offset between the frame pointer and
2917the automatic variables until after register allocation has been
2918completed.  When this macro is defined, you must also indicate in your
2919definition of @code{ELIMINABLE_REGS} how to eliminate
2920@code{FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM} into either @code{HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM}
2921or @code{STACK_POINTER_REGNUM}.
2922
2923Do not define this macro if it would be the same as
2924@code{FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM}.
2925
2926@findex ARG_POINTER_REGNUM
2927@item ARG_POINTER_REGNUM
2928The register number of the arg pointer register, which is used to access
2929the function's argument list.  On some machines, this is the same as the
2930frame pointer register.  On some machines, the hardware determines which
2931register this is.  On other machines, you can choose any register you
2932wish for this purpose.  If this is not the same register as the frame
2933pointer register, then you must mark it as a fixed register according to
2934@code{FIXED_REGISTERS}, or arrange to be able to eliminate it
2935(@pxref{Elimination}).
2936
2937@findex RETURN_ADDRESS_POINTER_REGNUM
2938@item RETURN_ADDRESS_POINTER_REGNUM
2939The register number of the return address pointer register, which is used to
2940access the current function's return address from the stack.  On some
2941machines, the return address is not at a fixed offset from the frame
2942pointer or stack pointer or argument pointer.  This register can be defined
2943to point to the return address on the stack, and then be converted by
2944@code{ELIMINABLE_REGS} into either the frame pointer or stack pointer.
2945
2946Do not define this macro unless there is no other way to get the return
2947address from the stack.
2948
2949@findex STATIC_CHAIN_REGNUM
2950@findex STATIC_CHAIN_INCOMING_REGNUM
2951@item STATIC_CHAIN_REGNUM
2952@itemx STATIC_CHAIN_INCOMING_REGNUM
2953Register numbers used for passing a function's static chain pointer.  If
2954register windows are used, the register number as seen by the called
2955function is @code{STATIC_CHAIN_INCOMING_REGNUM}, while the register
2956number as seen by the calling function is @code{STATIC_CHAIN_REGNUM}.  If
2957these registers are the same, @code{STATIC_CHAIN_INCOMING_REGNUM} need
2958not be defined.
2959
2960The static chain register need not be a fixed register.
2961
2962If the static chain is passed in memory, these macros should not be
2963defined; instead, the next two macros should be defined.
2964
2965@findex STATIC_CHAIN
2966@findex STATIC_CHAIN_INCOMING
2967@item STATIC_CHAIN
2968@itemx STATIC_CHAIN_INCOMING
2969If the static chain is passed in memory, these macros provide rtx giving
2970@code{mem} expressions that denote where they are stored.
2971@code{STATIC_CHAIN} and @code{STATIC_CHAIN_INCOMING} give the locations
2972as seen by the calling and called functions, respectively.  Often the former
2973will be at an offset from the stack pointer and the latter at an offset from
2974the frame pointer.
2975
2976@findex stack_pointer_rtx
2977@findex frame_pointer_rtx
2978@findex arg_pointer_rtx
2979The variables @code{stack_pointer_rtx}, @code{frame_pointer_rtx}, and
2980@code{arg_pointer_rtx} will have been initialized prior to the use of these
2981macros and should be used to refer to those items.
2982
2983If the static chain is passed in a register, the two previous macros should
2984be defined instead.
2985
2986@findex DWARF_FRAME_REGISTERS
2987@item DWARF_FRAME_REGISTERS
2988This macro specifies the maximum number of hard registers that can be
2989saved in a call frame.  This is used to size data structures used in
2990DWARF2 exception handling.
2991
2992Prior to GCC 3.0, this macro was needed in order to establish a stable
2993exception handling ABI in the face of adding new hard registers for ISA
2994extensions.  In GCC 3.0 and later, the EH ABI is insulated from changes
2995in the number of hard registers.  Nevertheless, this macro can still be
2996used to reduce the runtime memory requirements of the exception handling
2997routines, which can be substantial if the ISA contains a lot of
2998registers that are not call-saved.
2999
3000If this macro is not defined, it defaults to
3001@code{FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER}.
3002
3003@findex PRE_GCC3_DWARF_FRAME_REGISTERS
3004@item PRE_GCC3_DWARF_FRAME_REGISTERS
3005
3006This macro is similar to @code{DWARF_FRAME_REGISTERS}, but is provided
3007for backward compatibility in pre GCC 3.0 compiled code.
3008
3009If this macro is not defined, it defaults to
3010@code{DWARF_FRAME_REGISTERS}.
3011
3012@end table
3013
3014@node Elimination
3015@subsection Eliminating Frame Pointer and Arg Pointer
3016
3017@c prevent bad page break with this line
3018This is about eliminating the frame pointer and arg pointer.
3019
3020@table @code
3021@findex FRAME_POINTER_REQUIRED
3022@item FRAME_POINTER_REQUIRED
3023A C expression which is nonzero if a function must have and use a frame
3024pointer.  This expression is evaluated  in the reload pass.  If its value is
3025nonzero the function will have a frame pointer.
3026
3027The expression can in principle examine the current function and decide
3028according to the facts, but on most machines the constant 0 or the
3029constant 1 suffices.  Use 0 when the machine allows code to be generated
3030with no frame pointer, and doing so saves some time or space.  Use 1
3031when there is no possible advantage to avoiding a frame pointer.
3032
3033In certain cases, the compiler does not know how to produce valid code
3034without a frame pointer.  The compiler recognizes those cases and
3035automatically gives the function a frame pointer regardless of what
3036@code{FRAME_POINTER_REQUIRED} says.  You don't need to worry about
3037them.
3038
3039In a function that does not require a frame pointer, the frame pointer
3040register can be allocated for ordinary usage, unless you mark it as a
3041fixed register.  See @code{FIXED_REGISTERS} for more information.
3042
3043@findex INITIAL_FRAME_POINTER_OFFSET
3044@findex get_frame_size
3045@item INITIAL_FRAME_POINTER_OFFSET (@var{depth-var})
3046A C statement to store in the variable @var{depth-var} the difference
3047between the frame pointer and the stack pointer values immediately after
3048the function prologue.  The value would be computed from information
3049such as the result of @code{get_frame_size ()} and the tables of
3050registers @code{regs_ever_live} and @code{call_used_regs}.
3051
3052If @code{ELIMINABLE_REGS} is defined, this macro will be not be used and
3053need not be defined.  Otherwise, it must be defined even if
3054@code{FRAME_POINTER_REQUIRED} is defined to always be true; in that
3055case, you may set @var{depth-var} to anything.
3056
3057@findex ELIMINABLE_REGS
3058@item ELIMINABLE_REGS
3059If defined, this macro specifies a table of register pairs used to
3060eliminate unneeded registers that point into the stack frame.  If it is not
3061defined, the only elimination attempted by the compiler is to replace
3062references to the frame pointer with references to the stack pointer.
3063
3064The definition of this macro is a list of structure initializations, each
3065of which specifies an original and replacement register.
3066
3067On some machines, the position of the argument pointer is not known until
3068the compilation is completed.  In such a case, a separate hard register
3069must be used for the argument pointer.  This register can be eliminated by
3070replacing it with either the frame pointer or the argument pointer,
3071depending on whether or not the frame pointer has been eliminated.
3072
3073In this case, you might specify:
3074@example
3075#define ELIMINABLE_REGS  \
3076@{@{ARG_POINTER_REGNUM, STACK_POINTER_REGNUM@}, \
3077 @{ARG_POINTER_REGNUM, FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM@}, \
3078 @{FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM, STACK_POINTER_REGNUM@}@}
3079@end example
3080
3081Note that the elimination of the argument pointer with the stack pointer is
3082specified first since that is the preferred elimination.
3083
3084@findex CAN_ELIMINATE
3085@item CAN_ELIMINATE (@var{from-reg}, @var{to-reg})
3086A C expression that returns nonzero if the compiler is allowed to try
3087to replace register number @var{from-reg} with register number
3088@var{to-reg}.  This macro need only be defined if @code{ELIMINABLE_REGS}
3089is defined, and will usually be the constant 1, since most of the cases
3090preventing register elimination are things that the compiler already
3091knows about.
3092
3093@findex INITIAL_ELIMINATION_OFFSET
3094@item INITIAL_ELIMINATION_OFFSET (@var{from-reg}, @var{to-reg}, @var{offset-var})
3095This macro is similar to @code{INITIAL_FRAME_POINTER_OFFSET}.  It
3096specifies the initial difference between the specified pair of
3097registers.  This macro must be defined if @code{ELIMINABLE_REGS} is
3098defined.
3099@end table
3100
3101@node Stack Arguments
3102@subsection Passing Function Arguments on the Stack
3103@cindex arguments on stack
3104@cindex stack arguments
3105
3106The macros in this section control how arguments are passed
3107on the stack.  See the following section for other macros that
3108control passing certain arguments in registers.
3109
3110@table @code
3111@findex PROMOTE_PROTOTYPES
3112@item PROMOTE_PROTOTYPES
3113A C expression whose value is nonzero if an argument declared in
3114a prototype as an integral type smaller than @code{int} should
3115actually be passed as an @code{int}.  In addition to avoiding
3116errors in certain cases of mismatch, it also makes for better
3117code on certain machines.  If the macro is not defined in target
3118header files, it defaults to 0.
3119
3120@findex PUSH_ARGS
3121@item PUSH_ARGS
3122A C expression.  If nonzero, push insns will be used to pass
3123outgoing arguments.
3124If the target machine does not have a push instruction, set it to zero.
3125That directs GCC to use an alternate strategy: to
3126allocate the entire argument block and then store the arguments into
3127it.  When @code{PUSH_ARGS} is nonzero, @code{PUSH_ROUNDING} must be defined too.
3128On some machines, the definition
3129
3130@findex PUSH_ROUNDING
3131@item PUSH_ROUNDING (@var{npushed})
3132A C expression that is the number of bytes actually pushed onto the
3133stack when an instruction attempts to push @var{npushed} bytes.
3134
3135On some machines, the definition
3136
3137@example
3138#define PUSH_ROUNDING(BYTES) (BYTES)
3139@end example
3140
3141@noindent
3142will suffice.  But on other machines, instructions that appear
3143to push one byte actually push two bytes in an attempt to maintain
3144alignment.  Then the definition should be
3145
3146@example
3147#define PUSH_ROUNDING(BYTES) (((BYTES) + 1) & ~1)
3148@end example
3149
3150@findex ACCUMULATE_OUTGOING_ARGS
3151@findex current_function_outgoing_args_size
3152@item ACCUMULATE_OUTGOING_ARGS
3153A C expression.  If nonzero, the maximum amount of space required for outgoing arguments
3154will be computed and placed into the variable
3155@code{current_function_outgoing_args_size}.  No space will be pushed
3156onto the stack for each call; instead, the function prologue should
3157increase the stack frame size by this amount.
3158
3159Setting both @code{PUSH_ARGS} and @code{ACCUMULATE_OUTGOING_ARGS}
3160is not proper.
3161
3162@findex REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE
3163@item REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE (@var{fndecl})
3164Define this macro if functions should assume that stack space has been
3165allocated for arguments even when their values are passed in
3166registers.
3167
3168The value of this macro is the size, in bytes, of the area reserved for
3169arguments passed in registers for the function represented by @var{fndecl},
3170which can be zero if GCC is calling a library function.
3171
3172This space can be allocated by the caller, or be a part of the
3173machine-dependent stack frame: @code{OUTGOING_REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE} says
3174which.
3175@c above is overfull.  not sure what to do.  --mew 5feb93  did
3176@c something, not sure if it looks good.  --mew 10feb93
3177
3178@findex MAYBE_REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE
3179@findex FINAL_REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE
3180@item MAYBE_REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE
3181@itemx FINAL_REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE (@var{const_size}, @var{var_size})
3182Define these macros in addition to the one above if functions might
3183allocate stack space for arguments even when their values are passed
3184in registers.  These should be used when the stack space allocated
3185for arguments in registers is not a simple constant independent of the
3186function declaration.
3187
3188The value of the first macro is the size, in bytes, of the area that
3189we should initially assume would be reserved for arguments passed in registers.
3190
3191The value of the second macro is the actual size, in bytes, of the area
3192that will be reserved for arguments passed in registers.  This takes two
3193arguments: an integer representing the number of bytes of fixed sized
3194arguments on the stack, and a tree representing the number of bytes of
3195variable sized arguments on the stack.
3196
3197When these macros are defined, @code{REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE} will only be
3198called for libcall functions, the current function, or for a function
3199being called when it is known that such stack space must be allocated.
3200In each case this value can be easily computed.
3201
3202When deciding whether a called function needs such stack space, and how
3203much space to reserve, GCC uses these two macros instead of
3204@code{REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE}.
3205
3206@findex OUTGOING_REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE
3207@item OUTGOING_REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE
3208Define this if it is the responsibility of the caller to allocate the area
3209reserved for arguments passed in registers.
3210
3211If @code{ACCUMULATE_OUTGOING_ARGS} is defined, this macro controls
3212whether the space for these arguments counts in the value of
3213@code{current_function_outgoing_args_size}.
3214
3215@findex STACK_PARMS_IN_REG_PARM_AREA
3216@item STACK_PARMS_IN_REG_PARM_AREA
3217Define this macro if @code{REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE} is defined, but the
3218stack parameters don't skip the area specified by it.
3219@c i changed this, makes more sens and it should have taken care of the
3220@c overfull.. not as specific, tho.  --mew 5feb93
3221
3222Normally, when a parameter is not passed in registers, it is placed on the
3223stack beyond the @code{REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE} area.  Defining this macro
3224suppresses this behavior and causes the parameter to be passed on the
3225stack in its natural location.
3226
3227@findex RETURN_POPS_ARGS
3228@item RETURN_POPS_ARGS (@var{fundecl}, @var{funtype}, @var{stack-size})
3229A C expression that should indicate the number of bytes of its own
3230arguments that a function pops on returning, or 0 if the
3231function pops no arguments and the caller must therefore pop them all
3232after the function returns.
3233
3234@var{fundecl} is a C variable whose value is a tree node that describes
3235the function in question.  Normally it is a node of type
3236@code{FUNCTION_DECL} that describes the declaration of the function.
3237From this you can obtain the @code{DECL_ATTRIBUTES} of the function.
3238
3239@var{funtype} is a C variable whose value is a tree node that
3240describes the function in question.  Normally it is a node of type
3241@code{FUNCTION_TYPE} that describes the data type of the function.
3242From this it is possible to obtain the data types of the value and
3243arguments (if known).
3244
3245When a call to a library function is being considered, @var{fundecl}
3246will contain an identifier node for the library function.  Thus, if
3247you need to distinguish among various library functions, you can do so
3248by their names.  Note that ``library function'' in this context means
3249a function used to perform arithmetic, whose name is known specially
3250in the compiler and was not mentioned in the C code being compiled.
3251
3252@var{stack-size} is the number of bytes of arguments passed on the
3253stack.  If a variable number of bytes is passed, it is zero, and
3254argument popping will always be the responsibility of the calling function.
3255
3256On the VAX, all functions always pop their arguments, so the definition
3257of this macro is @var{stack-size}.  On the 68000, using the standard
3258calling convention, no functions pop their arguments, so the value of
3259the macro is always 0 in this case.  But an alternative calling
3260convention is available in which functions that take a fixed number of
3261arguments pop them but other functions (such as @code{printf}) pop
3262nothing (the caller pops all).  When this convention is in use,
3263@var{funtype} is examined to determine whether a function takes a fixed
3264number of arguments.
3265@end table
3266
3267@node Register Arguments
3268@subsection Passing Arguments in Registers
3269@cindex arguments in registers
3270@cindex registers arguments
3271
3272This section describes the macros which let you control how various
3273types of arguments are passed in registers or how they are arranged in
3274the stack.
3275
3276@table @code
3277@findex FUNCTION_ARG
3278@item FUNCTION_ARG (@var{cum}, @var{mode}, @var{type}, @var{named})
3279A C expression that controls whether a function argument is passed
3280in a register, and which register.
3281
3282The arguments are @var{cum}, which summarizes all the previous
3283arguments; @var{mode}, the machine mode of the argument; @var{type},
3284the data type of the argument as a tree node or 0 if that is not known
3285(which happens for C support library functions); and @var{named},
3286which is 1 for an ordinary argument and 0 for nameless arguments that
3287correspond to @samp{@dots{}} in the called function's prototype.
3288@var{type} can be an incomplete type if a syntax error has previously
3289occurred.
3290
3291The value of the expression is usually either a @code{reg} RTX for the
3292hard register in which to pass the argument, or zero to pass the
3293argument on the stack.
3294
3295For machines like the VAX and 68000, where normally all arguments are
3296pushed, zero suffices as a definition.
3297
3298The value of the expression can also be a @code{parallel} RTX@.  This is
3299used when an argument is passed in multiple locations.  The mode of the
3300of the @code{parallel} should be the mode of the entire argument.  The
3301@code{parallel} holds any number of @code{expr_list} pairs; each one
3302describes where part of the argument is passed.  In each
3303@code{expr_list} the first operand must be a @code{reg} RTX for the hard
3304register in which to pass this part of the argument, and the mode of the
3305register RTX indicates how large this part of the argument is.  The
3306second operand of the @code{expr_list} is a @code{const_int} which gives
3307the offset in bytes into the entire argument of where this part starts.
3308As a special exception the first @code{expr_list} in the @code{parallel}
3309RTX may have a first operand of zero.  This indicates that the entire
3310argument is also stored on the stack.
3311
3312The last time this macro is called, it is called with @code{MODE ==
3313VOIDmode}, and its result is passed to the @code{call} or @code{call_value}
3314pattern as operands 2 and 3 respectively.
3315
3316@cindex @file{stdarg.h} and register arguments
3317The usual way to make the ISO library @file{stdarg.h} work on a machine
3318where some arguments are usually passed in registers, is to cause
3319nameless arguments to be passed on the stack instead.  This is done
3320by making @code{FUNCTION_ARG} return 0 whenever @var{named} is 0.
3321
3322@cindex @code{MUST_PASS_IN_STACK}, and @code{FUNCTION_ARG}
3323@cindex @code{REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE}, and @code{FUNCTION_ARG}
3324You may use the macro @code{MUST_PASS_IN_STACK (@var{mode}, @var{type})}
3325in the definition of this macro to determine if this argument is of a
3326type that must be passed in the stack.  If @code{REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE}
3327is not defined and @code{FUNCTION_ARG} returns nonzero for such an
3328argument, the compiler will abort.  If @code{REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE} is
3329defined, the argument will be computed in the stack and then loaded into
3330a register.
3331
3332@findex MUST_PASS_IN_STACK
3333@item MUST_PASS_IN_STACK (@var{mode}, @var{type})
3334Define as a C expression that evaluates to nonzero if we do not know how
3335to pass TYPE solely in registers.  The file @file{expr.h} defines a
3336definition that is usually appropriate, refer to @file{expr.h} for additional
3337documentation.
3338
3339@findex FUNCTION_INCOMING_ARG
3340@item FUNCTION_INCOMING_ARG (@var{cum}, @var{mode}, @var{type}, @var{named})
3341Define this macro if the target machine has ``register windows'', so
3342that the register in which a function sees an arguments is not
3343necessarily the same as the one in which the caller passed the
3344argument.
3345
3346For such machines, @code{FUNCTION_ARG} computes the register in which
3347the caller passes the value, and @code{FUNCTION_INCOMING_ARG} should
3348be defined in a similar fashion to tell the function being called
3349where the arguments will arrive.
3350
3351If @code{FUNCTION_INCOMING_ARG} is not defined, @code{FUNCTION_ARG}
3352serves both purposes.
3353
3354@findex FUNCTION_ARG_PARTIAL_NREGS
3355@item FUNCTION_ARG_PARTIAL_NREGS (@var{cum}, @var{mode}, @var{type}, @var{named})
3356A C expression for the number of words, at the beginning of an
3357argument, that must be put in registers.  The value must be zero for
3358arguments that are passed entirely in registers or that are entirely
3359pushed on the stack.
3360
3361On some machines, certain arguments must be passed partially in
3362registers and partially in memory.  On these machines, typically the
3363first @var{n} words of arguments are passed in registers, and the rest
3364on the stack.  If a multi-word argument (a @code{double} or a
3365structure) crosses that boundary, its first few words must be passed
3366in registers and the rest must be pushed.  This macro tells the
3367compiler when this occurs, and how many of the words should go in
3368registers.
3369
3370@code{FUNCTION_ARG} for these arguments should return the first
3371register to be used by the caller for this argument; likewise
3372@code{FUNCTION_INCOMING_ARG}, for the called function.
3373
3374@findex FUNCTION_ARG_PASS_BY_REFERENCE
3375@item FUNCTION_ARG_PASS_BY_REFERENCE (@var{cum}, @var{mode}, @var{type}, @var{named})
3376A C expression that indicates when an argument must be passed by reference.
3377If nonzero for an argument, a copy of that argument is made in memory and a
3378pointer to the argument is passed instead of the argument itself.
3379The pointer is passed in whatever way is appropriate for passing a pointer
3380to that type.
3381
3382On machines where @code{REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE} is not defined, a suitable
3383definition of this macro might be
3384@smallexample
3385#define FUNCTION_ARG_PASS_BY_REFERENCE\
3386(CUM, MODE, TYPE, NAMED)  \
3387  MUST_PASS_IN_STACK (MODE, TYPE)
3388@end smallexample
3389@c this is *still* too long.  --mew 5feb93
3390
3391@findex FUNCTION_ARG_CALLEE_COPIES
3392@item FUNCTION_ARG_CALLEE_COPIES (@var{cum}, @var{mode}, @var{type}, @var{named})
3393If defined, a C expression that indicates when it is the called function's
3394responsibility to make a copy of arguments passed by invisible reference.
3395Normally, the caller makes a copy and passes the address of the copy to the
3396routine being called.  When @code{FUNCTION_ARG_CALLEE_COPIES} is defined and is
3397nonzero, the caller does not make a copy.  Instead, it passes a pointer to the
3398``live'' value.  The called function must not modify this value.  If it can be
3399determined that the value won't be modified, it need not make a copy;
3400otherwise a copy must be made.
3401
3402@findex FUNCTION_ARG_REG_LITTLE_ENDIAN
3403@item FUNCTION_ARG_REG_LITTLE_ENDIAN
3404If defined TRUE on a big-endian system then structure arguments passed
3405(and returned) in registers are passed in a little-endian manner instead of
3406the big-endian manner.  On the HP-UX IA64 and PA64 platforms structures are
3407aligned differently then integral values and setting this value to true will
3408allow for the special handling of structure arguments and return values.
3409
3410@findex CUMULATIVE_ARGS
3411@item CUMULATIVE_ARGS
3412A C type for declaring a variable that is used as the first argument of
3413@code{FUNCTION_ARG} and other related values.  For some target machines,
3414the type @code{int} suffices and can hold the number of bytes of
3415argument so far.
3416
3417There is no need to record in @code{CUMULATIVE_ARGS} anything about the
3418arguments that have been passed on the stack.  The compiler has other
3419variables to keep track of that.  For target machines on which all
3420arguments are passed on the stack, there is no need to store anything in
3421@code{CUMULATIVE_ARGS}; however, the data structure must exist and
3422should not be empty, so use @code{int}.
3423
3424@findex INIT_CUMULATIVE_ARGS
3425@item INIT_CUMULATIVE_ARGS (@var{cum}, @var{fntype}, @var{libname}, @var{indirect})
3426A C statement (sans semicolon) for initializing the variable @var{cum}
3427for the state at the beginning of the argument list.  The variable has
3428type @code{CUMULATIVE_ARGS}.  The value of @var{fntype} is the tree node
3429for the data type of the function which will receive the args, or 0
3430if the args are to a compiler support library function.  The value of
3431@var{indirect} is nonzero when processing an indirect call, for example
3432a call through a function pointer.  The value of @var{indirect} is zero
3433for a call to an explicitly named function, a library function call, or when
3434@code{INIT_CUMULATIVE_ARGS} is used to find arguments for the function
3435being compiled.
3436
3437When processing a call to a compiler support library function,
3438@var{libname} identifies which one.  It is a @code{symbol_ref} rtx which
3439contains the name of the function, as a string.  @var{libname} is 0 when
3440an ordinary C function call is being processed.  Thus, each time this
3441macro is called, either @var{libname} or @var{fntype} is nonzero, but
3442never both of them at once.
3443
3444@findex INIT_CUMULATIVE_LIBCALL_ARGS
3445@item INIT_CUMULATIVE_LIBCALL_ARGS (@var{cum}, @var{mode}, @var{libname})
3446Like @code{INIT_CUMULATIVE_ARGS} but only used for outgoing libcalls,
3447it gets a @code{MODE} argument instead of @var{fntype}, that would be
3448@code{NULL}.  @var{indirect} would always be zero, too.  If this macro
3449is not defined, @code{INIT_CUMULATIVE_ARGS (cum, NULL_RTX, libname,
34500)} is used instead.
3451
3452@findex INIT_CUMULATIVE_INCOMING_ARGS
3453@item INIT_CUMULATIVE_INCOMING_ARGS (@var{cum}, @var{fntype}, @var{libname})
3454Like @code{INIT_CUMULATIVE_ARGS} but overrides it for the purposes of
3455finding the arguments for the function being compiled.  If this macro is
3456undefined, @code{INIT_CUMULATIVE_ARGS} is used instead.
3457
3458The value passed for @var{libname} is always 0, since library routines
3459with special calling conventions are never compiled with GCC@.  The
3460argument @var{libname} exists for symmetry with
3461@code{INIT_CUMULATIVE_ARGS}.
3462@c could use "this macro" in place of @code{INIT_CUMULATIVE_ARGS}, maybe.
3463@c --mew 5feb93   i switched the order of the sentences.  --mew 10feb93
3464
3465@findex FUNCTION_ARG_ADVANCE
3466@item FUNCTION_ARG_ADVANCE (@var{cum}, @var{mode}, @var{type}, @var{named})
3467A C statement (sans semicolon) to update the summarizer variable
3468@var{cum} to advance past an argument in the argument list.  The
3469values @var{mode}, @var{type} and @var{named} describe that argument.
3470Once this is done, the variable @var{cum} is suitable for analyzing
3471the @emph{following} argument with @code{FUNCTION_ARG}, etc.
3472
3473This macro need not do anything if the argument in question was passed
3474on the stack.  The compiler knows how to track the amount of stack space
3475used for arguments without any special help.
3476
3477@findex FUNCTION_ARG_PADDING
3478@item FUNCTION_ARG_PADDING (@var{mode}, @var{type})
3479If defined, a C expression which determines whether, and in which direction,
3480to pad out an argument with extra space.  The value should be of type
3481@code{enum direction}: either @code{upward} to pad above the argument,
3482@code{downward} to pad below, or @code{none} to inhibit padding.
3483
3484The @emph{amount} of padding is always just enough to reach the next
3485multiple of @code{FUNCTION_ARG_BOUNDARY}; this macro does not control
3486it.
3487
3488This macro has a default definition which is right for most systems.
3489For little-endian machines, the default is to pad upward.  For
3490big-endian machines, the default is to pad downward for an argument of
3491constant size shorter than an @code{int}, and upward otherwise.
3492
3493@findex PAD_VARARGS_DOWN
3494@item PAD_VARARGS_DOWN
3495If defined, a C expression which determines whether the default
3496implementation of va_arg will attempt to pad down before reading the
3497next argument, if that argument is smaller than its aligned space as
3498controlled by @code{PARM_BOUNDARY}.  If this macro is not defined, all such
3499arguments are padded down if @code{BYTES_BIG_ENDIAN} is true.
3500
3501@findex FUNCTION_ARG_BOUNDARY
3502@item FUNCTION_ARG_BOUNDARY (@var{mode}, @var{type})
3503If defined, a C expression that gives the alignment boundary, in bits,
3504of an argument with the specified mode and type.  If it is not defined,
3505@code{PARM_BOUNDARY} is used for all arguments.
3506
3507@findex FUNCTION_ARG_REGNO_P
3508@item FUNCTION_ARG_REGNO_P (@var{regno})
3509A C expression that is nonzero if @var{regno} is the number of a hard
3510register in which function arguments are sometimes passed.  This does
3511@emph{not} include implicit arguments such as the static chain and
3512the structure-value address.  On many machines, no registers can be
3513used for this purpose since all function arguments are pushed on the
3514stack.
3515
3516@findex LOAD_ARGS_REVERSED
3517@item LOAD_ARGS_REVERSED
3518If defined, the order in which arguments are loaded into their
3519respective argument registers is reversed so that the last
3520argument is loaded first.  This macro only affects arguments
3521passed in registers.
3522
3523@end table
3524
3525@node Scalar Return
3526@subsection How Scalar Function Values Are Returned
3527@cindex return values in registers
3528@cindex values, returned by functions
3529@cindex scalars, returned as values
3530
3531This section discusses the macros that control returning scalars as
3532values---values that can fit in registers.
3533
3534@table @code
3535@findex TRADITIONAL_RETURN_FLOAT
3536@item TRADITIONAL_RETURN_FLOAT
3537Define this macro if @option{-traditional} should not cause functions
3538declared to return @code{float} to convert the value to @code{double}.
3539
3540@findex FUNCTION_VALUE
3541@item FUNCTION_VALUE (@var{valtype}, @var{func})
3542A C expression to create an RTX representing the place where a
3543function returns a value of data type @var{valtype}.  @var{valtype} is
3544a tree node representing a data type.  Write @code{TYPE_MODE
3545(@var{valtype})} to get the machine mode used to represent that type.
3546On many machines, only the mode is relevant.  (Actually, on most
3547machines, scalar values are returned in the same place regardless of
3548mode).
3549
3550The value of the expression is usually a @code{reg} RTX for the hard
3551register where the return value is stored.  The value can also be a
3552@code{parallel} RTX, if the return value is in multiple places.  See
3553@code{FUNCTION_ARG} for an explanation of the @code{parallel} form.
3554
3555If @code{PROMOTE_FUNCTION_RETURN} is defined, you must apply the same
3556promotion rules specified in @code{PROMOTE_MODE} if @var{valtype} is a
3557scalar type.
3558
3559If the precise function being called is known, @var{func} is a tree
3560node (@code{FUNCTION_DECL}) for it; otherwise, @var{func} is a null
3561pointer.  This makes it possible to use a different value-returning
3562convention for specific functions when all their calls are
3563known.
3564
3565@code{FUNCTION_VALUE} is not used for return vales with aggregate data
3566types, because these are returned in another way.  See
3567@code{STRUCT_VALUE_REGNUM} and related macros, below.
3568
3569@findex FUNCTION_OUTGOING_VALUE
3570@item FUNCTION_OUTGOING_VALUE (@var{valtype}, @var{func})
3571Define this macro if the target machine has ``register windows''
3572so that the register in which a function returns its value is not
3573the same as the one in which the caller sees the value.
3574
3575For such machines, @code{FUNCTION_VALUE} computes the register in which
3576the caller will see the value.  @code{FUNCTION_OUTGOING_VALUE} should be
3577defined in a similar fashion to tell the function where to put the
3578value.
3579
3580If @code{FUNCTION_OUTGOING_VALUE} is not defined,
3581@code{FUNCTION_VALUE} serves both purposes.
3582
3583@code{FUNCTION_OUTGOING_VALUE} is not used for return vales with
3584aggregate data types, because these are returned in another way.  See
3585@code{STRUCT_VALUE_REGNUM} and related macros, below.
3586
3587@findex LIBCALL_VALUE
3588@item LIBCALL_VALUE (@var{mode})
3589A C expression to create an RTX representing the place where a library
3590function returns a value of mode @var{mode}.  If the precise function
3591being called is known, @var{func} is a tree node
3592(@code{FUNCTION_DECL}) for it; otherwise, @var{func} is a null
3593pointer.  This makes it possible to use a different value-returning
3594convention for specific functions when all their calls are
3595known.
3596
3597Note that ``library function'' in this context means a compiler
3598support routine, used to perform arithmetic, whose name is known
3599specially by the compiler and was not mentioned in the C code being
3600compiled.
3601
3602The definition of @code{LIBRARY_VALUE} need not be concerned aggregate
3603data types, because none of the library functions returns such types.
3604
3605@findex FUNCTION_VALUE_REGNO_P
3606@item FUNCTION_VALUE_REGNO_P (@var{regno})
3607A C expression that is nonzero if @var{regno} is the number of a hard
3608register in which the values of called function may come back.
3609
3610A register whose use for returning values is limited to serving as the
3611second of a pair (for a value of type @code{double}, say) need not be
3612recognized by this macro.  So for most machines, this definition
3613suffices:
3614
3615@example
3616#define FUNCTION_VALUE_REGNO_P(N) ((N) == 0)
3617@end example
3618
3619If the machine has register windows, so that the caller and the called
3620function use different registers for the return value, this macro
3621should recognize only the caller's register numbers.
3622
3623@findex APPLY_RESULT_SIZE
3624@item APPLY_RESULT_SIZE
3625Define this macro if @samp{untyped_call} and @samp{untyped_return}
3626need more space than is implied by @code{FUNCTION_VALUE_REGNO_P} for
3627saving and restoring an arbitrary return value.
3628@end table
3629
3630@node Aggregate Return
3631@subsection How Large Values Are Returned
3632@cindex aggregates as return values
3633@cindex large return values
3634@cindex returning aggregate values
3635@cindex structure value address
3636
3637When a function value's mode is @code{BLKmode} (and in some other
3638cases), the value is not returned according to @code{FUNCTION_VALUE}
3639(@pxref{Scalar Return}).  Instead, the caller passes the address of a
3640block of memory in which the value should be stored.  This address
3641is called the @dfn{structure value address}.
3642
3643This section describes how to control returning structure values in
3644memory.
3645
3646@table @code
3647@findex RETURN_IN_MEMORY
3648@item RETURN_IN_MEMORY (@var{type})
3649A C expression which can inhibit the returning of certain function
3650values in registers, based on the type of value.  A nonzero value says
3651to return the function value in memory, just as large structures are
3652always returned.  Here @var{type} will be a C expression of type
3653@code{tree}, representing the data type of the value.
3654
3655Note that values of mode @code{BLKmode} must be explicitly handled
3656by this macro.  Also, the option @option{-fpcc-struct-return}
3657takes effect regardless of this macro.  On most systems, it is
3658possible to leave the macro undefined; this causes a default
3659definition to be used, whose value is the constant 1 for @code{BLKmode}
3660values, and 0 otherwise.
3661
3662Do not use this macro to indicate that structures and unions should always
3663be returned in memory.  You should instead use @code{DEFAULT_PCC_STRUCT_RETURN}
3664to indicate this.
3665
3666@findex DEFAULT_PCC_STRUCT_RETURN
3667@item DEFAULT_PCC_STRUCT_RETURN
3668Define this macro to be 1 if all structure and union return values must be
3669in memory.  Since this results in slower code, this should be defined
3670only if needed for compatibility with other compilers or with an ABI@.
3671If you define this macro to be 0, then the conventions used for structure
3672and union return values are decided by the @code{RETURN_IN_MEMORY} macro.
3673
3674If not defined, this defaults to the value 1.
3675
3676@findex STRUCT_VALUE_REGNUM
3677@item STRUCT_VALUE_REGNUM
3678If the structure value address is passed in a register, then
3679@code{STRUCT_VALUE_REGNUM} should be the number of that register.
3680
3681@findex STRUCT_VALUE
3682@item STRUCT_VALUE
3683If the structure value address is not passed in a register, define
3684@code{STRUCT_VALUE} as an expression returning an RTX for the place
3685where the address is passed.  If it returns 0, the address is passed as
3686an ``invisible'' first argument.
3687
3688@findex STRUCT_VALUE_INCOMING_REGNUM
3689@item STRUCT_VALUE_INCOMING_REGNUM
3690On some architectures the place where the structure value address
3691is found by the called function is not the same place that the
3692caller put it.  This can be due to register windows, or it could
3693be because the function prologue moves it to a different place.
3694
3695If the incoming location of the structure value address is in a
3696register, define this macro as the register number.
3697
3698@findex STRUCT_VALUE_INCOMING
3699@item STRUCT_VALUE_INCOMING
3700If the incoming location is not a register, then you should define
3701@code{STRUCT_VALUE_INCOMING} as an expression for an RTX for where the
3702called function should find the value.  If it should find the value on
3703the stack, define this to create a @code{mem} which refers to the frame
3704pointer.  A definition of 0 means that the address is passed as an
3705``invisible'' first argument.
3706
3707@findex PCC_STATIC_STRUCT_RETURN
3708@item PCC_STATIC_STRUCT_RETURN
3709Define this macro if the usual system convention on the target machine
3710for returning structures and unions is for the called function to return
3711the address of a static variable containing the value.
3712
3713Do not define this if the usual system convention is for the caller to
3714pass an address to the subroutine.
3715
3716This macro has effect in @option{-fpcc-struct-return} mode, but it does
3717nothing when you use @option{-freg-struct-return} mode.
3718@end table
3719
3720@node Caller Saves
3721@subsection Caller-Saves Register Allocation
3722
3723If you enable it, GCC can save registers around function calls.  This
3724makes it possible to use call-clobbered registers to hold variables that
3725must live across calls.
3726
3727@table @code
3728@findex DEFAULT_CALLER_SAVES
3729@item DEFAULT_CALLER_SAVES
3730Define this macro if function calls on the target machine do not preserve
3731any registers; in other words, if @code{CALL_USED_REGISTERS} has 1
3732for all registers.  When defined, this macro enables @option{-fcaller-saves}
3733by default for all optimization levels.  It has no effect for optimization
3734levels 2 and higher, where @option{-fcaller-saves} is the default.
3735
3736@findex CALLER_SAVE_PROFITABLE
3737@item CALLER_SAVE_PROFITABLE (@var{refs}, @var{calls})
3738A C expression to determine whether it is worthwhile to consider placing
3739a pseudo-register in a call-clobbered hard register and saving and
3740restoring it around each function call.  The expression should be 1 when
3741this is worth doing, and 0 otherwise.
3742
3743If you don't define this macro, a default is used which is good on most
3744machines: @code{4 * @var{calls} < @var{refs}}.
3745
3746@findex HARD_REGNO_CALLER_SAVE_MODE
3747@item HARD_REGNO_CALLER_SAVE_MODE (@var{regno}, @var{nregs})
3748A C expression specifying which mode is required for saving @var{nregs}
3749of a pseudo-register in call-clobbered hard register @var{regno}.  If
3750@var{regno} is unsuitable for caller save, @code{VOIDmode} should be
3751returned.  For most machines this macro need not be defined since GCC
3752will select the smallest suitable mode.
3753@end table
3754
3755@node Function Entry
3756@subsection Function Entry and Exit
3757@cindex function entry and exit
3758@cindex prologue
3759@cindex epilogue
3760
3761This section describes the macros that output function entry
3762(@dfn{prologue}) and exit (@dfn{epilogue}) code.
3763
3764@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_PROLOGUE (FILE *@var{file}, HOST_WIDE_INT @var{size})
3765If defined, a function that outputs the assembler code for entry to a
3766function.  The prologue is responsible for setting up the stack frame,
3767initializing the frame pointer register, saving registers that must be
3768saved, and allocating @var{size} additional bytes of storage for the
3769local variables.  @var{size} is an integer.  @var{file} is a stdio
3770stream to which the assembler code should be output.
3771
3772The label for the beginning of the function need not be output by this
3773macro.  That has already been done when the macro is run.
3774
3775@findex regs_ever_live
3776To determine which registers to save, the macro can refer to the array
3777@code{regs_ever_live}: element @var{r} is nonzero if hard register
3778@var{r} is used anywhere within the function.  This implies the function
3779prologue should save register @var{r}, provided it is not one of the
3780call-used registers.  (@code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_EPILOGUE} must likewise use
3781@code{regs_ever_live}.)
3782
3783On machines that have ``register windows'', the function entry code does
3784not save on the stack the registers that are in the windows, even if
3785they are supposed to be preserved by function calls; instead it takes
3786appropriate steps to ``push'' the register stack, if any non-call-used
3787registers are used in the function.
3788
3789@findex frame_pointer_needed
3790On machines where functions may or may not have frame-pointers, the
3791function entry code must vary accordingly; it must set up the frame
3792pointer if one is wanted, and not otherwise.  To determine whether a
3793frame pointer is in wanted, the macro can refer to the variable
3794@code{frame_pointer_needed}.  The variable's value will be 1 at run
3795time in a function that needs a frame pointer.  @xref{Elimination}.
3796
3797The function entry code is responsible for allocating any stack space
3798required for the function.  This stack space consists of the regions
3799listed below.  In most cases, these regions are allocated in the
3800order listed, with the last listed region closest to the top of the
3801stack (the lowest address if @code{STACK_GROWS_DOWNWARD} is defined, and
3802the highest address if it is not defined).  You can use a different order
3803for a machine if doing so is more convenient or required for
3804compatibility reasons.  Except in cases where required by standard
3805or by a debugger, there is no reason why the stack layout used by GCC
3806need agree with that used by other compilers for a machine.
3807@end deftypefn
3808
3809@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_END_PROLOGUE (FILE *@var{file})
3810If defined, a function that outputs assembler code at the end of a
3811prologue.  This should be used when the function prologue is being
3812emitted as RTL, and you have some extra assembler that needs to be
3813emitted.  @xref{prologue instruction pattern}.
3814@end deftypefn
3815
3816@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_BEGIN_EPILOGUE (FILE *@var{file})
3817If defined, a function that outputs assembler code at the start of an
3818epilogue.  This should be used when the function epilogue is being
3819emitted as RTL, and you have some extra assembler that needs to be
3820emitted.  @xref{epilogue instruction pattern}.
3821@end deftypefn
3822
3823@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_EPILOGUE (FILE *@var{file}, HOST_WIDE_INT @var{size})
3824If defined, a function that outputs the assembler code for exit from a
3825function.  The epilogue is responsible for restoring the saved
3826registers and stack pointer to their values when the function was
3827called, and returning control to the caller.  This macro takes the
3828same arguments as the macro @code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_PROLOGUE}, and the
3829registers to restore are determined from @code{regs_ever_live} and
3830@code{CALL_USED_REGISTERS} in the same way.
3831
3832On some machines, there is a single instruction that does all the work
3833of returning from the function.  On these machines, give that
3834instruction the name @samp{return} and do not define the macro
3835@code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_EPILOGUE} at all.
3836
3837Do not define a pattern named @samp{return} if you want the
3838@code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_EPILOGUE} to be used.  If you want the target
3839switches to control whether return instructions or epilogues are used,
3840define a @samp{return} pattern with a validity condition that tests the
3841target switches appropriately.  If the @samp{return} pattern's validity
3842condition is false, epilogues will be used.
3843
3844On machines where functions may or may not have frame-pointers, the
3845function exit code must vary accordingly.  Sometimes the code for these
3846two cases is completely different.  To determine whether a frame pointer
3847is wanted, the macro can refer to the variable
3848@code{frame_pointer_needed}.  The variable's value will be 1 when compiling
3849a function that needs a frame pointer.
3850
3851Normally, @code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_PROLOGUE} and
3852@code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_EPILOGUE} must treat leaf functions specially.
3853The C variable @code{current_function_is_leaf} is nonzero for such a
3854function.  @xref{Leaf Functions}.
3855
3856On some machines, some functions pop their arguments on exit while
3857others leave that for the caller to do.  For example, the 68020 when
3858given @option{-mrtd} pops arguments in functions that take a fixed
3859number of arguments.
3860
3861@findex current_function_pops_args
3862Your definition of the macro @code{RETURN_POPS_ARGS} decides which
3863functions pop their own arguments.  @code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_EPILOGUE}
3864needs to know what was decided.  The variable that is called
3865@code{current_function_pops_args} is the number of bytes of its
3866arguments that a function should pop.  @xref{Scalar Return}.
3867@c what is the "its arguments" in the above sentence referring to, pray
3868@c tell?  --mew 5feb93
3869@end deftypefn
3870
3871@table @code
3872
3873@itemize @bullet
3874@item
3875@findex current_function_pretend_args_size
3876A region of @code{current_function_pretend_args_size} bytes of
3877uninitialized space just underneath the first argument arriving on the
3878stack.  (This may not be at the very start of the allocated stack region
3879if the calling sequence has pushed anything else since pushing the stack
3880arguments.  But usually, on such machines, nothing else has been pushed
3881yet, because the function prologue itself does all the pushing.)  This
3882region is used on machines where an argument may be passed partly in
3883registers and partly in memory, and, in some cases to support the
3884features in @code{<varargs.h>} and @code{<stdarg.h>}.
3885
3886@item
3887An area of memory used to save certain registers used by the function.
3888The size of this area, which may also include space for such things as
3889the return address and pointers to previous stack frames, is
3890machine-specific and usually depends on which registers have been used
3891in the function.  Machines with register windows often do not require
3892a save area.
3893
3894@item
3895A region of at least @var{size} bytes, possibly rounded up to an allocation
3896boundary, to contain the local variables of the function.  On some machines,
3897this region and the save area may occur in the opposite order, with the
3898save area closer to the top of the stack.
3899
3900@item
3901@cindex @code{ACCUMULATE_OUTGOING_ARGS} and stack frames
3902Optionally, when @code{ACCUMULATE_OUTGOING_ARGS} is defined, a region of
3903@code{current_function_outgoing_args_size} bytes to be used for outgoing
3904argument lists of the function.  @xref{Stack Arguments}.
3905@end itemize
3906
3907Normally, it is necessary for the macros
3908@code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_PROLOGUE} and
3909@code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_EPILOGUE} to treat leaf functions specially.
3910The C variable @code{current_function_is_leaf} is nonzero for such a
3911function.
3912
3913@findex EXIT_IGNORE_STACK
3914@item EXIT_IGNORE_STACK
3915Define this macro as a C expression that is nonzero if the return
3916instruction or the function epilogue ignores the value of the stack
3917pointer; in other words, if it is safe to delete an instruction to
3918adjust the stack pointer before a return from the function.
3919
3920Note that this macro's value is relevant only for functions for which
3921frame pointers are maintained.  It is never safe to delete a final
3922stack adjustment in a function that has no frame pointer, and the
3923compiler knows this regardless of @code{EXIT_IGNORE_STACK}.
3924
3925@findex EPILOGUE_USES
3926@item EPILOGUE_USES (@var{regno})
3927Define this macro as a C expression that is nonzero for registers that are
3928used by the epilogue or the @samp{return} pattern.  The stack and frame
3929pointer registers are already be assumed to be used as needed.
3930
3931@findex DELAY_SLOTS_FOR_EPILOGUE
3932@item DELAY_SLOTS_FOR_EPILOGUE
3933Define this macro if the function epilogue contains delay slots to which
3934instructions from the rest of the function can be ``moved''.  The
3935definition should be a C expression whose value is an integer
3936representing the number of delay slots there.
3937
3938@findex ELIGIBLE_FOR_EPILOGUE_DELAY
3939@item ELIGIBLE_FOR_EPILOGUE_DELAY (@var{insn}, @var{n})
3940A C expression that returns 1 if @var{insn} can be placed in delay
3941slot number @var{n} of the epilogue.
3942
3943The argument @var{n} is an integer which identifies the delay slot now
3944being considered (since different slots may have different rules of
3945eligibility).  It is never negative and is always less than the number
3946of epilogue delay slots (what @code{DELAY_SLOTS_FOR_EPILOGUE} returns).
3947If you reject a particular insn for a given delay slot, in principle, it
3948may be reconsidered for a subsequent delay slot.  Also, other insns may
3949(at least in principle) be considered for the so far unfilled delay
3950slot.
3951
3952@findex current_function_epilogue_delay_list
3953@findex final_scan_insn
3954The insns accepted to fill the epilogue delay slots are put in an RTL
3955list made with @code{insn_list} objects, stored in the variable
3956@code{current_function_epilogue_delay_list}.  The insn for the first
3957delay slot comes first in the list.  Your definition of the macro
3958@code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_EPILOGUE} should fill the delay slots by
3959outputting the insns in this list, usually by calling
3960@code{final_scan_insn}.
3961
3962You need not define this macro if you did not define
3963@code{DELAY_SLOTS_FOR_EPILOGUE}.
3964
3965@findex ASM_OUTPUT_MI_THUNK
3966@item ASM_OUTPUT_MI_THUNK (@var{file}, @var{thunk_fndecl}, @var{delta}, @var{function})
3967A C compound statement that outputs the assembler code for a thunk
3968function, used to implement C++ virtual function calls with multiple
3969inheritance.  The thunk acts as a wrapper around a virtual function,
3970adjusting the implicit object parameter before handing control off to
3971the real function.
3972
3973First, emit code to add the integer @var{delta} to the location that
3974contains the incoming first argument.  Assume that this argument
3975contains a pointer, and is the one used to pass the @code{this} pointer
3976in C++.  This is the incoming argument @emph{before} the function prologue,
3977e.g.@: @samp{%o0} on a sparc.  The addition must preserve the values of
3978all other incoming arguments.
3979
3980After the addition, emit code to jump to @var{function}, which is a
3981@code{FUNCTION_DECL}.  This is a direct pure jump, not a call, and does
3982not touch the return address.  Hence returning from @var{FUNCTION} will
3983return to whoever called the current @samp{thunk}.
3984
3985The effect must be as if @var{function} had been called directly with
3986the adjusted first argument.  This macro is responsible for emitting all
3987of the code for a thunk function; @code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_PROLOGUE}
3988and @code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_EPILOGUE} are not invoked.
3989
3990The @var{thunk_fndecl} is redundant.  (@var{delta} and @var{function}
3991have already been extracted from it.)  It might possibly be useful on
3992some targets, but probably not.
3993
3994If you do not define this macro, the target-independent code in the C++
3995front end will generate a less efficient heavyweight thunk that calls
3996@var{function} instead of jumping to it.  The generic approach does
3997not support varargs.
3998@end table
3999
4000@node Profiling
4001@subsection Generating Code for Profiling
4002@cindex profiling, code generation
4003
4004These macros will help you generate code for profiling.
4005
4006@table @code
4007@findex FUNCTION_PROFILER
4008@item FUNCTION_PROFILER (@var{file}, @var{labelno})
4009A C statement or compound statement to output to @var{file} some
4010assembler code to call the profiling subroutine @code{mcount}.
4011
4012@findex mcount
4013The details of how @code{mcount} expects to be called are determined by
4014your operating system environment, not by GCC@.  To figure them out,
4015compile a small program for profiling using the system's installed C
4016compiler and look at the assembler code that results.
4017
4018Older implementations of @code{mcount} expect the address of a counter
4019variable to be loaded into some register.  The name of this variable is
4020@samp{LP} followed by the number @var{labelno}, so you would generate
4021the name using @samp{LP%d} in a @code{fprintf}.
4022
4023@findex PROFILE_HOOK
4024@item PROFILE_HOOK
4025A C statement or compound statement to output to @var{file} some assembly
4026code to call the profiling subroutine @code{mcount} even the target does
4027not support profiling.
4028
4029@findex NO_PROFILE_COUNTERS
4030@item NO_PROFILE_COUNTERS
4031Define this macro if the @code{mcount} subroutine on your system does
4032not need a counter variable allocated for each function.  This is true
4033for almost all modern implementations.  If you define this macro, you
4034must not use the @var{labelno} argument to @code{FUNCTION_PROFILER}.
4035
4036@findex PROFILE_BEFORE_PROLOGUE
4037@item PROFILE_BEFORE_PROLOGUE
4038Define this macro if the code for function profiling should come before
4039the function prologue.  Normally, the profiling code comes after.
4040
4041
4042@findex TARGET_ALLOWS_PROFILING_WITHOUT_FRAME_POINTER
4043@item TARGET_ALLOWS_PROFILING_WITHOUT_FRAME_POINTER
4044On some targets, it is impossible to use profiling when the frame
4045pointer has been omitted.  For example, on x86 GNU/Linux systems,
4046the @code{mcount} routine provided by the GNU C Library finds the
4047address of the routine that called the routine that called @code{mcount}
4048by looking in the immediate caller's stack frame.  If the immediate
4049caller has no frame pointer, this lookup will fail.
4050
4051By default, GCC assumes that the target does allow profiling when the
4052frame pointer is omitted.  This macro should be defined to a C
4053expression that evaluates to @code{false} if the target does not allow
4054profiling when the frame pointer is omitted.
4055
4056@end table
4057
4058@node Tail Calls
4059@subsection Permitting tail calls
4060@cindex tail calls
4061
4062@table @code
4063@findex FUNCTION_OK_FOR_SIBCALL
4064@item FUNCTION_OK_FOR_SIBCALL (@var{decl})
4065A C expression that evaluates to true if it is ok to perform a sibling
4066call to @var{decl} from the current function.
4067
4068It is not uncommon for limitations of calling conventions to prevent
4069tail calls to functions outside the current unit of translation, or
4070during PIC compilation.  Use this macro to enforce these restrictions,
4071as the @code{sibcall} md pattern can not fail, or fall over to a
4072``normal'' call.
4073@end table
4074
4075@node Varargs
4076@section Implementing the Varargs Macros
4077@cindex varargs implementation
4078
4079GCC comes with an implementation of @code{<varargs.h>} and
4080@code{<stdarg.h>} that work without change on machines that pass arguments
4081on the stack.  Other machines require their own implementations of
4082varargs, and the two machine independent header files must have
4083conditionals to include it.
4084
4085ISO @code{<stdarg.h>} differs from traditional @code{<varargs.h>} mainly in
4086the calling convention for @code{va_start}.  The traditional
4087implementation takes just one argument, which is the variable in which
4088to store the argument pointer.  The ISO implementation of
4089@code{va_start} takes an additional second argument.  The user is
4090supposed to write the last named argument of the function here.
4091
4092However, @code{va_start} should not use this argument.  The way to find
4093the end of the named arguments is with the built-in functions described
4094below.
4095
4096@table @code
4097@findex __builtin_saveregs
4098@item __builtin_saveregs ()
4099Use this built-in function to save the argument registers in memory so
4100that the varargs mechanism can access them.  Both ISO and traditional
4101versions of @code{va_start} must use @code{__builtin_saveregs}, unless
4102you use @code{SETUP_INCOMING_VARARGS} (see below) instead.
4103
4104On some machines, @code{__builtin_saveregs} is open-coded under the
4105control of the macro @code{EXPAND_BUILTIN_SAVEREGS}.  On other machines,
4106it calls a routine written in assembler language, found in
4107@file{libgcc2.c}.
4108
4109Code generated for the call to @code{__builtin_saveregs} appears at the
4110beginning of the function, as opposed to where the call to
4111@code{__builtin_saveregs} is written, regardless of what the code is.
4112This is because the registers must be saved before the function starts
4113to use them for its own purposes.
4114@c i rewrote the first sentence above to fix an overfull hbox. --mew
4115@c 10feb93
4116
4117@findex __builtin_args_info
4118@item __builtin_args_info (@var{category})
4119Use this built-in function to find the first anonymous arguments in
4120registers.
4121
4122In general, a machine may have several categories of registers used for
4123arguments, each for a particular category of data types.  (For example,
4124on some machines, floating-point registers are used for floating-point
4125arguments while other arguments are passed in the general registers.)
4126To make non-varargs functions use the proper calling convention, you
4127have defined the @code{CUMULATIVE_ARGS} data type to record how many
4128registers in each category have been used so far
4129
4130@code{__builtin_args_info} accesses the same data structure of type
4131@code{CUMULATIVE_ARGS} after the ordinary argument layout is finished
4132with it, with @var{category} specifying which word to access.  Thus, the
4133value indicates the first unused register in a given category.
4134
4135Normally, you would use @code{__builtin_args_info} in the implementation
4136of @code{va_start}, accessing each category just once and storing the
4137value in the @code{va_list} object.  This is because @code{va_list} will
4138have to update the values, and there is no way to alter the
4139values accessed by @code{__builtin_args_info}.
4140
4141@findex __builtin_next_arg
4142@item __builtin_next_arg (@var{lastarg})
4143This is the equivalent of @code{__builtin_args_info}, for stack
4144arguments.  It returns the address of the first anonymous stack
4145argument, as type @code{void *}.  If @code{ARGS_GROW_DOWNWARD}, it
4146returns the address of the location above the first anonymous stack
4147argument.  Use it in @code{va_start} to initialize the pointer for
4148fetching arguments from the stack.  Also use it in @code{va_start} to
4149verify that the second parameter @var{lastarg} is the last named argument
4150of the current function.
4151
4152@findex __builtin_classify_type
4153@item __builtin_classify_type (@var{object})
4154Since each machine has its own conventions for which data types are
4155passed in which kind of register, your implementation of @code{va_arg}
4156has to embody these conventions.  The easiest way to categorize the
4157specified data type is to use @code{__builtin_classify_type} together
4158with @code{sizeof} and @code{__alignof__}.
4159
4160@code{__builtin_classify_type} ignores the value of @var{object},
4161considering only its data type.  It returns an integer describing what
4162kind of type that is---integer, floating, pointer, structure, and so on.
4163
4164The file @file{typeclass.h} defines an enumeration that you can use to
4165interpret the values of @code{__builtin_classify_type}.
4166@end table
4167
4168These machine description macros help implement varargs:
4169
4170@table @code
4171@findex EXPAND_BUILTIN_SAVEREGS
4172@item EXPAND_BUILTIN_SAVEREGS ()
4173If defined, is a C expression that produces the machine-specific code
4174for a call to @code{__builtin_saveregs}.  This code will be moved to the
4175very beginning of the function, before any parameter access are made.
4176The return value of this function should be an RTX that contains the
4177value to use as the return of @code{__builtin_saveregs}.
4178
4179@findex SETUP_INCOMING_VARARGS
4180@item SETUP_INCOMING_VARARGS (@var{args_so_far}, @var{mode}, @var{type}, @var{pretend_args_size}, @var{second_time})
4181This macro offers an alternative to using @code{__builtin_saveregs} and
4182defining the macro @code{EXPAND_BUILTIN_SAVEREGS}.  Use it to store the
4183anonymous register arguments into the stack so that all the arguments
4184appear to have been passed consecutively on the stack.  Once this is
4185done, you can use the standard implementation of varargs that works for
4186machines that pass all their arguments on the stack.
4187
4188The argument @var{args_so_far} is the @code{CUMULATIVE_ARGS} data
4189structure, containing the values that are obtained after processing the
4190named arguments.  The arguments @var{mode} and @var{type} describe the
4191last named argument---its machine mode and its data type as a tree node.
4192
4193The macro implementation should do two things: first, push onto the
4194stack all the argument registers @emph{not} used for the named
4195arguments, and second, store the size of the data thus pushed into the
4196@code{int}-valued variable whose name is supplied as the argument
4197@var{pretend_args_size}.  The value that you store here will serve as
4198additional offset for setting up the stack frame.
4199
4200Because you must generate code to push the anonymous arguments at
4201compile time without knowing their data types,
4202@code{SETUP_INCOMING_VARARGS} is only useful on machines that have just
4203a single category of argument register and use it uniformly for all data
4204types.
4205
4206If the argument @var{second_time} is nonzero, it means that the
4207arguments of the function are being analyzed for the second time.  This
4208happens for an inline function, which is not actually compiled until the
4209end of the source file.  The macro @code{SETUP_INCOMING_VARARGS} should
4210not generate any instructions in this case.
4211
4212@findex STRICT_ARGUMENT_NAMING
4213@item STRICT_ARGUMENT_NAMING
4214Define this macro to be a nonzero value if the location where a function
4215argument is passed depends on whether or not it is a named argument.
4216
4217This macro controls how the @var{named} argument to @code{FUNCTION_ARG}
4218is set for varargs and stdarg functions.  If this macro returns a
4219nonzero value, the @var{named} argument is always true for named
4220arguments, and false for unnamed arguments.  If it returns a value of
4221zero, but @code{SETUP_INCOMING_VARARGS} is defined, then all arguments
4222are treated as named.  Otherwise, all named arguments except the last
4223are treated as named.
4224
4225You need not define this macro if it always returns zero.
4226
4227@findex PRETEND_OUTGOING_VARARGS_NAMED
4228@item PRETEND_OUTGOING_VARARGS_NAMED
4229If you need to conditionally change ABIs so that one works with
4230@code{SETUP_INCOMING_VARARGS}, but the other works like neither
4231@code{SETUP_INCOMING_VARARGS} nor @code{STRICT_ARGUMENT_NAMING} was
4232defined, then define this macro to return nonzero if
4233@code{SETUP_INCOMING_VARARGS} is used, zero otherwise.
4234Otherwise, you should not define this macro.
4235@end table
4236
4237@node Trampolines
4238@section Trampolines for Nested Functions
4239@cindex trampolines for nested functions
4240@cindex nested functions, trampolines for
4241
4242A @dfn{trampoline} is a small piece of code that is created at run time
4243when the address of a nested function is taken.  It normally resides on
4244the stack, in the stack frame of the containing function.  These macros
4245tell GCC how to generate code to allocate and initialize a
4246trampoline.
4247
4248The instructions in the trampoline must do two things: load a constant
4249address into the static chain register, and jump to the real address of
4250the nested function.  On CISC machines such as the m68k, this requires
4251two instructions, a move immediate and a jump.  Then the two addresses
4252exist in the trampoline as word-long immediate operands.  On RISC
4253machines, it is often necessary to load each address into a register in
4254two parts.  Then pieces of each address form separate immediate
4255operands.
4256
4257The code generated to initialize the trampoline must store the variable
4258parts---the static chain value and the function address---into the
4259immediate operands of the instructions.  On a CISC machine, this is
4260simply a matter of copying each address to a memory reference at the
4261proper offset from the start of the trampoline.  On a RISC machine, it
4262may be necessary to take out pieces of the address and store them
4263separately.
4264
4265@table @code
4266@findex TRAMPOLINE_TEMPLATE
4267@item TRAMPOLINE_TEMPLATE (@var{file})
4268A C statement to output, on the stream @var{file}, assembler code for a
4269block of data that contains the constant parts of a trampoline.  This
4270code should not include a label---the label is taken care of
4271automatically.
4272
4273If you do not define this macro, it means no template is needed
4274for the target.  Do not define this macro on systems where the block move
4275code to copy the trampoline into place would be larger than the code
4276to generate it on the spot.
4277
4278@findex TRAMPOLINE_SECTION
4279@item TRAMPOLINE_SECTION
4280The name of a subroutine to switch to the section in which the
4281trampoline template is to be placed (@pxref{Sections}).  The default is
4282a value of @samp{readonly_data_section}, which places the trampoline in
4283the section containing read-only data.
4284
4285@findex TRAMPOLINE_SIZE
4286@item TRAMPOLINE_SIZE
4287A C expression for the size in bytes of the trampoline, as an integer.
4288
4289@findex TRAMPOLINE_ALIGNMENT
4290@item TRAMPOLINE_ALIGNMENT
4291Alignment required for trampolines, in bits.
4292
4293If you don't define this macro, the value of @code{BIGGEST_ALIGNMENT}
4294is used for aligning trampolines.
4295
4296@findex INITIALIZE_TRAMPOLINE
4297@item INITIALIZE_TRAMPOLINE (@var{addr}, @var{fnaddr}, @var{static_chain})
4298A C statement to initialize the variable parts of a trampoline.
4299@var{addr} is an RTX for the address of the trampoline; @var{fnaddr} is
4300an RTX for the address of the nested function; @var{static_chain} is an
4301RTX for the static chain value that should be passed to the function
4302when it is called.
4303
4304@findex TRAMPOLINE_ADJUST_ADDRESS
4305@item TRAMPOLINE_ADJUST_ADDRESS (@var{addr})
4306A C statement that should perform any machine-specific adjustment in
4307the address of the trampoline.  Its argument contains the address that
4308was passed to @code{INITIALIZE_TRAMPOLINE}.  In case the address to be
4309used for a function call should be different from the address in which
4310the template was stored, the different address should be assigned to
4311@var{addr}.  If this macro is not defined, @var{addr} will be used for
4312function calls.
4313
4314@findex ALLOCATE_TRAMPOLINE
4315@item ALLOCATE_TRAMPOLINE (@var{fp})
4316A C expression to allocate run-time space for a trampoline.  The
4317expression value should be an RTX representing a memory reference to the
4318space for the trampoline.
4319
4320@cindex @code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_EPILOGUE} and trampolines
4321@cindex @code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_PROLOGUE} and trampolines
4322If this macro is not defined, by default the trampoline is allocated as
4323a stack slot.  This default is right for most machines.  The exceptions
4324are machines where it is impossible to execute instructions in the stack
4325area.  On such machines, you may have to implement a separate stack,
4326using this macro in conjunction with @code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_PROLOGUE}
4327and @code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_EPILOGUE}.
4328
4329@var{fp} points to a data structure, a @code{struct function}, which
4330describes the compilation status of the immediate containing function of
4331the function which the trampoline is for.  Normally (when
4332@code{ALLOCATE_TRAMPOLINE} is not defined), the stack slot for the
4333trampoline is in the stack frame of this containing function.  Other
4334allocation strategies probably must do something analogous with this
4335information.
4336@end table
4337
4338Implementing trampolines is difficult on many machines because they have
4339separate instruction and data caches.  Writing into a stack location
4340fails to clear the memory in the instruction cache, so when the program
4341jumps to that location, it executes the old contents.
4342
4343Here are two possible solutions.  One is to clear the relevant parts of
4344the instruction cache whenever a trampoline is set up.  The other is to
4345make all trampolines identical, by having them jump to a standard
4346subroutine.  The former technique makes trampoline execution faster; the
4347latter makes initialization faster.
4348
4349To clear the instruction cache when a trampoline is initialized, define
4350the following macros which describe the shape of the cache.
4351
4352@table @code
4353@findex INSN_CACHE_SIZE
4354@item INSN_CACHE_SIZE
4355The total size in bytes of the cache.
4356
4357@findex INSN_CACHE_LINE_WIDTH
4358@item INSN_CACHE_LINE_WIDTH
4359The length in bytes of each cache line.  The cache is divided into cache
4360lines which are disjoint slots, each holding a contiguous chunk of data
4361fetched from memory.  Each time data is brought into the cache, an
4362entire line is read at once.  The data loaded into a cache line is
4363always aligned on a boundary equal to the line size.
4364
4365@findex INSN_CACHE_DEPTH
4366@item INSN_CACHE_DEPTH
4367The number of alternative cache lines that can hold any particular memory
4368location.
4369@end table
4370
4371Alternatively, if the machine has system calls or instructions to clear
4372the instruction cache directly, you can define the following macro.
4373
4374@table @code
4375@findex CLEAR_INSN_CACHE
4376@item CLEAR_INSN_CACHE (@var{beg}, @var{end})
4377If defined, expands to a C expression clearing the @emph{instruction
4378cache} in the specified interval.  If it is not defined, and the macro
4379@code{INSN_CACHE_SIZE} is defined, some generic code is generated to clear the
4380cache.  The definition of this macro would typically be a series of
4381@code{asm} statements.  Both @var{beg} and @var{end} are both pointer
4382expressions.
4383@end table
4384
4385To use a standard subroutine, define the following macro.  In addition,
4386you must make sure that the instructions in a trampoline fill an entire
4387cache line with identical instructions, or else ensure that the
4388beginning of the trampoline code is always aligned at the same point in
4389its cache line.  Look in @file{m68k.h} as a guide.
4390
4391@table @code
4392@findex TRANSFER_FROM_TRAMPOLINE
4393@item TRANSFER_FROM_TRAMPOLINE
4394Define this macro if trampolines need a special subroutine to do their
4395work.  The macro should expand to a series of @code{asm} statements
4396which will be compiled with GCC@.  They go in a library function named
4397@code{__transfer_from_trampoline}.
4398
4399If you need to avoid executing the ordinary prologue code of a compiled
4400C function when you jump to the subroutine, you can do so by placing a
4401special label of your own in the assembler code.  Use one @code{asm}
4402statement to generate an assembler label, and another to make the label
4403global.  Then trampolines can use that label to jump directly to your
4404special assembler code.
4405@end table
4406
4407@node Library Calls
4408@section Implicit Calls to Library Routines
4409@cindex library subroutine names
4410@cindex @file{libgcc.a}
4411
4412@c prevent bad page break with this line
4413Here is an explanation of implicit calls to library routines.
4414
4415@table @code
4416@findex MULSI3_LIBCALL
4417@item MULSI3_LIBCALL
4418A C string constant giving the name of the function to call for
4419multiplication of one signed full-word by another.  If you do not
4420define this macro, the default name is used, which is @code{__mulsi3},
4421a function defined in @file{libgcc.a}.
4422
4423@findex DIVSI3_LIBCALL
4424@item DIVSI3_LIBCALL
4425A C string constant giving the name of the function to call for
4426division of one signed full-word by another.  If you do not define
4427this macro, the default name is used, which is @code{__divsi3}, a
4428function defined in @file{libgcc.a}.
4429
4430@findex UDIVSI3_LIBCALL
4431@item UDIVSI3_LIBCALL
4432A C string constant giving the name of the function to call for
4433division of one unsigned full-word by another.  If you do not define
4434this macro, the default name is used, which is @code{__udivsi3}, a
4435function defined in @file{libgcc.a}.
4436
4437@findex MODSI3_LIBCALL
4438@item MODSI3_LIBCALL
4439A C string constant giving the name of the function to call for the
4440remainder in division of one signed full-word by another.  If you do
4441not define this macro, the default name is used, which is
4442@code{__modsi3}, a function defined in @file{libgcc.a}.
4443
4444@findex UMODSI3_LIBCALL
4445@item UMODSI3_LIBCALL
4446A C string constant giving the name of the function to call for the
4447remainder in division of one unsigned full-word by another.  If you do
4448not define this macro, the default name is used, which is
4449@code{__umodsi3}, a function defined in @file{libgcc.a}.
4450
4451@findex MULDI3_LIBCALL
4452@item MULDI3_LIBCALL
4453A C string constant giving the name of the function to call for
4454multiplication of one signed double-word by another.  If you do not
4455define this macro, the default name is used, which is @code{__muldi3},
4456a function defined in @file{libgcc.a}.
4457
4458@findex DIVDI3_LIBCALL
4459@item DIVDI3_LIBCALL
4460A C string constant giving the name of the function to call for
4461division of one signed double-word by another.  If you do not define
4462this macro, the default name is used, which is @code{__divdi3}, a
4463function defined in @file{libgcc.a}.
4464
4465@findex UDIVDI3_LIBCALL
4466@item UDIVDI3_LIBCALL
4467A C string constant giving the name of the function to call for
4468division of one unsigned full-word by another.  If you do not define
4469this macro, the default name is used, which is @code{__udivdi3}, a
4470function defined in @file{libgcc.a}.
4471
4472@findex MODDI3_LIBCALL
4473@item MODDI3_LIBCALL
4474A C string constant giving the name of the function to call for the
4475remainder in division of one signed double-word by another.  If you do
4476not define this macro, the default name is used, which is
4477@code{__moddi3}, a function defined in @file{libgcc.a}.
4478
4479@findex UMODDI3_LIBCALL
4480@item UMODDI3_LIBCALL
4481A C string constant giving the name of the function to call for the
4482remainder in division of one unsigned full-word by another.  If you do
4483not define this macro, the default name is used, which is
4484@code{__umoddi3}, a function defined in @file{libgcc.a}.
4485
4486@findex INIT_TARGET_OPTABS
4487@item INIT_TARGET_OPTABS
4488Define this macro as a C statement that declares additional library
4489routines renames existing ones.  @code{init_optabs} calls this macro after
4490initializing all the normal library routines.
4491
4492@findex FLOAT_LIB_COMPARE_RETURNS_BOOL (@var{mode}, @var{comparison})
4493@item FLOAT_LIB_COMPARE_RETURNS_BOOL
4494Define this macro as a C statement that returns nonzero if a call to
4495the floating point comparison library function will return a boolean
4496value that indicates the result of the comparison.  It should return
4497zero if one of gcc's own libgcc functions is called.
4498
4499Most ports don't need to define this macro.
4500
4501@findex TARGET_EDOM
4502@cindex @code{EDOM}, implicit usage
4503@item TARGET_EDOM
4504The value of @code{EDOM} on the target machine, as a C integer constant
4505expression.  If you don't define this macro, GCC does not attempt to
4506deposit the value of @code{EDOM} into @code{errno} directly.  Look in
4507@file{/usr/include/errno.h} to find the value of @code{EDOM} on your
4508system.
4509
4510If you do not define @code{TARGET_EDOM}, then compiled code reports
4511domain errors by calling the library function and letting it report the
4512error.  If mathematical functions on your system use @code{matherr} when
4513there is an error, then you should leave @code{TARGET_EDOM} undefined so
4514that @code{matherr} is used normally.
4515
4516@findex GEN_ERRNO_RTX
4517@cindex @code{errno}, implicit usage
4518@item GEN_ERRNO_RTX
4519Define this macro as a C expression to create an rtl expression that
4520refers to the global ``variable'' @code{errno}.  (On certain systems,
4521@code{errno} may not actually be a variable.)  If you don't define this
4522macro, a reasonable default is used.
4523
4524@findex TARGET_MEM_FUNCTIONS
4525@cindex @code{bcopy}, implicit usage
4526@cindex @code{memcpy}, implicit usage
4527@cindex @code{memmove}, implicit usage
4528@cindex @code{bzero}, implicit usage
4529@cindex @code{memset}, implicit usage
4530@item TARGET_MEM_FUNCTIONS
4531Define this macro if GCC should generate calls to the ISO C
4532(and System V) library functions @code{memcpy}, @code{memmove} and
4533@code{memset} rather than the BSD functions @code{bcopy} and @code{bzero}.
4534
4535@findex LIBGCC_NEEDS_DOUBLE
4536@item LIBGCC_NEEDS_DOUBLE
4537Define this macro if @code{float} arguments cannot be passed to library
4538routines (so they must be converted to @code{double}).  This macro
4539affects both how library calls are generated and how the library
4540routines in @file{libgcc.a} accept their arguments.  It is useful on
4541machines where floating and fixed point arguments are passed
4542differently, such as the i860.
4543
4544@findex NEXT_OBJC_RUNTIME
4545@item NEXT_OBJC_RUNTIME
4546Define this macro to generate code for Objective-C message sending using
4547the calling convention of the NeXT system.  This calling convention
4548involves passing the object, the selector and the method arguments all
4549at once to the method-lookup library function.
4550
4551The default calling convention passes just the object and the selector
4552to the lookup function, which returns a pointer to the method.
4553@end table
4554
4555@node Addressing Modes
4556@section Addressing Modes
4557@cindex addressing modes
4558
4559@c prevent bad page break with this line
4560This is about addressing modes.
4561
4562@table @code
4563@findex HAVE_PRE_INCREMENT
4564@findex HAVE_PRE_DECREMENT
4565@findex HAVE_POST_INCREMENT
4566@findex HAVE_POST_DECREMENT
4567@item HAVE_PRE_INCREMENT
4568@itemx HAVE_PRE_DECREMENT
4569@itemx HAVE_POST_INCREMENT
4570@itemx HAVE_POST_DECREMENT
4571A C expression that is nonzero if the machine supports pre-increment,
4572pre-decrement, post-increment, or post-decrement addressing respectively.
4573
4574@findex HAVE_POST_MODIFY_DISP
4575@findex HAVE_PRE_MODIFY_DISP
4576@item HAVE_PRE_MODIFY_DISP
4577@itemx HAVE_POST_MODIFY_DISP
4578A C expression that is nonzero if the machine supports pre- or
4579post-address side-effect generation involving constants other than
4580the size of the memory operand.
4581
4582@findex HAVE_POST_MODIFY_REG
4583@findex HAVE_PRE_MODIFY_REG
4584@item HAVE_PRE_MODIFY_REG
4585@itemx HAVE_POST_MODIFY_REG
4586A C expression that is nonzero if the machine supports pre- or
4587post-address side-effect generation involving a register displacement.
4588
4589@findex CONSTANT_ADDRESS_P
4590@item CONSTANT_ADDRESS_P (@var{x})
4591A C expression that is 1 if the RTX @var{x} is a constant which
4592is a valid address.  On most machines, this can be defined as
4593@code{CONSTANT_P (@var{x})}, but a few machines are more restrictive
4594in which constant addresses are supported.
4595
4596@findex CONSTANT_P
4597@code{CONSTANT_P} accepts integer-values expressions whose values are
4598not explicitly known, such as @code{symbol_ref}, @code{label_ref}, and
4599@code{high} expressions and @code{const} arithmetic expressions, in
4600addition to @code{const_int} and @code{const_double} expressions.
4601
4602@findex MAX_REGS_PER_ADDRESS
4603@item MAX_REGS_PER_ADDRESS
4604A number, the maximum number of registers that can appear in a valid
4605memory address.  Note that it is up to you to specify a value equal to
4606the maximum number that @code{GO_IF_LEGITIMATE_ADDRESS} would ever
4607accept.
4608
4609@findex GO_IF_LEGITIMATE_ADDRESS
4610@item GO_IF_LEGITIMATE_ADDRESS (@var{mode}, @var{x}, @var{label})
4611A C compound statement with a conditional @code{goto @var{label};}
4612executed if @var{x} (an RTX) is a legitimate memory address on the
4613target machine for a memory operand of mode @var{mode}.
4614
4615It usually pays to define several simpler macros to serve as
4616subroutines for this one.  Otherwise it may be too complicated to
4617understand.
4618
4619This macro must exist in two variants: a strict variant and a
4620non-strict one.  The strict variant is used in the reload pass.  It
4621must be defined so that any pseudo-register that has not been
4622allocated a hard register is considered a memory reference.  In
4623contexts where some kind of register is required, a pseudo-register
4624with no hard register must be rejected.
4625
4626The non-strict variant is used in other passes.  It must be defined to
4627accept all pseudo-registers in every context where some kind of
4628register is required.
4629
4630@findex REG_OK_STRICT
4631Compiler source files that want to use the strict variant of this
4632macro define the macro @code{REG_OK_STRICT}.  You should use an
4633@code{#ifdef REG_OK_STRICT} conditional to define the strict variant
4634in that case and the non-strict variant otherwise.
4635
4636Subroutines to check for acceptable registers for various purposes (one
4637for base registers, one for index registers, and so on) are typically
4638among the subroutines used to define @code{GO_IF_LEGITIMATE_ADDRESS}.
4639Then only these subroutine macros need have two variants; the higher
4640levels of macros may be the same whether strict or not.
4641
4642Normally, constant addresses which are the sum of a @code{symbol_ref}
4643and an integer are stored inside a @code{const} RTX to mark them as
4644constant.  Therefore, there is no need to recognize such sums
4645specifically as legitimate addresses.  Normally you would simply
4646recognize any @code{const} as legitimate.
4647
4648Usually @code{PRINT_OPERAND_ADDRESS} is not prepared to handle constant
4649sums that are not marked with  @code{const}.  It assumes that a naked
4650@code{plus} indicates indexing.  If so, then you @emph{must} reject such
4651naked constant sums as illegitimate addresses, so that none of them will
4652be given to @code{PRINT_OPERAND_ADDRESS}.
4653
4654@cindex @code{ENCODE_SECTION_INFO} and address validation
4655On some machines, whether a symbolic address is legitimate depends on
4656the section that the address refers to.  On these machines, define the
4657macro @code{ENCODE_SECTION_INFO} to store the information into the
4658@code{symbol_ref}, and then check for it here.  When you see a
4659@code{const}, you will have to look inside it to find the
4660@code{symbol_ref} in order to determine the section.  @xref{Assembler
4661Format}.
4662
4663@findex saveable_obstack
4664The best way to modify the name string is by adding text to the
4665beginning, with suitable punctuation to prevent any ambiguity.  Allocate
4666the new name in @code{saveable_obstack}.  You will have to modify
4667@code{ASM_OUTPUT_LABELREF} to remove and decode the added text and
4668output the name accordingly, and define @code{STRIP_NAME_ENCODING} to
4669access the original name string.
4670
4671You can check the information stored here into the @code{symbol_ref} in
4672the definitions of the macros @code{GO_IF_LEGITIMATE_ADDRESS} and
4673@code{PRINT_OPERAND_ADDRESS}.
4674
4675@findex REG_OK_FOR_BASE_P
4676@item REG_OK_FOR_BASE_P (@var{x})
4677A C expression that is nonzero if @var{x} (assumed to be a @code{reg}
4678RTX) is valid for use as a base register.  For hard registers, it
4679should always accept those which the hardware permits and reject the
4680others.  Whether the macro accepts or rejects pseudo registers must be
4681controlled by @code{REG_OK_STRICT} as described above.  This usually
4682requires two variant definitions, of which @code{REG_OK_STRICT}
4683controls the one actually used.
4684
4685@findex REG_MODE_OK_FOR_BASE_P
4686@item REG_MODE_OK_FOR_BASE_P (@var{x}, @var{mode})
4687A C expression that is just like @code{REG_OK_FOR_BASE_P}, except that
4688that expression may examine the mode of the memory reference in
4689@var{mode}.  You should define this macro if the mode of the memory
4690reference affects whether a register may be used as a base register.  If
4691you define this macro, the compiler will use it instead of
4692@code{REG_OK_FOR_BASE_P}.
4693
4694@findex REG_OK_FOR_INDEX_P
4695@item REG_OK_FOR_INDEX_P (@var{x})
4696A C expression that is nonzero if @var{x} (assumed to be a @code{reg}
4697RTX) is valid for use as an index register.
4698
4699The difference between an index register and a base register is that
4700the index register may be scaled.  If an address involves the sum of
4701two registers, neither one of them scaled, then either one may be
4702labeled the ``base'' and the other the ``index''; but whichever
4703labeling is used must fit the machine's constraints of which registers
4704may serve in each capacity.  The compiler will try both labelings,
4705looking for one that is valid, and will reload one or both registers
4706only if neither labeling works.
4707
4708@findex FIND_BASE_TERM
4709@item FIND_BASE_TERM (@var{x})
4710A C expression to determine the base term of address @var{x}.
4711This macro is used in only one place: `find_base_term' in alias.c.
4712
4713It is always safe for this macro to not be defined.  It exists so
4714that alias analysis can understand machine-dependent addresses.
4715
4716The typical use of this macro is to handle addresses containing
4717a label_ref or symbol_ref within an UNSPEC@.
4718
4719@findex LEGITIMIZE_ADDRESS
4720@item LEGITIMIZE_ADDRESS (@var{x}, @var{oldx}, @var{mode}, @var{win})
4721A C compound statement that attempts to replace @var{x} with a valid
4722memory address for an operand of mode @var{mode}.  @var{win} will be a
4723C statement label elsewhere in the code; the macro definition may use
4724
4725@example
4726GO_IF_LEGITIMATE_ADDRESS (@var{mode}, @var{x}, @var{win});
4727@end example
4728
4729@noindent
4730to avoid further processing if the address has become legitimate.
4731
4732@findex break_out_memory_refs
4733@var{x} will always be the result of a call to @code{break_out_memory_refs},
4734and @var{oldx} will be the operand that was given to that function to produce
4735@var{x}.
4736
4737The code generated by this macro should not alter the substructure of
4738@var{x}.  If it transforms @var{x} into a more legitimate form, it
4739should assign @var{x} (which will always be a C variable) a new value.
4740
4741It is not necessary for this macro to come up with a legitimate
4742address.  The compiler has standard ways of doing so in all cases.  In
4743fact, it is safe for this macro to do nothing.  But often a
4744machine-dependent strategy can generate better code.
4745
4746@findex LEGITIMIZE_RELOAD_ADDRESS
4747@item LEGITIMIZE_RELOAD_ADDRESS (@var{x}, @var{mode}, @var{opnum}, @var{type}, @var{ind_levels}, @var{win})
4748A C compound statement that attempts to replace @var{x}, which is an address
4749that needs reloading, with a valid memory address for an operand of mode
4750@var{mode}.  @var{win} will be a C statement label elsewhere in the code.
4751It is not necessary to define this macro, but it might be useful for
4752performance reasons.
4753
4754For example, on the i386, it is sometimes possible to use a single
4755reload register instead of two by reloading a sum of two pseudo
4756registers into a register.  On the other hand, for number of RISC
4757processors offsets are limited so that often an intermediate address
4758needs to be generated in order to address a stack slot.  By defining
4759@code{LEGITIMIZE_RELOAD_ADDRESS} appropriately, the intermediate addresses
4760generated for adjacent some stack slots can be made identical, and thus
4761be shared.
4762
4763@emph{Note}: This macro should be used with caution.  It is necessary
4764to know something of how reload works in order to effectively use this,
4765and it is quite easy to produce macros that build in too much knowledge
4766of reload internals.
4767
4768@emph{Note}: This macro must be able to reload an address created by a
4769previous invocation of this macro.  If it fails to handle such addresses
4770then the compiler may generate incorrect code or abort.
4771
4772@findex push_reload
4773The macro definition should use @code{push_reload} to indicate parts that
4774need reloading; @var{opnum}, @var{type} and @var{ind_levels} are usually
4775suitable to be passed unaltered to @code{push_reload}.
4776
4777The code generated by this macro must not alter the substructure of
4778@var{x}.  If it transforms @var{x} into a more legitimate form, it
4779should assign @var{x} (which will always be a C variable) a new value.
4780This also applies to parts that you change indirectly by calling
4781@code{push_reload}.
4782
4783@findex strict_memory_address_p
4784The macro definition may use @code{strict_memory_address_p} to test if
4785the address has become legitimate.
4786
4787@findex copy_rtx
4788If you want to change only a part of @var{x}, one standard way of doing
4789this is to use @code{copy_rtx}.  Note, however, that is unshares only a
4790single level of rtl.  Thus, if the part to be changed is not at the
4791top level, you'll need to replace first the top level.
4792It is not necessary for this macro to come up with a legitimate
4793address;  but often a machine-dependent strategy can generate better code.
4794
4795@findex GO_IF_MODE_DEPENDENT_ADDRESS
4796@item GO_IF_MODE_DEPENDENT_ADDRESS (@var{addr}, @var{label})
4797A C statement or compound statement with a conditional @code{goto
4798@var{label};} executed if memory address @var{x} (an RTX) can have
4799different meanings depending on the machine mode of the memory
4800reference it is used for or if the address is valid for some modes
4801but not others.
4802
4803Autoincrement and autodecrement addresses typically have mode-dependent
4804effects because the amount of the increment or decrement is the size
4805of the operand being addressed.  Some machines have other mode-dependent
4806addresses.  Many RISC machines have no mode-dependent addresses.
4807
4808You may assume that @var{addr} is a valid address for the machine.
4809
4810@findex LEGITIMATE_CONSTANT_P
4811@item LEGITIMATE_CONSTANT_P (@var{x})
4812A C expression that is nonzero if @var{x} is a legitimate constant for
4813an immediate operand on the target machine.  You can assume that
4814@var{x} satisfies @code{CONSTANT_P}, so you need not check this.  In fact,
4815@samp{1} is a suitable definition for this macro on machines where
4816anything @code{CONSTANT_P} is valid.
4817@end table
4818
4819@node Condition Code
4820@section Condition Code Status
4821@cindex condition code status
4822
4823@c prevent bad page break with this line
4824This describes the condition code status.
4825
4826@findex cc_status
4827The file @file{conditions.h} defines a variable @code{cc_status} to
4828describe how the condition code was computed (in case the interpretation of
4829the condition code depends on the instruction that it was set by).  This
4830variable contains the RTL expressions on which the condition code is
4831currently based, and several standard flags.
4832
4833Sometimes additional machine-specific flags must be defined in the machine
4834description header file.  It can also add additional machine-specific
4835information by defining @code{CC_STATUS_MDEP}.
4836
4837@table @code
4838@findex CC_STATUS_MDEP
4839@item CC_STATUS_MDEP
4840C code for a data type which is used for declaring the @code{mdep}
4841component of @code{cc_status}.  It defaults to @code{int}.
4842
4843This macro is not used on machines that do not use @code{cc0}.
4844
4845@findex CC_STATUS_MDEP_INIT
4846@item CC_STATUS_MDEP_INIT
4847A C expression to initialize the @code{mdep} field to ``empty''.
4848The default definition does nothing, since most machines don't use
4849the field anyway.  If you want to use the field, you should probably
4850define this macro to initialize it.
4851
4852This macro is not used on machines that do not use @code{cc0}.
4853
4854@findex NOTICE_UPDATE_CC
4855@item NOTICE_UPDATE_CC (@var{exp}, @var{insn})
4856A C compound statement to set the components of @code{cc_status}
4857appropriately for an insn @var{insn} whose body is @var{exp}.  It is
4858this macro's responsibility to recognize insns that set the condition
4859code as a byproduct of other activity as well as those that explicitly
4860set @code{(cc0)}.
4861
4862This macro is not used on machines that do not use @code{cc0}.
4863
4864If there are insns that do not set the condition code but do alter
4865other machine registers, this macro must check to see whether they
4866invalidate the expressions that the condition code is recorded as
4867reflecting.  For example, on the 68000, insns that store in address
4868registers do not set the condition code, which means that usually
4869@code{NOTICE_UPDATE_CC} can leave @code{cc_status} unaltered for such
4870insns.  But suppose that the previous insn set the condition code
4871based on location @samp{a4@@(102)} and the current insn stores a new
4872value in @samp{a4}.  Although the condition code is not changed by
4873this, it will no longer be true that it reflects the contents of
4874@samp{a4@@(102)}.  Therefore, @code{NOTICE_UPDATE_CC} must alter
4875@code{cc_status} in this case to say that nothing is known about the
4876condition code value.
4877
4878The definition of @code{NOTICE_UPDATE_CC} must be prepared to deal
4879with the results of peephole optimization: insns whose patterns are
4880@code{parallel} RTXs containing various @code{reg}, @code{mem} or
4881constants which are just the operands.  The RTL structure of these
4882insns is not sufficient to indicate what the insns actually do.  What
4883@code{NOTICE_UPDATE_CC} should do when it sees one is just to run
4884@code{CC_STATUS_INIT}.
4885
4886A possible definition of @code{NOTICE_UPDATE_CC} is to call a function
4887that looks at an attribute (@pxref{Insn Attributes}) named, for example,
4888@samp{cc}.  This avoids having detailed information about patterns in
4889two places, the @file{md} file and in @code{NOTICE_UPDATE_CC}.
4890
4891@findex EXTRA_CC_MODES
4892@item EXTRA_CC_MODES
4893A list of additional modes for condition code values in registers
4894(@pxref{Jump Patterns}).  This macro should expand to a sequence of
4895calls of the macro @code{CC} separated by white space.  @code{CC} takes
4896two arguments.  The first is the enumeration name of the mode, which
4897should begin with @samp{CC} and end with @samp{mode}.  The second is a C
4898string giving the printable name of the mode; it should be the same as
4899the first argument, but with the trailing @samp{mode} removed.
4900
4901You should only define this macro if additional modes are required.
4902
4903A sample definition of @code{EXTRA_CC_MODES} is:
4904@smallexample
4905#define EXTRA_CC_MODES            \
4906    CC(CC_NOOVmode, "CC_NOOV")    \
4907    CC(CCFPmode, "CCFP")          \
4908    CC(CCFPEmode, "CCFPE")
4909@end smallexample
4910
4911@findex SELECT_CC_MODE
4912@item SELECT_CC_MODE (@var{op}, @var{x}, @var{y})
4913Returns a mode from class @code{MODE_CC} to be used when comparison
4914operation code @var{op} is applied to rtx @var{x} and @var{y}.  For
4915example, on the Sparc, @code{SELECT_CC_MODE} is defined as (see
4916@pxref{Jump Patterns} for a description of the reason for this
4917definition)
4918
4919@smallexample
4920#define SELECT_CC_MODE(OP,X,Y) \
4921  (GET_MODE_CLASS (GET_MODE (X)) == MODE_FLOAT          \
4922   ? ((OP == EQ || OP == NE) ? CCFPmode : CCFPEmode)    \
4923   : ((GET_CODE (X) == PLUS || GET_CODE (X) == MINUS    \
4924       || GET_CODE (X) == NEG) \
4925      ? CC_NOOVmode : CCmode))
4926@end smallexample
4927
4928You need not define this macro if @code{EXTRA_CC_MODES} is not defined.
4929
4930@findex CANONICALIZE_COMPARISON
4931@item CANONICALIZE_COMPARISON (@var{code}, @var{op0}, @var{op1})
4932On some machines not all possible comparisons are defined, but you can
4933convert an invalid comparison into a valid one.  For example, the Alpha
4934does not have a @code{GT} comparison, but you can use an @code{LT}
4935comparison instead and swap the order of the operands.
4936
4937On such machines, define this macro to be a C statement to do any
4938required conversions.  @var{code} is the initial comparison code
4939and @var{op0} and @var{op1} are the left and right operands of the
4940comparison, respectively.  You should modify @var{code}, @var{op0}, and
4941@var{op1} as required.
4942
4943GCC will not assume that the comparison resulting from this macro is
4944valid but will see if the resulting insn matches a pattern in the
4945@file{md} file.
4946
4947You need not define this macro if it would never change the comparison
4948code or operands.
4949
4950@findex REVERSIBLE_CC_MODE
4951@item REVERSIBLE_CC_MODE (@var{mode})
4952A C expression whose value is one if it is always safe to reverse a
4953comparison whose mode is @var{mode}.  If @code{SELECT_CC_MODE}
4954can ever return @var{mode} for a floating-point inequality comparison,
4955then @code{REVERSIBLE_CC_MODE (@var{mode})} must be zero.
4956
4957You need not define this macro if it would always returns zero or if the
4958floating-point format is anything other than @code{IEEE_FLOAT_FORMAT}.
4959For example, here is the definition used on the Sparc, where floating-point
4960inequality comparisons are always given @code{CCFPEmode}:
4961
4962@smallexample
4963#define REVERSIBLE_CC_MODE(MODE)  ((MODE) != CCFPEmode)
4964@end smallexample
4965
4966@findex REVERSE_CONDITION (@var{code}, @var{mode})
4967A C expression whose value is reversed condition code of the @var{code} for
4968comparison done in CC_MODE @var{mode}.  The macro is used only in case
4969@code{REVERSIBLE_CC_MODE (@var{mode})} is nonzero.  Define this macro in case
4970machine has some non-standard way how to reverse certain conditionals.  For
4971instance in case all floating point conditions are non-trapping, compiler may
4972freely convert unordered compares to ordered one.  Then definition may look
4973like:
4974
4975@smallexample
4976#define REVERSE_CONDITION(CODE, MODE) \
4977   ((MODE) != CCFPmode ? reverse_condition (CODE) \
4978    : reverse_condition_maybe_unordered (CODE))
4979@end smallexample
4980
4981@findex REVERSE_CONDEXEC_PREDICATES_P
4982@item REVERSE_CONDEXEC_PREDICATES_P (@var{code1}, @var{code2})
4983A C expression that returns true if the conditional execution predicate
4984@var{code1} is the inverse of @var{code2} and vice versa.  Define this to
4985return 0 if the target has conditional execution predicates that cannot be
4986reversed safely.  If no expansion is specified, this macro is defined as
4987follows:
4988
4989@smallexample
4990#define REVERSE_CONDEXEC_PREDICATES_P (x, y) \
4991   ((x) == reverse_condition (y))
4992@end smallexample
4993
4994@end table
4995
4996@node Costs
4997@section Describing Relative Costs of Operations
4998@cindex costs of instructions
4999@cindex relative costs
5000@cindex speed of instructions
5001
5002These macros let you describe the relative speed of various operations
5003on the target machine.
5004
5005@table @code
5006@findex CONST_COSTS
5007@item CONST_COSTS (@var{x}, @var{code}, @var{outer_code})
5008A part of a C @code{switch} statement that describes the relative costs
5009of constant RTL expressions.  It must contain @code{case} labels for
5010expression codes @code{const_int}, @code{const}, @code{symbol_ref},
5011@code{label_ref} and @code{const_double}.  Each case must ultimately
5012reach a @code{return} statement to return the relative cost of the use
5013of that kind of constant value in an expression.  The cost may depend on
5014the precise value of the constant, which is available for examination in
5015@var{x}, and the rtx code of the expression in which it is contained,
5016found in @var{outer_code}.
5017
5018@var{code} is the expression code---redundant, since it can be
5019obtained with @code{GET_CODE (@var{x})}.
5020
5021@findex RTX_COSTS
5022@findex COSTS_N_INSNS
5023@item RTX_COSTS (@var{x}, @var{code}, @var{outer_code})
5024Like @code{CONST_COSTS} but applies to nonconstant RTL expressions.
5025This can be used, for example, to indicate how costly a multiply
5026instruction is.  In writing this macro, you can use the construct
5027@code{COSTS_N_INSNS (@var{n})} to specify a cost equal to @var{n} fast
5028instructions.  @var{outer_code} is the code of the expression in which
5029@var{x} is contained.
5030
5031This macro is optional; do not define it if the default cost assumptions
5032are adequate for the target machine.
5033
5034@findex DEFAULT_RTX_COSTS
5035@item DEFAULT_RTX_COSTS (@var{x}, @var{code}, @var{outer_code})
5036This macro, if defined, is called for any case not handled by the
5037@code{RTX_COSTS} or @code{CONST_COSTS} macros.  This eliminates the need
5038to put case labels into the macro, but the code, or any functions it
5039calls, must assume that the RTL in @var{x} could be of any type that has
5040not already been handled.  The arguments are the same as for
5041@code{RTX_COSTS}, and the macro should execute a return statement giving
5042the cost of any RTL expressions that it can handle.  The default cost
5043calculation is used for any RTL for which this macro does not return a
5044value.
5045
5046This macro is optional; do not define it if the default cost assumptions
5047are adequate for the target machine.
5048
5049@findex ADDRESS_COST
5050@item ADDRESS_COST (@var{address})
5051An expression giving the cost of an addressing mode that contains
5052@var{address}.  If not defined, the cost is computed from
5053the @var{address} expression and the @code{CONST_COSTS} values.
5054
5055For most CISC machines, the default cost is a good approximation of the
5056true cost of the addressing mode.  However, on RISC machines, all
5057instructions normally have the same length and execution time.  Hence
5058all addresses will have equal costs.
5059
5060In cases where more than one form of an address is known, the form with
5061the lowest cost will be used.  If multiple forms have the same, lowest,
5062cost, the one that is the most complex will be used.
5063
5064For example, suppose an address that is equal to the sum of a register
5065and a constant is used twice in the same basic block.  When this macro
5066is not defined, the address will be computed in a register and memory
5067references will be indirect through that register.  On machines where
5068the cost of the addressing mode containing the sum is no higher than
5069that of a simple indirect reference, this will produce an additional
5070instruction and possibly require an additional register.  Proper
5071specification of this macro eliminates this overhead for such machines.
5072
5073Similar use of this macro is made in strength reduction of loops.
5074
5075@var{address} need not be valid as an address.  In such a case, the cost
5076is not relevant and can be any value; invalid addresses need not be
5077assigned a different cost.
5078
5079On machines where an address involving more than one register is as
5080cheap as an address computation involving only one register, defining
5081@code{ADDRESS_COST} to reflect this can cause two registers to be live
5082over a region of code where only one would have been if
5083@code{ADDRESS_COST} were not defined in that manner.  This effect should
5084be considered in the definition of this macro.  Equivalent costs should
5085probably only be given to addresses with different numbers of registers
5086on machines with lots of registers.
5087
5088This macro will normally either not be defined or be defined as a
5089constant.
5090
5091@findex REGISTER_MOVE_COST
5092@item REGISTER_MOVE_COST (@var{mode}, @var{from}, @var{to})
5093A C expression for the cost of moving data of mode @var{mode} from a
5094register in class @var{from} to one in class @var{to}.  The classes are
5095expressed using the enumeration values such as @code{GENERAL_REGS}.  A
5096value of 2 is the default; other values are interpreted relative to
5097that.
5098
5099It is not required that the cost always equal 2 when @var{from} is the
5100same as @var{to}; on some machines it is expensive to move between
5101registers if they are not general registers.
5102
5103If reload sees an insn consisting of a single @code{set} between two
5104hard registers, and if @code{REGISTER_MOVE_COST} applied to their
5105classes returns a value of 2, reload does not check to ensure that the
5106constraints of the insn are met.  Setting a cost of other than 2 will
5107allow reload to verify that the constraints are met.  You should do this
5108if the @samp{mov@var{m}} pattern's constraints do not allow such copying.
5109
5110@findex MEMORY_MOVE_COST
5111@item MEMORY_MOVE_COST (@var{mode}, @var{class}, @var{in})
5112A C expression for the cost of moving data of mode @var{mode} between a
5113register of class @var{class} and memory; @var{in} is zero if the value
5114is to be written to memory, nonzero if it is to be read in.  This cost
5115is relative to those in @code{REGISTER_MOVE_COST}.  If moving between
5116registers and memory is more expensive than between two registers, you
5117should define this macro to express the relative cost.
5118
5119If you do not define this macro, GCC uses a default cost of 4 plus
5120the cost of copying via a secondary reload register, if one is
5121needed.  If your machine requires a secondary reload register to copy
5122between memory and a register of @var{class} but the reload mechanism is
5123more complex than copying via an intermediate, define this macro to
5124reflect the actual cost of the move.
5125
5126GCC defines the function @code{memory_move_secondary_cost} if
5127secondary reloads are needed.  It computes the costs due to copying via
5128a secondary register.  If your machine copies from memory using a
5129secondary register in the conventional way but the default base value of
51304 is not correct for your machine, define this macro to add some other
5131value to the result of that function.  The arguments to that function
5132are the same as to this macro.
5133
5134@findex BRANCH_COST
5135@item BRANCH_COST
5136A C expression for the cost of a branch instruction.  A value of 1 is
5137the default; other values are interpreted relative to that.
5138@end table
5139
5140Here are additional macros which do not specify precise relative costs,
5141but only that certain actions are more expensive than GCC would
5142ordinarily expect.
5143
5144@table @code
5145@findex SLOW_BYTE_ACCESS
5146@item SLOW_BYTE_ACCESS
5147Define this macro as a C expression which is nonzero if accessing less
5148than a word of memory (i.e.@: a @code{char} or a @code{short}) is no
5149faster than accessing a word of memory, i.e., if such access
5150require more than one instruction or if there is no difference in cost
5151between byte and (aligned) word loads.
5152
5153When this macro is not defined, the compiler will access a field by
5154finding the smallest containing object; when it is defined, a fullword
5155load will be used if alignment permits.  Unless bytes accesses are
5156faster than word accesses, using word accesses is preferable since it
5157may eliminate subsequent memory access if subsequent accesses occur to
5158other fields in the same word of the structure, but to different bytes.
5159
5160@findex SLOW_UNALIGNED_ACCESS
5161@item SLOW_UNALIGNED_ACCESS (@var{mode}, @var{alignment})
5162Define this macro to be the value 1 if memory accesses described by the
5163@var{mode} and @var{alignment} parameters have a cost many times greater
5164than aligned accesses, for example if they are emulated in a trap
5165handler.
5166
5167When this macro is nonzero, the compiler will act as if
5168@code{STRICT_ALIGNMENT} were nonzero when generating code for block
5169moves.  This can cause significantly more instructions to be produced.
5170Therefore, do not set this macro nonzero if unaligned accesses only add a
5171cycle or two to the time for a memory access.
5172
5173If the value of this macro is always zero, it need not be defined.  If
5174this macro is defined, it should produce a nonzero value when
5175@code{STRICT_ALIGNMENT} is nonzero.
5176
5177@findex DONT_REDUCE_ADDR
5178@item DONT_REDUCE_ADDR
5179Define this macro to inhibit strength reduction of memory addresses.
5180(On some machines, such strength reduction seems to do harm rather
5181than good.)
5182
5183@findex MOVE_RATIO
5184@item MOVE_RATIO
5185The threshold of number of scalar memory-to-memory move insns, @emph{below}
5186which a sequence of insns should be generated instead of a
5187string move insn or a library call.  Increasing the value will always
5188make code faster, but eventually incurs high cost in increased code size.
5189
5190Note that on machines where the corresponding move insn is a
5191@code{define_expand} that emits a sequence of insns, this macro counts
5192the number of such sequences.
5193
5194If you don't define this, a reasonable default is used.
5195
5196@findex MOVE_BY_PIECES_P
5197@item MOVE_BY_PIECES_P (@var{size}, @var{alignment})
5198A C expression used to determine whether @code{move_by_pieces} will be used to
5199copy a chunk of memory, or whether some other block move mechanism
5200will be used.  Defaults to 1 if @code{move_by_pieces_ninsns} returns less
5201than @code{MOVE_RATIO}.
5202
5203@findex MOVE_MAX_PIECES
5204@item MOVE_MAX_PIECES
5205A C expression used by @code{move_by_pieces} to determine the largest unit
5206a load or store used to copy memory is.  Defaults to @code{MOVE_MAX}.
5207
5208@findex USE_LOAD_POST_INCREMENT
5209@item USE_LOAD_POST_INCREMENT (@var{mode})
5210A C expression used to determine whether a load postincrement is a good
5211thing to use for a given mode.  Defaults to the value of
5212@code{HAVE_POST_INCREMENT}.
5213
5214@findex USE_LOAD_POST_DECREMENT
5215@item USE_LOAD_POST_DECREMENT (@var{mode})
5216A C expression used to determine whether a load postdecrement is a good
5217thing to use for a given mode.  Defaults to the value of
5218@code{HAVE_POST_DECREMENT}.
5219
5220@findex USE_LOAD_PRE_INCREMENT
5221@item USE_LOAD_PRE_INCREMENT (@var{mode})
5222A C expression used to determine whether a load preincrement is a good
5223thing to use for a given mode.  Defaults to the value of
5224@code{HAVE_PRE_INCREMENT}.
5225
5226@findex USE_LOAD_PRE_DECREMENT
5227@item USE_LOAD_PRE_DECREMENT (@var{mode})
5228A C expression used to determine whether a load predecrement is a good
5229thing to use for a given mode.  Defaults to the value of
5230@code{HAVE_PRE_DECREMENT}.
5231
5232@findex USE_STORE_POST_INCREMENT
5233@item USE_STORE_POST_INCREMENT (@var{mode})
5234A C expression used to determine whether a store postincrement is a good
5235thing to use for a given mode.  Defaults to the value of
5236@code{HAVE_POST_INCREMENT}.
5237
5238@findex USE_STORE_POST_DECREMENT
5239@item USE_STORE_POST_DECREMENT (@var{mode})
5240A C expression used to determine whether a store postdecrement is a good
5241thing to use for a given mode.  Defaults to the value of
5242@code{HAVE_POST_DECREMENT}.
5243
5244@findex USE_STORE_PRE_INCREMENT
5245@item USE_STORE_PRE_INCREMENT (@var{mode})
5246This macro is used to determine whether a store preincrement is a good
5247thing to use for a given mode.  Defaults to the value of
5248@code{HAVE_PRE_INCREMENT}.
5249
5250@findex USE_STORE_PRE_DECREMENT
5251@item USE_STORE_PRE_DECREMENT (@var{mode})
5252This macro is used to determine whether a store predecrement is a good
5253thing to use for a given mode.  Defaults to the value of
5254@code{HAVE_PRE_DECREMENT}.
5255
5256@findex NO_FUNCTION_CSE
5257@item NO_FUNCTION_CSE
5258Define this macro if it is as good or better to call a constant
5259function address than to call an address kept in a register.
5260
5261@findex NO_RECURSIVE_FUNCTION_CSE
5262@item NO_RECURSIVE_FUNCTION_CSE
5263Define this macro if it is as good or better for a function to call
5264itself with an explicit address than to call an address kept in a
5265register.
5266@end table
5267
5268@node Scheduling
5269@section Adjusting the Instruction Scheduler
5270
5271The instruction scheduler may need a fair amount of machine-specific
5272adjustment in order to produce good code.  GCC provides several target
5273hooks for this purpose.  It is usually enough to define just a few of
5274them: try the first ones in this list first.
5275
5276@deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_SCHED_ISSUE_RATE (void)
5277This hook returns the maximum number of instructions that can ever issue
5278at the same time on the target machine.  The default is one.  This value
5279must be constant over the entire compilation.  If you need it to vary
5280depending on what the instructions are, you must use
5281@samp{TARGET_SCHED_VARIABLE_ISSUE}.
5282@end deftypefn
5283
5284@deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_SCHED_VARIABLE_ISSUE (FILE *@var{file}, int @var{verbose}, rtx @var{insn}, int @var{more})
5285This hook is executed by the scheduler after it has scheduled an insn
5286from the ready list.  It should return the number of insns which can
5287still be issued in the current cycle.  Normally this is
5288@samp{@w{@var{more} - 1}}.  You should define this hook if some insns
5289take more machine resources than others, so that fewer insns can follow
5290them in the same cycle.  @var{file} is either a null pointer, or a stdio
5291stream to write any debug output to.  @var{verbose} is the verbose level
5292provided by @option{-fsched-verbose-@var{n}}.  @var{insn} is the
5293instruction that was scheduled.
5294@end deftypefn
5295
5296@deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_SCHED_ADJUST_COST (rtx @var{insn}, rtx @var{link}, rtx @var{dep_insn}, int @var{cost})
5297This function corrects the value of @var{cost} based on the relationship
5298between @var{insn} and @var{dep_insn} through the dependence @var{link}.
5299It should return the new value.  The default is to make no adjustment to
5300@var{cost}.  This can be used for example to specify to the scheduler
5301that an output- or anti-dependence does not incur the same cost as a
5302data-dependence.
5303@end deftypefn
5304
5305@deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_SCHED_ADJUST_PRIORITY (rtx @var{insn}, int @var{priority})
5306This hook adjusts the integer scheduling priority @var{priority} of
5307@var{insn}.  It should return the new priority.  Reduce the priority to
5308execute @var{insn} earlier, increase the priority to execute @var{insn}
5309later.  Do not define this hook if you do not need to adjust the
5310scheduling priorities of insns.
5311@end deftypefn
5312
5313@deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_SCHED_REORDER (FILE *@var{file}, int @var{verbose}, rtx *@var{ready}, int *@var{n_readyp}, int @var{clock})
5314This hook is executed by the scheduler after it has scheduled the ready
5315list, to allow the machine description to reorder it (for example to
5316combine two small instructions together on @samp{VLIW} machines).
5317@var{file} is either a null pointer, or a stdio stream to write any
5318debug output to.  @var{verbose} is the verbose level provided by
5319@option{-fsched-verbose-@var{n}}.  @var{ready} is a pointer to the ready
5320list of instructions that are ready to be scheduled.  @var{n_readyp} is
5321a pointer to the number of elements in the ready list.  The scheduler
5322reads the ready list in reverse order, starting with
5323@var{ready}[@var{*n_readyp}-1] and going to @var{ready}[0].  @var{clock}
5324is the timer tick of the scheduler.  You may modify the ready list and
5325the number of ready insns.  The return value is the number of insns that
5326can issue this cycle; normally this is just @code{issue_rate}.  See also
5327@samp{TARGET_SCHED_REORDER2}.
5328@end deftypefn
5329
5330@deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_SCHED_REORDER2 (FILE *@var{file}, int @var{verbose}, rtx *@var{ready}, int *@var{n_ready}, @var{clock})
5331Like @samp{TARGET_SCHED_REORDER}, but called at a different time.  That
5332function is called whenever the scheduler starts a new cycle.  This one
5333is called once per iteration over a cycle, immediately after
5334@samp{TARGET_SCHED_VARIABLE_ISSUE}; it can reorder the ready list and
5335return the number of insns to be scheduled in the same cycle.  Defining
5336this hook can be useful if there are frequent situations where
5337scheduling one insn causes other insns to become ready in the same
5338cycle.  These other insns can then be taken into account properly.
5339@end deftypefn
5340
5341@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_INIT (FILE *@var{file}, int @var{verbose}, int @var{max_ready})
5342This hook is executed by the scheduler at the beginning of each block of
5343instructions that are to be scheduled.  @var{file} is either a null
5344pointer, or a stdio stream to write any debug output to.  @var{verbose}
5345is the verbose level provided by @option{-fsched-verbose-@var{n}}.
5346@var{max_ready} is the maximum number of insns in the current scheduling
5347region that can be live at the same time.  This can be used to allocate
5348scratch space if it is needed, e.g. by @samp{TARGET_SCHED_REORDER}.
5349@end deftypefn
5350
5351@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_FINISH (FILE *@var{file}, int @var{verbose})
5352This hook is executed by the scheduler at the end of each block of
5353instructions that are to be scheduled.  It can be used to perform
5354cleanup of any actions done by the other scheduling hooks.  @var{file}
5355is either a null pointer, or a stdio stream to write any debug output
5356to.  @var{verbose} is the verbose level provided by
5357@option{-fsched-verbose-@var{n}}.
5358@end deftypefn
5359
5360@deftypefn {Target Hook} rtx TARGET_SCHED_CYCLE_DISPLAY (int @var{clock}, rtx @var{last})
5361This hook is called in verbose mode only, at the beginning of each pass
5362over a basic block.  It should insert an insn into the chain after
5363@var{last}, which has no effect, but records the value @var{clock} in
5364RTL dumps and assembly output.  Define this hook only if you need this
5365level of detail about what the scheduler is doing.
5366@end deftypefn
5367
5368@node Sections
5369@section Dividing the Output into Sections (Texts, Data, @dots{})
5370@c the above section title is WAY too long.  maybe cut the part between
5371@c the (...)?  --mew 10feb93
5372
5373An object file is divided into sections containing different types of
5374data.  In the most common case, there are three sections: the @dfn{text
5375section}, which holds instructions and read-only data; the @dfn{data
5376section}, which holds initialized writable data; and the @dfn{bss
5377section}, which holds uninitialized data.  Some systems have other kinds
5378of sections.
5379
5380The compiler must tell the assembler when to switch sections.  These
5381macros control what commands to output to tell the assembler this.  You
5382can also define additional sections.
5383
5384@table @code
5385@findex TEXT_SECTION_ASM_OP
5386@item TEXT_SECTION_ASM_OP
5387A C expression whose value is a string, including spacing, containing the
5388assembler operation that should precede instructions and read-only data.
5389Normally @code{"\t.text"} is right.
5390
5391@findex TEXT_SECTION
5392@item TEXT_SECTION
5393A C statement that switches to the default section containing instructions.
5394Normally this is not needed, as simply defining @code{TEXT_SECTION_ASM_OP}
5395is enough.  The MIPS port uses this to sort all functions after all data
5396declarations.
5397
5398@findex DATA_SECTION_ASM_OP
5399@item DATA_SECTION_ASM_OP
5400A C expression whose value is a string, including spacing, containing the
5401assembler operation to identify the following data as writable initialized
5402data.  Normally @code{"\t.data"} is right.
5403
5404@findex SHARED_SECTION_ASM_OP
5405@item SHARED_SECTION_ASM_OP
5406If defined, a C expression whose value is a string, including spacing,
5407containing the assembler operation to identify the following data as
5408shared data.  If not defined, @code{DATA_SECTION_ASM_OP} will be used.
5409
5410@findex BSS_SECTION_ASM_OP
5411@item BSS_SECTION_ASM_OP
5412If defined, a C expression whose value is a string, including spacing,
5413containing the assembler operation to identify the following data as
5414uninitialized global data.  If not defined, and neither
5415@code{ASM_OUTPUT_BSS} nor @code{ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_BSS} are defined,
5416uninitialized global data will be output in the data section if
5417@option{-fno-common} is passed, otherwise @code{ASM_OUTPUT_COMMON} will be
5418used.
5419
5420@findex SHARED_BSS_SECTION_ASM_OP
5421@item SHARED_BSS_SECTION_ASM_OP
5422If defined, a C expression whose value is a string, including spacing,
5423containing the assembler operation to identify the following data as
5424uninitialized global shared data.  If not defined, and
5425@code{BSS_SECTION_ASM_OP} is, the latter will be used.
5426
5427@findex INIT_SECTION_ASM_OP
5428@item INIT_SECTION_ASM_OP
5429If defined, a C expression whose value is a string, including spacing,
5430containing the assembler operation to identify the following data as
5431initialization code.  If not defined, GCC will assume such a section does
5432not exist.
5433
5434@findex FINI_SECTION_ASM_OP
5435@item FINI_SECTION_ASM_OP
5436If defined, a C expression whose value is a string, including spacing,
5437containing the assembler operation to identify the following data as
5438finalization code.  If not defined, GCC will assume such a section does
5439not exist.
5440
5441@findex CRT_CALL_STATIC_FUNCTION
5442@item CRT_CALL_STATIC_FUNCTION (@var{section_op}, @var{function})
5443If defined, an ASM statement that switches to a different section
5444via @var{section_op}, calls @var{function}, and switches back to
5445the text section.  This is used in @file{crtstuff.c} if
5446@code{INIT_SECTION_ASM_OP} or @code{FINI_SECTION_ASM_OP} to calls
5447to initialization and finalization functions from the init and fini
5448sections.  By default, this macro uses a simple function call.  Some
5449ports need hand-crafted assembly code to avoid dependencies on
5450registers initialized in the function prologue or to ensure that
5451constant pools don't end up too far way in the text section.
5452
5453@findex FORCE_CODE_SECTION_ALIGN
5454@item FORCE_CODE_SECTION_ALIGN
5455If defined, an ASM statement that aligns a code section to some
5456arbitrary boundary.  This is used to force all fragments of the
5457@code{.init} and @code{.fini} sections to have to same alignment
5458and thus prevent the linker from having to add any padding.
5459
5460@findex EXTRA_SECTIONS
5461@findex in_text
5462@findex in_data
5463@item EXTRA_SECTIONS
5464A list of names for sections other than the standard two, which are
5465@code{in_text} and @code{in_data}.  You need not define this macro
5466on a system with no other sections (that GCC needs to use).
5467
5468@findex EXTRA_SECTION_FUNCTIONS
5469@findex text_section
5470@findex data_section
5471@item EXTRA_SECTION_FUNCTIONS
5472One or more functions to be defined in @file{varasm.c}.  These
5473functions should do jobs analogous to those of @code{text_section} and
5474@code{data_section}, for your additional sections.  Do not define this
5475macro if you do not define @code{EXTRA_SECTIONS}.
5476
5477@findex READONLY_DATA_SECTION
5478@item READONLY_DATA_SECTION
5479On most machines, read-only variables, constants, and jump tables are
5480placed in the text section.  If this is not the case on your machine,
5481this macro should be defined to be the name of a function (either
5482@code{data_section} or a function defined in @code{EXTRA_SECTIONS}) that
5483switches to the section to be used for read-only items.
5484
5485If these items should be placed in the text section, this macro should
5486not be defined.
5487
5488@findex SELECT_SECTION
5489@item SELECT_SECTION (@var{exp}, @var{reloc}, @var{align})
5490A C statement or statements to switch to the appropriate section for
5491output of @var{exp}.  You can assume that @var{exp} is either a
5492@code{VAR_DECL} node or a constant of some sort.  @var{reloc}
5493indicates whether the initial value of @var{exp} requires link-time
5494relocations.  Bit 1 is set when variable contains local relocations
5495only, while bit 2 is set for global relocations.
5496Select the section by calling @code{text_section} or one
5497of the alternatives for other sections.  @var{align} is the constant
5498alignment in bits.
5499
5500Do not define this macro if you put all read-only variables and
5501constants in the read-only data section (usually the text section).
5502
5503@findex SELECT_RTX_SECTION
5504@item SELECT_RTX_SECTION (@var{mode}, @var{rtx}, @var{align})
5505A C statement or statements to switch to the appropriate section for
5506output of @var{rtx} in mode @var{mode}.  You can assume that @var{rtx}
5507is some kind of constant in RTL@.  The argument @var{mode} is redundant
5508except in the case of a @code{const_int} rtx.  Select the section by
5509calling @code{text_section} or one of the alternatives for other
5510sections.  @var{align} is the constant alignment in bits.
5511
5512Do not define this macro if you put all constants in the read-only
5513data section.
5514
5515@findex JUMP_TABLES_IN_TEXT_SECTION
5516@item JUMP_TABLES_IN_TEXT_SECTION
5517Define this macro to be an expression with a nonzero value if jump
5518tables (for @code{tablejump} insns) should be output in the text
5519section, along with the assembler instructions.  Otherwise, the
5520readonly data section is used.
5521
5522This macro is irrelevant if there is no separate readonly data section.
5523
5524@findex ENCODE_SECTION_INFO
5525@item ENCODE_SECTION_INFO (@var{decl})
5526Define this macro if references to a symbol or a constant must be
5527treated differently depending on something about the variable or
5528function named by the symbol (such as what section it is in).
5529
5530The macro definition, if any, is executed under two circumstances.  One
5531is immediately after the rtl for @var{decl} that represents a variable
5532or a function has been created and stored in @code{DECL_RTL
5533(@var{decl})}.  The value of the rtl will be a @code{mem} whose address
5534is a @code{symbol_ref}.  The other is immediately after the rtl for
5535@var{decl} that represents a constant has been created and stored in
5536@code{TREE_CST_RTL (@var{decl})}.  The macro is called once for each
5537distinct constant in a source file.
5538
5539@cindex @code{SYMBOL_REF_FLAG}, in @code{ENCODE_SECTION_INFO}
5540The usual thing for this macro to do is to record a flag in the
5541@code{symbol_ref} (such as @code{SYMBOL_REF_FLAG}) or to store a
5542modified name string in the @code{symbol_ref} (if one bit is not enough
5543information).
5544
5545@findex STRIP_NAME_ENCODING
5546@item STRIP_NAME_ENCODING (@var{var}, @var{sym_name})
5547Decode @var{sym_name} and store the real name part in @var{var}, sans
5548the characters that encode section info.  Define this macro if
5549@code{ENCODE_SECTION_INFO} alters the symbol's name string.
5550
5551@findex UNIQUE_SECTION
5552@item UNIQUE_SECTION (@var{decl}, @var{reloc})
5553A C statement to build up a unique section name, expressed as a
5554@code{STRING_CST} node, and assign it to @samp{DECL_SECTION_NAME (@var{decl})}.
5555@var{reloc} indicates whether the initial value of @var{exp} requires
5556link-time relocations.  If you do not define this macro, GCC will use
5557the symbol name prefixed by @samp{.} as the section name.  Note - this
5558macro can now be called for uninitialized data items as well as
5559initialized data and functions.
5560@end table
5561
5562@node PIC
5563@section Position Independent Code
5564@cindex position independent code
5565@cindex PIC
5566
5567This section describes macros that help implement generation of position
5568independent code.  Simply defining these macros is not enough to
5569generate valid PIC; you must also add support to the macros
5570@code{GO_IF_LEGITIMATE_ADDRESS} and @code{PRINT_OPERAND_ADDRESS}, as
5571well as @code{LEGITIMIZE_ADDRESS}.  You must modify the definition of
5572@samp{movsi} to do something appropriate when the source operand
5573contains a symbolic address.  You may also need to alter the handling of
5574switch statements so that they use relative addresses.
5575@c i rearranged the order of the macros above to try to force one of
5576@c them to the next line, to eliminate an overfull hbox. --mew 10feb93
5577
5578@table @code
5579@findex PIC_OFFSET_TABLE_REGNUM
5580@item PIC_OFFSET_TABLE_REGNUM
5581The register number of the register used to address a table of static
5582data addresses in memory.  In some cases this register is defined by a
5583processor's ``application binary interface'' (ABI)@.  When this macro
5584is defined, RTL is generated for this register once, as with the stack
5585pointer and frame pointer registers.  If this macro is not defined, it
5586is up to the machine-dependent files to allocate such a register (if
5587necessary).  Note that this register must be fixed when in use (e.g.@:
5588when @code{flag_pic} is true).
5589
5590@findex PIC_OFFSET_TABLE_REG_CALL_CLOBBERED
5591@item PIC_OFFSET_TABLE_REG_CALL_CLOBBERED
5592Define this macro if the register defined by
5593@code{PIC_OFFSET_TABLE_REGNUM} is clobbered by calls.  Do not define
5594this macro if @code{PIC_OFFSET_TABLE_REGNUM} is not defined.
5595
5596@findex FINALIZE_PIC
5597@item FINALIZE_PIC
5598By generating position-independent code, when two different programs (A
5599and B) share a common library (libC.a), the text of the library can be
5600shared whether or not the library is linked at the same address for both
5601programs.  In some of these environments, position-independent code
5602requires not only the use of different addressing modes, but also
5603special code to enable the use of these addressing modes.
5604
5605The @code{FINALIZE_PIC} macro serves as a hook to emit these special
5606codes once the function is being compiled into assembly code, but not
5607before.  (It is not done before, because in the case of compiling an
5608inline function, it would lead to multiple PIC prologues being
5609included in functions which used inline functions and were compiled to
5610assembly language.)
5611
5612@findex LEGITIMATE_PIC_OPERAND_P
5613@item LEGITIMATE_PIC_OPERAND_P (@var{x})
5614A C expression that is nonzero if @var{x} is a legitimate immediate
5615operand on the target machine when generating position independent code.
5616You can assume that @var{x} satisfies @code{CONSTANT_P}, so you need not
5617check this.  You can also assume @var{flag_pic} is true, so you need not
5618check it either.  You need not define this macro if all constants
5619(including @code{SYMBOL_REF}) can be immediate operands when generating
5620position independent code.
5621@end table
5622
5623@node Assembler Format
5624@section Defining the Output Assembler Language
5625
5626This section describes macros whose principal purpose is to describe how
5627to write instructions in assembler language---rather than what the
5628instructions do.
5629
5630@menu
5631* File Framework::       Structural information for the assembler file.
5632* Data Output::          Output of constants (numbers, strings, addresses).
5633* Uninitialized Data::   Output of uninitialized variables.
5634* Label Output::         Output and generation of labels.
5635* Initialization::       General principles of initialization
5636			   and termination routines.
5637* Macros for Initialization::
5638			 Specific macros that control the handling of
5639			   initialization and termination routines.
5640* Instruction Output::   Output of actual instructions.
5641* Dispatch Tables::      Output of jump tables.
5642* Exception Region Output:: Output of exception region code.
5643* Alignment Output::     Pseudo ops for alignment and skipping data.
5644@end menu
5645
5646@node File Framework
5647@subsection The Overall Framework of an Assembler File
5648@cindex assembler format
5649@cindex output of assembler code
5650
5651@c prevent bad page break with this line
5652This describes the overall framework of an assembler file.
5653
5654@table @code
5655@findex ASM_FILE_START
5656@item ASM_FILE_START (@var{stream})
5657A C expression which outputs to the stdio stream @var{stream}
5658some appropriate text to go at the start of an assembler file.
5659
5660Normally this macro is defined to output a line containing
5661@samp{#NO_APP}, which is a comment that has no effect on most
5662assemblers but tells the GNU assembler that it can save time by not
5663checking for certain assembler constructs.
5664
5665On systems that use SDB, it is necessary to output certain commands;
5666see @file{attasm.h}.
5667
5668@findex ASM_FILE_END
5669@item ASM_FILE_END (@var{stream})
5670A C expression which outputs to the stdio stream @var{stream}
5671some appropriate text to go at the end of an assembler file.
5672
5673If this macro is not defined, the default is to output nothing
5674special at the end of the file.  Most systems don't require any
5675definition.
5676
5677On systems that use SDB, it is necessary to output certain commands;
5678see @file{attasm.h}.
5679
5680@findex ASM_COMMENT_START
5681@item ASM_COMMENT_START
5682A C string constant describing how to begin a comment in the target
5683assembler language.  The compiler assumes that the comment will end at
5684the end of the line.
5685
5686@findex ASM_APP_ON
5687@item ASM_APP_ON
5688A C string constant for text to be output before each @code{asm}
5689statement or group of consecutive ones.  Normally this is
5690@code{"#APP"}, which is a comment that has no effect on most
5691assemblers but tells the GNU assembler that it must check the lines
5692that follow for all valid assembler constructs.
5693
5694@findex ASM_APP_OFF
5695@item ASM_APP_OFF
5696A C string constant for text to be output after each @code{asm}
5697statement or group of consecutive ones.  Normally this is
5698@code{"#NO_APP"}, which tells the GNU assembler to resume making the
5699time-saving assumptions that are valid for ordinary compiler output.
5700
5701@findex ASM_OUTPUT_SOURCE_FILENAME
5702@item ASM_OUTPUT_SOURCE_FILENAME (@var{stream}, @var{name})
5703A C statement to output COFF information or DWARF debugging information
5704which indicates that filename @var{name} is the current source file to
5705the stdio stream @var{stream}.
5706
5707This macro need not be defined if the standard form of output
5708for the file format in use is appropriate.
5709
5710@findex OUTPUT_QUOTED_STRING
5711@item OUTPUT_QUOTED_STRING (@var{stream}, @var{string})
5712A C statement to output the string @var{string} to the stdio stream
5713@var{stream}.  If you do not call the function @code{output_quoted_string}
5714in your config files, GCC will only call it to output filenames to
5715the assembler source.  So you can use it to canonicalize the format
5716of the filename using this macro.
5717
5718@findex ASM_OUTPUT_SOURCE_LINE
5719@item ASM_OUTPUT_SOURCE_LINE (@var{stream}, @var{line})
5720A C statement to output DBX or SDB debugging information before code
5721for line number @var{line} of the current source file to the
5722stdio stream @var{stream}.
5723
5724This macro need not be defined if the standard form of debugging
5725information for the debugger in use is appropriate.
5726
5727@findex ASM_OUTPUT_IDENT
5728@item ASM_OUTPUT_IDENT (@var{stream}, @var{string})
5729A C statement to output something to the assembler file to handle a
5730@samp{#ident} directive containing the text @var{string}.  If this
5731macro is not defined, nothing is output for a @samp{#ident} directive.
5732
5733@findex OBJC_PROLOGUE
5734@item OBJC_PROLOGUE
5735A C statement to output any assembler statements which are required to
5736precede any Objective-C object definitions or message sending.  The
5737statement is executed only when compiling an Objective-C program.
5738@end table
5739
5740@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_NAMED_SECTION (const char *@var{name}, unsigned int @var{flags}, unsigned int @var{align})
5741Output assembly directives to switch to section @var{name}.  The section
5742should have attributes as specified by @var{flags}, which is a bit mask
5743of the @code{SECTION_*} flags defined in @file{output.h}.  If @var{align}
5744is nonzero, it contains an alignment in bytes to be used for the section,
5745otherwise some target default should be used.  Only targets that must 
5746specify an alignment within the section directive need pay attention to
5747@var{align} -- we will still use @code{ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGN}.
5748@end deftypefn
5749
5750@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_HAVE_NAMED_SECTIONS
5751This flag is true if the target supports @code{TARGET_ASM_NAMED_SECTION}.
5752@end deftypefn
5753
5754@deftypefn {Target Hook} {unsigned int} TARGET_SECTION_TYPE_FLAGS (tree @var{decl}, const char *@var{name}, int @var{reloc})
5755Choose a set of section attributes for use by @code{TARGET_ASM_NAMED_SECTION}
5756based on a variable or function decl, a section name, and whether or not the
5757declaration's initializer may contain runtime relocations.  @var{decl} may be
5758 null, in which case read-write data should be assumed.
5759
5760The default version if this function handles choosing code vs data,
5761read-only vs read-write data, and @code{flag_pic}.  You should only
5762need to override this if your target has special flags that might be
5763set via @code{__attribute__}.
5764@end deftypefn
5765
5766@need 2000
5767@node Data Output
5768@subsection Output of Data
5769
5770
5771@deftypevr {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_ASM_BYTE_OP
5772@deftypevrx {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_ASM_ALIGNED_HI_OP
5773@deftypevrx {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_ASM_ALIGNED_SI_OP
5774@deftypevrx {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_ASM_ALIGNED_DI_OP
5775@deftypevrx {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_ASM_ALIGNED_TI_OP
5776@deftypevrx {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_ASM_UNALIGNED_HI_OP
5777@deftypevrx {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_ASM_UNALIGNED_SI_OP
5778@deftypevrx {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_ASM_UNALIGNED_DI_OP
5779@deftypevrx {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_ASM_UNALIGNED_TI_OP
5780These hooks specify assembly directives for creating certain kinds
5781of integer object.  The @code{TARGET_ASM_BYTE_OP} directive creates a
5782byte-sized object, the @code{TARGET_ASM_ALIGNED_HI_OP} one creates an
5783aligned two-byte object, and so on.  Any of the hooks may be
5784@code{NULL}, indicating that no suitable directive is available.
5785
5786The compiler will print these strings at the start of a new line,
5787followed immediately by the object's initial value.  In most cases,
5788the string should contain a tab, a pseudo-op, and then another tab.
5789@end deftypevr
5790
5791@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_ASM_INTEGER (rtx @var{x}, unsigned int @var{size}, int @var{aligned_p})
5792The @code{assemble_integer} function uses this hook to output an
5793integer object.  @var{x} is the object's value, @var{size} is its size
5794in bytes and @var{aligned_p} indicates whether it is aligned.  The
5795function should return @code{true} if it was able to output the
5796object.  If it returns false, @code{assemble_integer} will try to
5797split the object into smaller parts.
5798
5799The default implementation of this hook will use the
5800@code{TARGET_ASM_BYTE_OP} family of strings, returning @code{false}
5801when the relevant string is @code{NULL}.
5802@end deftypefn
5803
5804@table @code
5805@findex OUTPUT_ADDR_CONST_EXTRA
5806@item OUTPUT_ADDR_CONST_EXTRA (@var{stream}, @var{x}, @var{fail})
5807A C statement to recognize @var{rtx} patterns that
5808@code{output_addr_const} can't deal with, and output assembly code to
5809@var{stream} corresponding to the pattern @var{x}.  This may be used to
5810allow machine-dependent @code{UNSPEC}s to appear within constants.
5811
5812If @code{OUTPUT_ADDR_CONST_EXTRA} fails to recognize a pattern, it must
5813@code{goto fail}, so that a standard error message is printed.  If it
5814prints an error message itself, by calling, for example,
5815@code{output_operand_lossage}, it may just complete normally.
5816
5817@findex ASM_OUTPUT_ASCII
5818@item ASM_OUTPUT_ASCII (@var{stream}, @var{ptr}, @var{len})
5819A C statement to output to the stdio stream @var{stream} an assembler
5820instruction to assemble a string constant containing the @var{len}
5821bytes at @var{ptr}.  @var{ptr} will be a C expression of type
5822@code{char *} and @var{len} a C expression of type @code{int}.
5823
5824If the assembler has a @code{.ascii} pseudo-op as found in the
5825Berkeley Unix assembler, do not define the macro
5826@code{ASM_OUTPUT_ASCII}.
5827
5828@findex ASM_OUTPUT_FDESC
5829@item ASM_OUTPUT_FDESC (@var{stream}, @var{decl}, @var{n})
5830A C statement to output word @var{n} of a function descriptor for
5831@var{decl}.  This must be defined if @code{TARGET_VTABLE_USES_DESCRIPTORS}
5832is defined, and is otherwise unused.
5833
5834@findex CONSTANT_POOL_BEFORE_FUNCTION
5835@item CONSTANT_POOL_BEFORE_FUNCTION
5836You may define this macro as a C expression.  You should define the
5837expression to have a nonzero value if GCC should output the constant
5838pool for a function before the code for the function, or a zero value if
5839GCC should output the constant pool after the function.  If you do
5840not define this macro, the usual case, GCC will output the constant
5841pool before the function.
5842
5843@findex ASM_OUTPUT_POOL_PROLOGUE
5844@item ASM_OUTPUT_POOL_PROLOGUE (@var{file}, @var{funname}, @var{fundecl}, @var{size})
5845A C statement to output assembler commands to define the start of the
5846constant pool for a function.  @var{funname} is a string giving
5847the name of the function.  Should the return type of the function
5848be required, it can be obtained via @var{fundecl}.  @var{size}
5849is the size, in bytes, of the constant pool that will be written
5850immediately after this call.
5851
5852If no constant-pool prefix is required, the usual case, this macro need
5853not be defined.
5854
5855@findex ASM_OUTPUT_SPECIAL_POOL_ENTRY
5856@item ASM_OUTPUT_SPECIAL_POOL_ENTRY (@var{file}, @var{x}, @var{mode}, @var{align}, @var{labelno}, @var{jumpto})
5857A C statement (with or without semicolon) to output a constant in the
5858constant pool, if it needs special treatment.  (This macro need not do
5859anything for RTL expressions that can be output normally.)
5860
5861The argument @var{file} is the standard I/O stream to output the
5862assembler code on.  @var{x} is the RTL expression for the constant to
5863output, and @var{mode} is the machine mode (in case @var{x} is a
5864@samp{const_int}).  @var{align} is the required alignment for the value
5865@var{x}; you should output an assembler directive to force this much
5866alignment.
5867
5868The argument @var{labelno} is a number to use in an internal label for
5869the address of this pool entry.  The definition of this macro is
5870responsible for outputting the label definition at the proper place.
5871Here is how to do this:
5872
5873@example
5874ASM_OUTPUT_INTERNAL_LABEL (@var{file}, "LC", @var{labelno});
5875@end example
5876
5877When you output a pool entry specially, you should end with a
5878@code{goto} to the label @var{jumpto}.  This will prevent the same pool
5879entry from being output a second time in the usual manner.
5880
5881You need not define this macro if it would do nothing.
5882
5883@findex CONSTANT_AFTER_FUNCTION_P
5884@item CONSTANT_AFTER_FUNCTION_P (@var{exp})
5885Define this macro as a C expression which is nonzero if the constant
5886@var{exp}, of type @code{tree}, should be output after the code for a
5887function.  The compiler will normally output all constants before the
5888function; you need not define this macro if this is OK@.
5889
5890@findex ASM_OUTPUT_POOL_EPILOGUE
5891@item ASM_OUTPUT_POOL_EPILOGUE (@var{file} @var{funname} @var{fundecl} @var{size})
5892A C statement to output assembler commands to at the end of the constant
5893pool for a function.  @var{funname} is a string giving the name of the
5894function.  Should the return type of the function be required, you can
5895obtain it via @var{fundecl}.  @var{size} is the size, in bytes, of the
5896constant pool that GCC wrote immediately before this call.
5897
5898If no constant-pool epilogue is required, the usual case, you need not
5899define this macro.
5900
5901@findex IS_ASM_LOGICAL_LINE_SEPARATOR
5902@item IS_ASM_LOGICAL_LINE_SEPARATOR (@var{C})
5903Define this macro as a C expression which is nonzero if @var{C} is
5904used as a logical line separator by the assembler.
5905
5906If you do not define this macro, the default is that only
5907the character @samp{;} is treated as a logical line separator.
5908@end table
5909
5910@deftypevr {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_ASM_OPEN_PAREN
5911@deftypevrx {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_ASM_CLOSE_PAREN
5912These target hooks are C string constants, describing the syntax in the
5913assembler for grouping arithmetic expressions.  If not overridden, they
5914default to normal parentheses, which is correct for most assemblers.
5915@end deftypevr
5916
5917  These macros are provided by @file{real.h} for writing the definitions
5918of @code{ASM_OUTPUT_DOUBLE} and the like:
5919
5920@table @code
5921@item REAL_VALUE_TO_TARGET_SINGLE (@var{x}, @var{l})
5922@itemx REAL_VALUE_TO_TARGET_DOUBLE (@var{x}, @var{l})
5923@itemx REAL_VALUE_TO_TARGET_LONG_DOUBLE (@var{x}, @var{l})
5924@findex REAL_VALUE_TO_TARGET_SINGLE
5925@findex REAL_VALUE_TO_TARGET_DOUBLE
5926@findex REAL_VALUE_TO_TARGET_LONG_DOUBLE
5927These translate @var{x}, of type @code{REAL_VALUE_TYPE}, to the target's
5928floating point representation, and store its bit pattern in the array of
5929@code{long int} whose address is @var{l}.  The number of elements in the
5930output array is determined by the size of the desired target floating
5931point data type: 32 bits of it go in each @code{long int} array
5932element.  Each array element holds 32 bits of the result, even if
5933@code{long int} is wider than 32 bits on the host machine.
5934
5935The array element values are designed so that you can print them out
5936using @code{fprintf} in the order they should appear in the target
5937machine's memory.
5938
5939@item REAL_VALUE_TO_DECIMAL (@var{x}, @var{format}, @var{string})
5940@findex REAL_VALUE_TO_DECIMAL
5941This macro converts @var{x}, of type @code{REAL_VALUE_TYPE}, to a
5942decimal number and stores it as a string into @var{string}.
5943You must pass, as @var{string}, the address of a long enough block
5944of space to hold the result.
5945
5946The argument @var{format} is a @code{printf}-specification that serves
5947as a suggestion for how to format the output string.
5948@end table
5949
5950@node Uninitialized Data
5951@subsection Output of Uninitialized Variables
5952
5953Each of the macros in this section is used to do the whole job of
5954outputting a single uninitialized variable.
5955
5956@table @code
5957@findex ASM_OUTPUT_COMMON
5958@item ASM_OUTPUT_COMMON (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{size}, @var{rounded})
5959A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
5960@var{stream} the assembler definition of a common-label named
5961@var{name} whose size is @var{size} bytes.  The variable @var{rounded}
5962is the size rounded up to whatever alignment the caller wants.
5963
5964Use the expression @code{assemble_name (@var{stream}, @var{name})} to
5965output the name itself; before and after that, output the additional
5966assembler syntax for defining the name, and a newline.
5967
5968This macro controls how the assembler definitions of uninitialized
5969common global variables are output.
5970
5971@findex ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_COMMON
5972@item ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_COMMON (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{size}, @var{alignment})
5973Like @code{ASM_OUTPUT_COMMON} except takes the required alignment as a
5974separate, explicit argument.  If you define this macro, it is used in
5975place of @code{ASM_OUTPUT_COMMON}, and gives you more flexibility in
5976handling the required alignment of the variable.  The alignment is specified
5977as the number of bits.
5978
5979@findex ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_DECL_COMMON
5980@item ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_DECL_COMMON (@var{stream}, @var{decl}, @var{name}, @var{size}, @var{alignment})
5981Like @code{ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_COMMON} except that @var{decl} of the
5982variable to be output, if there is one, or @code{NULL_TREE} if there
5983is no corresponding variable.  If you define this macro, GCC will use it
5984in place of both @code{ASM_OUTPUT_COMMON} and
5985@code{ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_COMMON}.  Define this macro when you need to see
5986the variable's decl in order to chose what to output.
5987
5988@findex ASM_OUTPUT_SHARED_COMMON
5989@item ASM_OUTPUT_SHARED_COMMON (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{size}, @var{rounded})
5990If defined, it is similar to @code{ASM_OUTPUT_COMMON}, except that it
5991is used when @var{name} is shared.  If not defined, @code{ASM_OUTPUT_COMMON}
5992will be used.
5993
5994@findex ASM_OUTPUT_BSS
5995@item ASM_OUTPUT_BSS (@var{stream}, @var{decl}, @var{name}, @var{size}, @var{rounded})
5996A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
5997@var{stream} the assembler definition of uninitialized global @var{decl} named
5998@var{name} whose size is @var{size} bytes.  The variable @var{rounded}
5999is the size rounded up to whatever alignment the caller wants.
6000
6001Try to use function @code{asm_output_bss} defined in @file{varasm.c} when
6002defining this macro.  If unable, use the expression
6003@code{assemble_name (@var{stream}, @var{name})} to output the name itself;
6004before and after that, output the additional assembler syntax for defining
6005the name, and a newline.
6006
6007This macro controls how the assembler definitions of uninitialized global
6008variables are output.  This macro exists to properly support languages like
6009C++ which do not have @code{common} data.  However, this macro currently
6010is not defined for all targets.  If this macro and
6011@code{ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_BSS} are not defined then @code{ASM_OUTPUT_COMMON}
6012or @code{ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_COMMON} or
6013@code{ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_DECL_COMMON} is used.
6014
6015@findex ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_BSS
6016@item ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_BSS (@var{stream}, @var{decl}, @var{name}, @var{size}, @var{alignment})
6017Like @code{ASM_OUTPUT_BSS} except takes the required alignment as a
6018separate, explicit argument.  If you define this macro, it is used in
6019place of @code{ASM_OUTPUT_BSS}, and gives you more flexibility in
6020handling the required alignment of the variable.  The alignment is specified
6021as the number of bits.
6022
6023Try to use function @code{asm_output_aligned_bss} defined in file
6024@file{varasm.c} when defining this macro.
6025
6026@findex ASM_OUTPUT_SHARED_BSS
6027@item ASM_OUTPUT_SHARED_BSS (@var{stream}, @var{decl}, @var{name}, @var{size}, @var{rounded})
6028If defined, it is similar to @code{ASM_OUTPUT_BSS}, except that it
6029is used when @var{name} is shared.  If not defined, @code{ASM_OUTPUT_BSS}
6030will be used.
6031
6032@findex ASM_OUTPUT_LOCAL
6033@item ASM_OUTPUT_LOCAL (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{size}, @var{rounded})
6034A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
6035@var{stream} the assembler definition of a local-common-label named
6036@var{name} whose size is @var{size} bytes.  The variable @var{rounded}
6037is the size rounded up to whatever alignment the caller wants.
6038
6039Use the expression @code{assemble_name (@var{stream}, @var{name})} to
6040output the name itself; before and after that, output the additional
6041assembler syntax for defining the name, and a newline.
6042
6043This macro controls how the assembler definitions of uninitialized
6044static variables are output.
6045
6046@findex ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_LOCAL
6047@item ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_LOCAL (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{size}, @var{alignment})
6048Like @code{ASM_OUTPUT_LOCAL} except takes the required alignment as a
6049separate, explicit argument.  If you define this macro, it is used in
6050place of @code{ASM_OUTPUT_LOCAL}, and gives you more flexibility in
6051handling the required alignment of the variable.  The alignment is specified
6052as the number of bits.
6053
6054@findex ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_DECL_LOCAL
6055@item ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_DECL_LOCAL (@var{stream}, @var{decl}, @var{name}, @var{size}, @var{alignment})
6056Like @code{ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_DECL} except that @var{decl} of the
6057variable to be output, if there is one, or @code{NULL_TREE} if there
6058is no corresponding variable.  If you define this macro, GCC will use it
6059in place of both @code{ASM_OUTPUT_DECL} and
6060@code{ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_DECL}.  Define this macro when you need to see
6061the variable's decl in order to chose what to output.
6062
6063@findex ASM_OUTPUT_SHARED_LOCAL
6064@item ASM_OUTPUT_SHARED_LOCAL (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{size}, @var{rounded})
6065If defined, it is similar to @code{ASM_OUTPUT_LOCAL}, except that it
6066is used when @var{name} is shared.  If not defined, @code{ASM_OUTPUT_LOCAL}
6067will be used.
6068@end table
6069
6070@node Label Output
6071@subsection Output and Generation of Labels
6072
6073@c prevent bad page break with this line
6074This is about outputting labels.
6075
6076@table @code
6077@findex ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL
6078@findex assemble_name
6079@item ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (@var{stream}, @var{name})
6080A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
6081@var{stream} the assembler definition of a label named @var{name}.
6082Use the expression @code{assemble_name (@var{stream}, @var{name})} to
6083output the name itself; before and after that, output the additional
6084assembler syntax for defining the name, and a newline.
6085
6086@findex ASM_DECLARE_FUNCTION_NAME
6087@item ASM_DECLARE_FUNCTION_NAME (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{decl})
6088A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
6089@var{stream} any text necessary for declaring the name @var{name} of a
6090function which is being defined.  This macro is responsible for
6091outputting the label definition (perhaps using
6092@code{ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL}).  The argument @var{decl} is the
6093@code{FUNCTION_DECL} tree node representing the function.
6094
6095If this macro is not defined, then the function name is defined in the
6096usual manner as a label (by means of @code{ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL}).
6097
6098@findex ASM_DECLARE_FUNCTION_SIZE
6099@item ASM_DECLARE_FUNCTION_SIZE (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{decl})
6100A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
6101@var{stream} any text necessary for declaring the size of a function
6102which is being defined.  The argument @var{name} is the name of the
6103function.  The argument @var{decl} is the @code{FUNCTION_DECL} tree node
6104representing the function.
6105
6106If this macro is not defined, then the function size is not defined.
6107
6108@findex ASM_DECLARE_OBJECT_NAME
6109@item ASM_DECLARE_OBJECT_NAME (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{decl})
6110A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
6111@var{stream} any text necessary for declaring the name @var{name} of an
6112initialized variable which is being defined.  This macro must output the
6113label definition (perhaps using @code{ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL}).  The argument
6114@var{decl} is the @code{VAR_DECL} tree node representing the variable.
6115
6116If this macro is not defined, then the variable name is defined in the
6117usual manner as a label (by means of @code{ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL}).
6118
6119@findex ASM_DECLARE_REGISTER_GLOBAL
6120@item ASM_DECLARE_REGISTER_GLOBAL (@var{stream}, @var{decl}, @var{regno}, @var{name})
6121A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
6122@var{stream} any text necessary for claiming a register @var{regno}
6123for a global variable @var{decl} with name @var{name}.
6124
6125If you don't define this macro, that is equivalent to defining it to do
6126nothing.
6127
6128@findex  ASM_FINISH_DECLARE_OBJECT
6129@item ASM_FINISH_DECLARE_OBJECT (@var{stream}, @var{decl}, @var{toplevel}, @var{atend})
6130A C statement (sans semicolon) to finish up declaring a variable name
6131once the compiler has processed its initializer fully and thus has had a
6132chance to determine the size of an array when controlled by an
6133initializer.  This is used on systems where it's necessary to declare
6134something about the size of the object.
6135
6136If you don't define this macro, that is equivalent to defining it to do
6137nothing.
6138
6139@findex ASM_GLOBALIZE_LABEL
6140@item ASM_GLOBALIZE_LABEL (@var{stream}, @var{name})
6141A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
6142@var{stream} some commands that will make the label @var{name} global;
6143that is, available for reference from other files.  Use the expression
6144@code{assemble_name (@var{stream}, @var{name})} to output the name
6145itself; before and after that, output the additional assembler syntax
6146for making that name global, and a newline.
6147
6148@findex ASM_WEAKEN_LABEL
6149@item ASM_WEAKEN_LABEL
6150A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
6151@var{stream} some commands that will make the label @var{name} weak;
6152that is, available for reference from other files but only used if
6153no other definition is available.  Use the expression
6154@code{assemble_name (@var{stream}, @var{name})} to output the name
6155itself; before and after that, output the additional assembler syntax
6156for making that name weak, and a newline.
6157
6158If you don't define this macro, GCC will not support weak
6159symbols and you should not define the @code{SUPPORTS_WEAK} macro.
6160
6161@findex SUPPORTS_WEAK
6162@item SUPPORTS_WEAK
6163A C expression which evaluates to true if the target supports weak symbols.
6164
6165If you don't define this macro, @file{defaults.h} provides a default
6166definition.  If @code{ASM_WEAKEN_LABEL} is defined, the default
6167definition is @samp{1}; otherwise, it is @samp{0}.  Define this macro if
6168you want to control weak symbol support with a compiler flag such as
6169@option{-melf}.
6170
6171@findex MAKE_DECL_ONE_ONLY (@var{decl})
6172@item MAKE_DECL_ONE_ONLY
6173A C statement (sans semicolon) to mark @var{decl} to be emitted as a
6174public symbol such that extra copies in multiple translation units will
6175be discarded by the linker.  Define this macro if your object file
6176format provides support for this concept, such as the @samp{COMDAT}
6177section flags in the Microsoft Windows PE/COFF format, and this support
6178requires changes to @var{decl}, such as putting it in a separate section.
6179
6180@findex SUPPORTS_ONE_ONLY
6181@item SUPPORTS_ONE_ONLY
6182A C expression which evaluates to true if the target supports one-only
6183semantics.
6184
6185If you don't define this macro, @file{varasm.c} provides a default
6186definition.  If @code{MAKE_DECL_ONE_ONLY} is defined, the default
6187definition is @samp{1}; otherwise, it is @samp{0}.  Define this macro if
6188you want to control one-only symbol support with a compiler flag, or if
6189setting the @code{DECL_ONE_ONLY} flag is enough to mark a declaration to
6190be emitted as one-only.
6191
6192@findex ASM_OUTPUT_EXTERNAL
6193@item ASM_OUTPUT_EXTERNAL (@var{stream}, @var{decl}, @var{name})
6194A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
6195@var{stream} any text necessary for declaring the name of an external
6196symbol named @var{name} which is referenced in this compilation but
6197not defined.  The value of @var{decl} is the tree node for the
6198declaration.
6199
6200This macro need not be defined if it does not need to output anything.
6201The GNU assembler and most Unix assemblers don't require anything.
6202
6203@findex ASM_OUTPUT_EXTERNAL_LIBCALL
6204@item ASM_OUTPUT_EXTERNAL_LIBCALL (@var{stream}, @var{symref})
6205A C statement (sans semicolon) to output on @var{stream} an assembler
6206pseudo-op to declare a library function name external.  The name of the
6207library function is given by @var{symref}, which has type @code{rtx} and
6208is a @code{symbol_ref}.
6209
6210This macro need not be defined if it does not need to output anything.
6211The GNU assembler and most Unix assemblers don't require anything.
6212
6213@findex ASM_OUTPUT_LABELREF
6214@item ASM_OUTPUT_LABELREF (@var{stream}, @var{name})
6215A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
6216@var{stream} a reference in assembler syntax to a label named
6217@var{name}.  This should add @samp{_} to the front of the name, if that
6218is customary on your operating system, as it is in most Berkeley Unix
6219systems.  This macro is used in @code{assemble_name}.
6220
6221@findex ASM_OUTPUT_SYMBOL_REF
6222@item ASM_OUTPUT_SYMBOL_REF (@var{stream}, @var{sym})
6223A C statement (sans semicolon) to output a reference to
6224@code{SYMBOL_REF} @var{sym}.  If not defined, @code{assemble_name}
6225will be used to output the name of the symbol.  This macro may be used
6226to modify the way a symbol is referenced depending on information
6227encoded by @code{ENCODE_SECTION_INFO}.
6228
6229@findex ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL_REF
6230@item ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL_REF (@var{stream}, @var{buf})
6231A C statement (sans semicolon) to output a reference to @var{buf}, the
6232result of ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL.  If not defined,
6233@code{assemble_name} will be used to output the name of the symbol.
6234This macro is not used by @code{output_asm_label}, or the @code{%l}
6235specifier that calls it; the intention is that this macro should be set
6236when it is necessary to output a label differently when its address
6237is being taken.
6238
6239@findex ASM_OUTPUT_INTERNAL_LABEL
6240@item ASM_OUTPUT_INTERNAL_LABEL (@var{stream}, @var{prefix}, @var{num})
6241A C statement to output to the stdio stream @var{stream} a label whose
6242name is made from the string @var{prefix} and the number @var{num}.
6243
6244It is absolutely essential that these labels be distinct from the labels
6245used for user-level functions and variables.  Otherwise, certain programs
6246will have name conflicts with internal labels.
6247
6248It is desirable to exclude internal labels from the symbol table of the
6249object file.  Most assemblers have a naming convention for labels that
6250should be excluded; on many systems, the letter @samp{L} at the
6251beginning of a label has this effect.  You should find out what
6252convention your system uses, and follow it.
6253
6254The usual definition of this macro is as follows:
6255
6256@example
6257fprintf (@var{stream}, "L%s%d:\n", @var{prefix}, @var{num})
6258@end example
6259
6260@findex ASM_OUTPUT_DEBUG_LABEL
6261@item ASM_OUTPUT_DEBUG_LABEL (@var{stream}, @var{prefix}, @var{num})
6262A C statement to output to the stdio stream @var{stream} a debug info
6263label whose name is made from the string @var{prefix} and the number
6264@var{num}.  This is useful for VLIW targets, where debug info labels
6265may need to be treated differently than branch target labels.  On some
6266systems, branch target labels must be at the beginning of instruction
6267bundles, but debug info labels can occur in the middle of instruction
6268bundles.
6269
6270If this macro is not defined, then @code{ASM_OUTPUT_INTERNAL_LABEL} will be
6271used.
6272
6273@findex ASM_OUTPUT_ALTERNATE_LABEL_NAME
6274@item ASM_OUTPUT_ALTERNATE_LABEL_NAME (@var{stream}, @var{string})
6275A C statement to output to the stdio stream @var{stream} the string
6276@var{string}.
6277
6278The default definition of this macro is as follows:
6279
6280@example
6281fprintf (@var{stream}, "%s:\n", LABEL_ALTERNATE_NAME (INSN))
6282@end example
6283
6284@findex ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL
6285@item ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (@var{string}, @var{prefix}, @var{num})
6286A C statement to store into the string @var{string} a label whose name
6287is made from the string @var{prefix} and the number @var{num}.
6288
6289This string, when output subsequently by @code{assemble_name}, should
6290produce the output that @code{ASM_OUTPUT_INTERNAL_LABEL} would produce
6291with the same @var{prefix} and @var{num}.
6292
6293If the string begins with @samp{*}, then @code{assemble_name} will
6294output the rest of the string unchanged.  It is often convenient for
6295@code{ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL} to use @samp{*} in this way.  If the
6296string doesn't start with @samp{*}, then @code{ASM_OUTPUT_LABELREF} gets
6297to output the string, and may change it.  (Of course,
6298@code{ASM_OUTPUT_LABELREF} is also part of your machine description, so
6299you should know what it does on your machine.)
6300
6301@findex ASM_FORMAT_PRIVATE_NAME
6302@item ASM_FORMAT_PRIVATE_NAME (@var{outvar}, @var{name}, @var{number})
6303A C expression to assign to @var{outvar} (which is a variable of type
6304@code{char *}) a newly allocated string made from the string
6305@var{name} and the number @var{number}, with some suitable punctuation
6306added.  Use @code{alloca} to get space for the string.
6307
6308The string will be used as an argument to @code{ASM_OUTPUT_LABELREF} to
6309produce an assembler label for an internal static variable whose name is
6310@var{name}.  Therefore, the string must be such as to result in valid
6311assembler code.  The argument @var{number} is different each time this
6312macro is executed; it prevents conflicts between similarly-named
6313internal static variables in different scopes.
6314
6315Ideally this string should not be a valid C identifier, to prevent any
6316conflict with the user's own symbols.  Most assemblers allow periods
6317or percent signs in assembler symbols; putting at least one of these
6318between the name and the number will suffice.
6319
6320@findex ASM_OUTPUT_DEF
6321@item ASM_OUTPUT_DEF (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{value})
6322A C statement to output to the stdio stream @var{stream} assembler code
6323which defines (equates) the symbol @var{name} to have the value @var{value}.
6324
6325@findex SET_ASM_OP
6326If @code{SET_ASM_OP} is defined, a default definition is provided which is
6327correct for most systems.
6328
6329@findex ASM_OUTPUT_DEF_FROM_DECLS
6330@item ASM_OUTPUT_DEF_FROM_DECLS (@var{stream}, @var{decl_of_name}, @var{decl_of_value})
6331A C statement to output to the stdio stream @var{stream} assembler code
6332which defines (equates) the symbol whose tree node is @var{decl_of_name}
6333to have the value of the tree node @var{decl_of_value}.  This macro will
6334be used in preference to @samp{ASM_OUTPUT_DEF} if it is defined and if
6335the tree nodes are available.
6336
6337@findex ASM_OUTPUT_DEFINE_LABEL_DIFFERENCE_SYMBOL
6338@item ASM_OUTPUT_DEFINE_LABEL_DIFFERENCE_SYMBOL (@var{stream}, @var{symbol}, @var{high}, @var{low})
6339A C statement to output to the stdio stream @var{stream} assembler code
6340which defines (equates) the symbol @var{symbol} to have a value equal to
6341the difference of the two symbols @var{high} and @var{low},
6342i.e.@: @var{high} minus @var{low}.  GCC guarantees that the symbols @var{high}
6343and @var{low} are already known by the assembler so that the difference
6344resolves into a constant.
6345
6346@findex SET_ASM_OP
6347If @code{SET_ASM_OP} is defined, a default definition is provided which is
6348correct for most systems.
6349
6350@findex ASM_OUTPUT_WEAK_ALIAS
6351@item ASM_OUTPUT_WEAK_ALIAS (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{value})
6352A C statement to output to the stdio stream @var{stream} assembler code
6353which defines (equates) the weak symbol @var{name} to have the value
6354@var{value}.  If @var{value} is @code{NULL}, it defines @var{name} as
6355an undefined weak symbol.
6356
6357Define this macro if the target only supports weak aliases; define
6358@code{ASM_OUTPUT_DEF} instead if possible.
6359
6360@findex OBJC_GEN_METHOD_LABEL
6361@item OBJC_GEN_METHOD_LABEL (@var{buf}, @var{is_inst}, @var{class_name}, @var{cat_name}, @var{sel_name})
6362Define this macro to override the default assembler names used for
6363Objective-C methods.
6364
6365The default name is a unique method number followed by the name of the
6366class (e.g.@: @samp{_1_Foo}).  For methods in categories, the name of
6367the category is also included in the assembler name (e.g.@:
6368@samp{_1_Foo_Bar}).
6369
6370These names are safe on most systems, but make debugging difficult since
6371the method's selector is not present in the name.  Therefore, particular
6372systems define other ways of computing names.
6373
6374@var{buf} is an expression of type @code{char *} which gives you a
6375buffer in which to store the name; its length is as long as
6376@var{class_name}, @var{cat_name} and @var{sel_name} put together, plus
637750 characters extra.
6378
6379The argument @var{is_inst} specifies whether the method is an instance
6380method or a class method; @var{class_name} is the name of the class;
6381@var{cat_name} is the name of the category (or @code{NULL} if the method is not
6382in a category); and @var{sel_name} is the name of the selector.
6383
6384On systems where the assembler can handle quoted names, you can use this
6385macro to provide more human-readable names.
6386
6387@findex ASM_DECLARE_CLASS_REFERENCE
6388@item ASM_DECLARE_CLASS_REFERENCE (@var{stream}, @var{name})
6389A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
6390@var{stream} commands to declare that the label @var{name} is an
6391Objective-C class reference.  This is only needed for targets whose
6392linkers have special support for NeXT-style runtimes.
6393
6394@findex ASM_DECLARE_UNRESOLVED_REFERENCE
6395@item ASM_DECLARE_UNRESOLVED_REFERENCE (@var{stream}, @var{name})
6396A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
6397@var{stream} commands to declare that the label @var{name} is an
6398unresolved Objective-C class reference.  This is only needed for targets
6399whose linkers have special support for NeXT-style runtimes.
6400@end table
6401
6402@node Initialization
6403@subsection How Initialization Functions Are Handled
6404@cindex initialization routines
6405@cindex termination routines
6406@cindex constructors, output of
6407@cindex destructors, output of
6408
6409The compiled code for certain languages includes @dfn{constructors}
6410(also called @dfn{initialization routines})---functions to initialize
6411data in the program when the program is started.  These functions need
6412to be called before the program is ``started''---that is to say, before
6413@code{main} is called.
6414
6415Compiling some languages generates @dfn{destructors} (also called
6416@dfn{termination routines}) that should be called when the program
6417terminates.
6418
6419To make the initialization and termination functions work, the compiler
6420must output something in the assembler code to cause those functions to
6421be called at the appropriate time.  When you port the compiler to a new
6422system, you need to specify how to do this.
6423
6424There are two major ways that GCC currently supports the execution of
6425initialization and termination functions.  Each way has two variants.
6426Much of the structure is common to all four variations.
6427
6428@findex __CTOR_LIST__
6429@findex __DTOR_LIST__
6430The linker must build two lists of these functions---a list of
6431initialization functions, called @code{__CTOR_LIST__}, and a list of
6432termination functions, called @code{__DTOR_LIST__}.
6433
6434Each list always begins with an ignored function pointer (which may hold
64350, @minus{}1, or a count of the function pointers after it, depending on
6436the environment).  This is followed by a series of zero or more function
6437pointers to constructors (or destructors), followed by a function
6438pointer containing zero.
6439
6440Depending on the operating system and its executable file format, either
6441@file{crtstuff.c} or @file{libgcc2.c} traverses these lists at startup
6442time and exit time.  Constructors are called in reverse order of the
6443list; destructors in forward order.
6444
6445The best way to handle static constructors works only for object file
6446formats which provide arbitrarily-named sections.  A section is set
6447aside for a list of constructors, and another for a list of destructors.
6448Traditionally these are called @samp{.ctors} and @samp{.dtors}.  Each
6449object file that defines an initialization function also puts a word in
6450the constructor section to point to that function.  The linker
6451accumulates all these words into one contiguous @samp{.ctors} section.
6452Termination functions are handled similarly.
6453
6454This method will be chosen as the default by @file{target-def.h} if
6455@code{TARGET_ASM_NAMED_SECTION} is defined.  A target that does not
6456support arbitrary sections, but does support special designated 
6457constructor and destructor sections may define @code{CTORS_SECTION_ASM_OP}
6458and @code{DTORS_SECTION_ASM_OP} to achieve the same effect.
6459
6460When arbitrary sections are available, there are two variants, depending
6461upon how the code in @file{crtstuff.c} is called.  On systems that
6462support a @dfn{.init} section which is executed at program startup,
6463parts of @file{crtstuff.c} are compiled into that section.  The
6464program is linked by the @code{gcc} driver like this:
6465
6466@example
6467ld -o @var{output_file} crti.o crtbegin.o @dots{} -lgcc crtend.o crtn.o
6468@end example
6469
6470The prologue of a function (@code{__init}) appears in the @code{.init}
6471section of @file{crti.o}; the epilogue appears in @file{crtn.o}.  Likewise
6472for the function @code{__fini} in the @dfn{.fini} section.  Normally these
6473files are provided by the operating system or by the GNU C library, but
6474are provided by GCC for a few targets.
6475
6476The objects @file{crtbegin.o} and @file{crtend.o} are (for most targets)
6477compiled from @file{crtstuff.c}.  They contain, among other things, code
6478fragments within the @code{.init} and @code{.fini} sections that branch
6479to routines in the @code{.text} section.  The linker will pull all parts
6480of a section together, which results in a complete @code{__init} function
6481that invokes the routines we need at startup.
6482
6483To use this variant, you must define the @code{INIT_SECTION_ASM_OP}
6484macro properly.
6485
6486If no init section is available, when GCC compiles any function called
6487@code{main} (or more accurately, any function designated as a program
6488entry point by the language front end calling @code{expand_main_function}),
6489it inserts a procedure call to @code{__main} as the first executable code
6490after the function prologue.  The @code{__main} function is defined
6491in @file{libgcc2.c} and runs the global constructors.
6492
6493In file formats that don't support arbitrary sections, there are again
6494two variants.  In the simplest variant, the GNU linker (GNU @code{ld})
6495and an `a.out' format must be used.  In this case,
6496@code{TARGET_ASM_CONSTRUCTOR} is defined to produce a @code{.stabs}
6497entry of type @samp{N_SETT}, referencing the name @code{__CTOR_LIST__},
6498and with the address of the void function containing the initialization
6499code as its value.  The GNU linker recognizes this as a request to add
6500the value to a @dfn{set}; the values are accumulated, and are eventually
6501placed in the executable as a vector in the format described above, with
6502a leading (ignored) count and a trailing zero element.
6503@code{TARGET_ASM_DESTRUCTOR} is handled similarly.  Since no init
6504section is available, the absence of @code{INIT_SECTION_ASM_OP} causes
6505the compilation of @code{main} to call @code{__main} as above, starting
6506the initialization process.
6507
6508The last variant uses neither arbitrary sections nor the GNU linker.
6509This is preferable when you want to do dynamic linking and when using
6510file formats which the GNU linker does not support, such as `ECOFF'@.  In
6511this case, @code{TARGET_HAVE_CTORS_DTORS} is false, initialization and
6512termination functions are recognized simply by their names.  This requires
6513an extra program in the linkage step, called @command{collect2}.  This program
6514pretends to be the linker, for use with GCC; it does its job by running
6515the ordinary linker, but also arranges to include the vectors of
6516initialization and termination functions.  These functions are called
6517via @code{__main} as described above.  In order to use this method,
6518@code{use_collect2} must be defined in the target in @file{config.gcc}.
6519
6520@ifinfo
6521The following section describes the specific macros that control and
6522customize the handling of initialization and termination functions.
6523@end ifinfo
6524
6525@node Macros for Initialization
6526@subsection Macros Controlling Initialization Routines
6527
6528Here are the macros that control how the compiler handles initialization
6529and termination functions:
6530
6531@table @code
6532@findex INIT_SECTION_ASM_OP
6533@item INIT_SECTION_ASM_OP
6534If defined, a C string constant, including spacing, for the assembler
6535operation to identify the following data as initialization code.  If not
6536defined, GCC will assume such a section does not exist.  When you are
6537using special sections for initialization and termination functions, this
6538macro also controls how @file{crtstuff.c} and @file{libgcc2.c} arrange to
6539run the initialization functions.
6540
6541@item HAS_INIT_SECTION
6542@findex HAS_INIT_SECTION
6543If defined, @code{main} will not call @code{__main} as described above.
6544This macro should be defined for systems that control start-up code
6545on a symbol-by-symbol basis, such as OSF/1, and should not
6546be defined explicitly for systems that support @code{INIT_SECTION_ASM_OP}.
6547
6548@item LD_INIT_SWITCH
6549@findex LD_INIT_SWITCH
6550If defined, a C string constant for a switch that tells the linker that
6551the following symbol is an initialization routine.
6552
6553@item LD_FINI_SWITCH
6554@findex LD_FINI_SWITCH
6555If defined, a C string constant for a switch that tells the linker that
6556the following symbol is a finalization routine.
6557
6558@item COLLECT_SHARED_INIT_FUNC (@var{stream}, @var{func})
6559If defined, a C statement that will write a function that can be
6560automatically called when a shared library is loaded.  The function
6561should call @var{func}, which takes no arguments.  If not defined, and
6562the object format requires an explicit initialization function, then a
6563function called @code{_GLOBAL__DI} will be generated.
6564
6565This function and the following one are used by collect2 when linking a
6566shared library that needs constructors or destructors, or has DWARF2 
6567exception tables embedded in the code.
6568
6569@item COLLECT_SHARED_FINI_FUNC (@var{stream}, @var{func})
6570If defined, a C statement that will write a function that can be
6571automatically called when a shared library is unloaded.  The function
6572should call @var{func}, which takes no arguments.  If not defined, and
6573the object format requires an explicit finalization function, then a
6574function called @code{_GLOBAL__DD} will be generated.
6575
6576@item INVOKE__main
6577@findex INVOKE__main
6578If defined, @code{main} will call @code{__main} despite the presence of
6579@code{INIT_SECTION_ASM_OP}.  This macro should be defined for systems
6580where the init section is not actually run automatically, but is still
6581useful for collecting the lists of constructors and destructors.
6582
6583@item SUPPORTS_INIT_PRIORITY
6584@findex SUPPORTS_INIT_PRIORITY
6585If nonzero, the C++ @code{init_priority} attribute is supported and the
6586compiler should emit instructions to control the order of initialization
6587of objects.  If zero, the compiler will issue an error message upon
6588encountering an @code{init_priority} attribute.
6589@end table
6590
6591@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_HAVE_CTORS_DTORS
6592This value is true if the target supports some ``native'' method of
6593collecting constructors and destructors to be run at startup and exit.
6594It is false if we must use @command{collect2}.
6595@end deftypefn
6596
6597@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_CONSTRUCTOR (rtx @var{symbol}, int @var{priority})
6598If defined, a function that outputs assembler code to arrange to call
6599the function referenced by @var{symbol} at initialization time.
6600
6601Assume that @var{symbol} is a @code{SYMBOL_REF} for a function taking
6602no arguments and with no return value.  If the target supports initialization
6603priorities, @var{priority} is a value between 0 and @code{MAX_INIT_PRIORITY};
6604otherwise it must be @code{DEFAULT_INIT_PRIORITY}.
6605
6606If this macro is not defined by the target, a suitable default will
6607be chosen if (1) the target supports arbitrary section names, (2) the
6608target defines @code{CTORS_SECTION_ASM_OP}, or (3) @code{USE_COLLECT2}
6609is not defined.
6610@end deftypefn
6611
6612@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_DESTRUCTOR (rtx @var{symbol}, int @var{priority})
6613This is like @code{TARGET_ASM_CONSTRUCTOR} but used for termination
6614functions rather than initialization functions.
6615@end deftypefn
6616
6617If @code{TARGET_HAVE_CTORS_DTORS} is true, the initialization routine
6618generated for the generated object file will have static linkage.
6619
6620If your system uses @command{collect2} as the means of processing
6621constructors, then that program normally uses @command{nm} to scan
6622an object file for constructor functions to be called.
6623
6624On certain kinds of systems, you can define these macros to make
6625@command{collect2} work faster (and, in some cases, make it work at all):
6626
6627@table @code
6628@findex OBJECT_FORMAT_COFF
6629@item OBJECT_FORMAT_COFF
6630Define this macro if the system uses COFF (Common Object File Format)
6631object files, so that @command{collect2} can assume this format and scan
6632object files directly for dynamic constructor/destructor functions.
6633
6634@findex OBJECT_FORMAT_ROSE
6635@item OBJECT_FORMAT_ROSE
6636Define this macro if the system uses ROSE format object files, so that
6637@command{collect2} can assume this format and scan object files directly
6638for dynamic constructor/destructor functions.
6639
6640These macros are effective only in a native compiler; @command{collect2} as
6641part of a cross compiler always uses @command{nm} for the target machine.
6642
6643@findex REAL_NM_FILE_NAME
6644@item REAL_NM_FILE_NAME
6645Define this macro as a C string constant containing the file name to use
6646to execute @command{nm}.  The default is to search the path normally for
6647@command{nm}.
6648
6649If your system supports shared libraries and has a program to list the
6650dynamic dependencies of a given library or executable, you can define
6651these macros to enable support for running initialization and
6652termination functions in shared libraries:
6653
6654@findex LDD_SUFFIX
6655@item LDD_SUFFIX
6656Define this macro to a C string constant containing the name of the program
6657which lists dynamic dependencies, like @command{"ldd"} under SunOS 4.
6658
6659@findex PARSE_LDD_OUTPUT
6660@item PARSE_LDD_OUTPUT (@var{ptr})
6661Define this macro to be C code that extracts filenames from the output
6662of the program denoted by @code{LDD_SUFFIX}.  @var{ptr} is a variable
6663of type @code{char *} that points to the beginning of a line of output
6664from @code{LDD_SUFFIX}.  If the line lists a dynamic dependency, the
6665code must advance @var{ptr} to the beginning of the filename on that
6666line.  Otherwise, it must set @var{ptr} to @code{NULL}.
6667@end table
6668
6669@node Instruction Output
6670@subsection Output of Assembler Instructions
6671
6672@c prevent bad page break with this line
6673This describes assembler instruction output.
6674
6675@table @code
6676@findex REGISTER_NAMES
6677@item REGISTER_NAMES
6678A C initializer containing the assembler's names for the machine
6679registers, each one as a C string constant.  This is what translates
6680register numbers in the compiler into assembler language.
6681
6682@findex ADDITIONAL_REGISTER_NAMES
6683@item ADDITIONAL_REGISTER_NAMES
6684If defined, a C initializer for an array of structures containing a name
6685and a register number.  This macro defines additional names for hard
6686registers, thus allowing the @code{asm} option in declarations to refer
6687to registers using alternate names.
6688
6689@findex ASM_OUTPUT_OPCODE
6690@item ASM_OUTPUT_OPCODE (@var{stream}, @var{ptr})
6691Define this macro if you are using an unusual assembler that
6692requires different names for the machine instructions.
6693
6694The definition is a C statement or statements which output an
6695assembler instruction opcode to the stdio stream @var{stream}.  The
6696macro-operand @var{ptr} is a variable of type @code{char *} which
6697points to the opcode name in its ``internal'' form---the form that is
6698written in the machine description.  The definition should output the
6699opcode name to @var{stream}, performing any translation you desire, and
6700increment the variable @var{ptr} to point at the end of the opcode
6701so that it will not be output twice.
6702
6703In fact, your macro definition may process less than the entire opcode
6704name, or more than the opcode name; but if you want to process text
6705that includes @samp{%}-sequences to substitute operands, you must take
6706care of the substitution yourself.  Just be sure to increment
6707@var{ptr} over whatever text should not be output normally.
6708
6709@findex recog_data.operand
6710If you need to look at the operand values, they can be found as the
6711elements of @code{recog_data.operand}.
6712
6713If the macro definition does nothing, the instruction is output
6714in the usual way.
6715
6716@findex FINAL_PRESCAN_INSN
6717@item FINAL_PRESCAN_INSN (@var{insn}, @var{opvec}, @var{noperands})
6718If defined, a C statement to be executed just prior to the output of
6719assembler code for @var{insn}, to modify the extracted operands so
6720they will be output differently.
6721
6722Here the argument @var{opvec} is the vector containing the operands
6723extracted from @var{insn}, and @var{noperands} is the number of
6724elements of the vector which contain meaningful data for this insn.
6725The contents of this vector are what will be used to convert the insn
6726template into assembler code, so you can change the assembler output
6727by changing the contents of the vector.
6728
6729This macro is useful when various assembler syntaxes share a single
6730file of instruction patterns; by defining this macro differently, you
6731can cause a large class of instructions to be output differently (such
6732as with rearranged operands).  Naturally, variations in assembler
6733syntax affecting individual insn patterns ought to be handled by
6734writing conditional output routines in those patterns.
6735
6736If this macro is not defined, it is equivalent to a null statement.
6737
6738@findex FINAL_PRESCAN_LABEL
6739@item FINAL_PRESCAN_LABEL
6740If defined, @code{FINAL_PRESCAN_INSN} will be called on each
6741@code{CODE_LABEL}.  In that case, @var{opvec} will be a null pointer and
6742@var{noperands} will be zero.
6743
6744@findex PRINT_OPERAND
6745@item PRINT_OPERAND (@var{stream}, @var{x}, @var{code})
6746A C compound statement to output to stdio stream @var{stream} the
6747assembler syntax for an instruction operand @var{x}.  @var{x} is an
6748RTL expression.
6749
6750@var{code} is a value that can be used to specify one of several ways
6751of printing the operand.  It is used when identical operands must be
6752printed differently depending on the context.  @var{code} comes from
6753the @samp{%} specification that was used to request printing of the
6754operand.  If the specification was just @samp{%@var{digit}} then
6755@var{code} is 0; if the specification was @samp{%@var{ltr}
6756@var{digit}} then @var{code} is the ASCII code for @var{ltr}.
6757
6758@findex reg_names
6759If @var{x} is a register, this macro should print the register's name.
6760The names can be found in an array @code{reg_names} whose type is
6761@code{char *[]}.  @code{reg_names} is initialized from
6762@code{REGISTER_NAMES}.
6763
6764When the machine description has a specification @samp{%@var{punct}}
6765(a @samp{%} followed by a punctuation character), this macro is called
6766with a null pointer for @var{x} and the punctuation character for
6767@var{code}.
6768
6769@findex PRINT_OPERAND_PUNCT_VALID_P
6770@item PRINT_OPERAND_PUNCT_VALID_P (@var{code})
6771A C expression which evaluates to true if @var{code} is a valid
6772punctuation character for use in the @code{PRINT_OPERAND} macro.  If
6773@code{PRINT_OPERAND_PUNCT_VALID_P} is not defined, it means that no
6774punctuation characters (except for the standard one, @samp{%}) are used
6775in this way.
6776
6777@findex PRINT_OPERAND_ADDRESS
6778@item PRINT_OPERAND_ADDRESS (@var{stream}, @var{x})
6779A C compound statement to output to stdio stream @var{stream} the
6780assembler syntax for an instruction operand that is a memory reference
6781whose address is @var{x}.  @var{x} is an RTL expression.
6782
6783@cindex @code{ENCODE_SECTION_INFO} usage
6784On some machines, the syntax for a symbolic address depends on the
6785section that the address refers to.  On these machines, define the macro
6786@code{ENCODE_SECTION_INFO} to store the information into the
6787@code{symbol_ref}, and then check for it here.  @xref{Assembler Format}.
6788
6789@findex DBR_OUTPUT_SEQEND
6790@findex dbr_sequence_length
6791@item DBR_OUTPUT_SEQEND(@var{file})
6792A C statement, to be executed after all slot-filler instructions have
6793been output.  If necessary, call @code{dbr_sequence_length} to
6794determine the number of slots filled in a sequence (zero if not
6795currently outputting a sequence), to decide how many no-ops to output,
6796or whatever.
6797
6798Don't define this macro if it has nothing to do, but it is helpful in
6799reading assembly output if the extent of the delay sequence is made
6800explicit (e.g.@: with white space).
6801
6802@findex final_sequence
6803Note that output routines for instructions with delay slots must be
6804prepared to deal with not being output as part of a sequence
6805(i.e.@: when the scheduling pass is not run, or when no slot fillers could be
6806found.)  The variable @code{final_sequence} is null when not
6807processing a sequence, otherwise it contains the @code{sequence} rtx
6808being output.
6809
6810@findex REGISTER_PREFIX
6811@findex LOCAL_LABEL_PREFIX
6812@findex USER_LABEL_PREFIX
6813@findex IMMEDIATE_PREFIX
6814@findex asm_fprintf
6815@item REGISTER_PREFIX
6816@itemx LOCAL_LABEL_PREFIX
6817@itemx USER_LABEL_PREFIX
6818@itemx IMMEDIATE_PREFIX
6819If defined, C string expressions to be used for the @samp{%R}, @samp{%L},
6820@samp{%U}, and @samp{%I} options of @code{asm_fprintf} (see
6821@file{final.c}).  These are useful when a single @file{md} file must
6822support multiple assembler formats.  In that case, the various @file{tm.h}
6823files can define these macros differently.
6824
6825@item ASM_FPRINTF_EXTENSIONS(@var{file}, @var{argptr}, @var{format})
6826@findex ASM_FPRINTF_EXTENSIONS
6827If defined this macro should expand to a series of @code{case}
6828statements which will be parsed inside the @code{switch} statement of
6829the @code{asm_fprintf} function.  This allows targets to define extra
6830printf formats which may useful when generating their assembler
6831statements.  Note that upper case letters are reserved for future
6832generic extensions to asm_fprintf, and so are not available to target
6833specific code.  The output file is given by the parameter @var{file}.
6834The varargs input pointer is @var{argptr} and the rest of the format
6835string, starting the character after the one that is being switched
6836upon, is pointed to by @var{format}.
6837
6838@findex ASSEMBLER_DIALECT
6839@item ASSEMBLER_DIALECT
6840If your target supports multiple dialects of assembler language (such as
6841different opcodes), define this macro as a C expression that gives the
6842numeric index of the assembler language dialect to use, with zero as the
6843first variant.
6844
6845If this macro is defined, you may use constructs of the form
6846@smallexample
6847@samp{@{option0|option1|option2@dots{}@}} 
6848@end smallexample
6849@noindent
6850in the output templates of patterns (@pxref{Output Template}) or in the
6851first argument of @code{asm_fprintf}.  This construct outputs
6852@samp{option0}, @samp{option1}, @samp{option2}, etc., if the value of
6853@code{ASSEMBLER_DIALECT} is zero, one, two, etc.  Any special characters
6854within these strings retain their usual meaning.  If there are fewer
6855alternatives within the braces than the value of
6856@code{ASSEMBLER_DIALECT}, the construct outputs nothing.
6857
6858If you do not define this macro, the characters @samp{@{}, @samp{|} and
6859@samp{@}} do not have any special meaning when used in templates or
6860operands to @code{asm_fprintf}.
6861
6862Define the macros @code{REGISTER_PREFIX}, @code{LOCAL_LABEL_PREFIX},
6863@code{USER_LABEL_PREFIX} and @code{IMMEDIATE_PREFIX} if you can express
6864the variations in assembler language syntax with that mechanism.  Define
6865@code{ASSEMBLER_DIALECT} and use the @samp{@{option0|option1@}} syntax
6866if the syntax variant are larger and involve such things as different
6867opcodes or operand order.
6868
6869@findex ASM_OUTPUT_REG_PUSH
6870@item ASM_OUTPUT_REG_PUSH (@var{stream}, @var{regno})
6871A C expression to output to @var{stream} some assembler code
6872which will push hard register number @var{regno} onto the stack.
6873The code need not be optimal, since this macro is used only when
6874profiling.
6875
6876@findex ASM_OUTPUT_REG_POP
6877@item ASM_OUTPUT_REG_POP (@var{stream}, @var{regno})
6878A C expression to output to @var{stream} some assembler code
6879which will pop hard register number @var{regno} off of the stack.
6880The code need not be optimal, since this macro is used only when
6881profiling.
6882@end table
6883
6884@node Dispatch Tables
6885@subsection Output of Dispatch Tables
6886
6887@c prevent bad page break with this line
6888This concerns dispatch tables.
6889
6890@table @code
6891@cindex dispatch table
6892@findex ASM_OUTPUT_ADDR_DIFF_ELT
6893@item ASM_OUTPUT_ADDR_DIFF_ELT (@var{stream}, @var{body}, @var{value}, @var{rel})
6894A C statement to output to the stdio stream @var{stream} an assembler
6895pseudo-instruction to generate a difference between two labels.
6896@var{value} and @var{rel} are the numbers of two internal labels.  The
6897definitions of these labels are output using
6898@code{ASM_OUTPUT_INTERNAL_LABEL}, and they must be printed in the same
6899way here.  For example,
6900
6901@example
6902fprintf (@var{stream}, "\t.word L%d-L%d\n",
6903         @var{value}, @var{rel})
6904@end example
6905
6906You must provide this macro on machines where the addresses in a
6907dispatch table are relative to the table's own address.  If defined, GCC
6908will also use this macro on all machines when producing PIC@.
6909@var{body} is the body of the @code{ADDR_DIFF_VEC}; it is provided so that the
6910mode and flags can be read.
6911
6912@findex ASM_OUTPUT_ADDR_VEC_ELT
6913@item ASM_OUTPUT_ADDR_VEC_ELT (@var{stream}, @var{value})
6914This macro should be provided on machines where the addresses
6915in a dispatch table are absolute.
6916
6917The definition should be a C statement to output to the stdio stream
6918@var{stream} an assembler pseudo-instruction to generate a reference to
6919a label.  @var{value} is the number of an internal label whose
6920definition is output using @code{ASM_OUTPUT_INTERNAL_LABEL}.
6921For example,
6922
6923@example
6924fprintf (@var{stream}, "\t.word L%d\n", @var{value})
6925@end example
6926
6927@findex ASM_OUTPUT_CASE_LABEL
6928@item ASM_OUTPUT_CASE_LABEL (@var{stream}, @var{prefix}, @var{num}, @var{table})
6929Define this if the label before a jump-table needs to be output
6930specially.  The first three arguments are the same as for
6931@code{ASM_OUTPUT_INTERNAL_LABEL}; the fourth argument is the
6932jump-table which follows (a @code{jump_insn} containing an
6933@code{addr_vec} or @code{addr_diff_vec}).
6934
6935This feature is used on system V to output a @code{swbeg} statement
6936for the table.
6937
6938If this macro is not defined, these labels are output with
6939@code{ASM_OUTPUT_INTERNAL_LABEL}.
6940
6941@findex ASM_OUTPUT_CASE_END
6942@item ASM_OUTPUT_CASE_END (@var{stream}, @var{num}, @var{table})
6943Define this if something special must be output at the end of a
6944jump-table.  The definition should be a C statement to be executed
6945after the assembler code for the table is written.  It should write
6946the appropriate code to stdio stream @var{stream}.  The argument
6947@var{table} is the jump-table insn, and @var{num} is the label-number
6948of the preceding label.
6949
6950If this macro is not defined, nothing special is output at the end of
6951the jump-table.
6952@end table
6953
6954@node Exception Region Output
6955@subsection Assembler Commands for Exception Regions
6956
6957@c prevent bad page break with this line
6958
6959This describes commands marking the start and the end of an exception
6960region.
6961
6962@table @code
6963@findex EH_FRAME_SECTION_NAME
6964@item EH_FRAME_SECTION_NAME
6965If defined, a C string constant for the name of the section containing
6966exception handling frame unwind information.  If not defined, GCC will
6967provide a default definition if the target supports named sections.
6968@file{crtstuff.c} uses this macro to switch to the appropriate section.
6969
6970You should define this symbol if your target supports DWARF 2 frame
6971unwind information and the default definition does not work.
6972
6973@findex EH_FRAME_IN_DATA_SECTION
6974@item EH_FRAME_IN_DATA_SECTION
6975If defined, DWARF 2 frame unwind information will be placed in the
6976data section even though the target supports named sections.  This
6977might be necessary, for instance, if the system linker does garbage
6978collection and sections cannot be marked as not to be collected.
6979
6980Do not define this macro unless @code{TARGET_ASM_NAMED_SECTION} is
6981also defined.
6982
6983@findex MASK_RETURN_ADDR
6984@item MASK_RETURN_ADDR
6985An rtx used to mask the return address found via @code{RETURN_ADDR_RTX}, so
6986that it does not contain any extraneous set bits in it.
6987
6988@findex DWARF2_UNWIND_INFO
6989@item DWARF2_UNWIND_INFO
6990Define this macro to 0 if your target supports DWARF 2 frame unwind
6991information, but it does not yet work with exception handling.
6992Otherwise, if your target supports this information (if it defines
6993@samp{INCOMING_RETURN_ADDR_RTX} and either @samp{UNALIGNED_INT_ASM_OP}
6994or @samp{OBJECT_FORMAT_ELF}), GCC will provide a default definition of
69951.
6996
6997If this macro is defined to 1, the DWARF 2 unwinder will be the default
6998exception handling mechanism; otherwise, @code{setjmp}/@code{longjmp} will be used by
6999default.
7000
7001If this macro is defined to anything, the DWARF 2 unwinder will be used
7002instead of inline unwinders and @code{__unwind_function} in the non-@code{setjmp} case.
7003
7004@findex DWARF_CIE_DATA_ALIGNMENT
7005@item DWARF_CIE_DATA_ALIGNMENT
7006This macro need only be defined if the target might save registers in the
7007function prologue at an offset to the stack pointer that is not aligned to
7008@code{UNITS_PER_WORD}.  The definition should be the negative minimum
7009alignment if @code{STACK_GROWS_DOWNWARD} is defined, and the positive
7010minimum alignment otherwise.  @xref{SDB and DWARF}.  Only applicable if
7011the target supports DWARF 2 frame unwind information.
7012
7013@end table
7014
7015@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_EXCEPTION_SECTION ()
7016If defined, a function that switches to the section in which the main
7017exception table is to be placed (@pxref{Sections}).  The default is a
7018function that switches to a section named @code{.gcc_except_table} on
7019machines that support named sections via
7020@code{TARGET_ASM_NAMED_SECTION}, otherwise if @option{-fpic} or
7021@option{-fPIC} is in effect, the @code{data_section}, otherwise the
7022@code{readonly_data_section}.
7023@end deftypefn
7024
7025@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_EH_FRAME_SECTION ()
7026If defined, a function that switches to the section in which the DWARF 2
7027frame unwind information to be placed (@pxref{Sections}).  The default
7028is a function that outputs a standard GAS section directive, if
7029@code{EH_FRAME_SECTION_NAME} is defined, or else a data section
7030directive followed by a synthetic label.
7031@end deftypefn
7032
7033@node Alignment Output
7034@subsection Assembler Commands for Alignment
7035
7036@c prevent bad page break with this line
7037This describes commands for alignment.
7038
7039@table @code
7040@findex JUMP_ALIGN
7041@item JUMP_ALIGN (@var{label})
7042The alignment (log base 2) to put in front of @var{label}, which is
7043a common destination of jumps and has no fallthru incoming edge.
7044
7045This macro need not be defined if you don't want any special alignment
7046to be done at such a time.  Most machine descriptions do not currently
7047define the macro.
7048
7049Unless it's necessary to inspect the @var{label} parameter, it is better
7050to set the variable @var{align_jumps} in the target's
7051@code{OVERRIDE_OPTIONS}.  Otherwise, you should try to honor the user's
7052selection in @var{align_jumps} in a @code{JUMP_ALIGN} implementation.
7053
7054@findex LABEL_ALIGN_AFTER_BARRIER
7055@item LABEL_ALIGN_AFTER_BARRIER (@var{label})
7056The alignment (log base 2) to put in front of @var{label}, which follows
7057a @code{BARRIER}.
7058
7059This macro need not be defined if you don't want any special alignment
7060to be done at such a time.  Most machine descriptions do not currently
7061define the macro.
7062
7063@findex LABEL_ALIGN_AFTER_BARRIER_MAX_SKIP
7064@item LABEL_ALIGN_AFTER_BARRIER_MAX_SKIP
7065The maximum number of bytes to skip when applying
7066@code{LABEL_ALIGN_AFTER_BARRIER}.  This works only if
7067@code{ASM_OUTPUT_MAX_SKIP_ALIGN} is defined.
7068
7069@findex LOOP_ALIGN
7070@item LOOP_ALIGN (@var{label})
7071The alignment (log base 2) to put in front of @var{label}, which follows
7072a @code{NOTE_INSN_LOOP_BEG} note.
7073
7074This macro need not be defined if you don't want any special alignment
7075to be done at such a time.  Most machine descriptions do not currently
7076define the macro.
7077
7078Unless it's necessary to inspect the @var{label} parameter, it is better
7079to set the variable @code{align_loops} in the target's
7080@code{OVERRIDE_OPTIONS}.  Otherwise, you should try to honor the user's
7081selection in @code{align_loops} in a @code{LOOP_ALIGN} implementation.
7082
7083@findex LOOP_ALIGN_MAX_SKIP
7084@item LOOP_ALIGN_MAX_SKIP
7085The maximum number of bytes to skip when applying @code{LOOP_ALIGN}.
7086This works only if @code{ASM_OUTPUT_MAX_SKIP_ALIGN} is defined.
7087
7088@findex LABEL_ALIGN
7089@item LABEL_ALIGN (@var{label})
7090The alignment (log base 2) to put in front of @var{label}.
7091If @code{LABEL_ALIGN_AFTER_BARRIER} / @code{LOOP_ALIGN} specify a different alignment,
7092the maximum of the specified values is used.
7093
7094Unless it's necessary to inspect the @var{label} parameter, it is better
7095to set the variable @code{align_labels} in the target's
7096@code{OVERRIDE_OPTIONS}.  Otherwise, you should try to honor the user's
7097selection in @code{align_labels} in a @code{LABEL_ALIGN} implementation.
7098
7099@findex LABEL_ALIGN_MAX_SKIP
7100@item LABEL_ALIGN_MAX_SKIP
7101The maximum number of bytes to skip when applying @code{LABEL_ALIGN}.
7102This works only if @code{ASM_OUTPUT_MAX_SKIP_ALIGN} is defined.
7103
7104@findex ASM_OUTPUT_SKIP
7105@item ASM_OUTPUT_SKIP (@var{stream}, @var{nbytes})
7106A C statement to output to the stdio stream @var{stream} an assembler
7107instruction to advance the location counter by @var{nbytes} bytes.
7108Those bytes should be zero when loaded.  @var{nbytes} will be a C
7109expression of type @code{int}.
7110
7111@findex ASM_NO_SKIP_IN_TEXT
7112@item ASM_NO_SKIP_IN_TEXT
7113Define this macro if @code{ASM_OUTPUT_SKIP} should not be used in the
7114text section because it fails to put zeros in the bytes that are skipped.
7115This is true on many Unix systems, where the pseudo--op to skip bytes
7116produces no-op instructions rather than zeros when used in the text
7117section.
7118
7119@findex ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGN
7120@item ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGN (@var{stream}, @var{power})
7121A C statement to output to the stdio stream @var{stream} an assembler
7122command to advance the location counter to a multiple of 2 to the
7123@var{power} bytes.  @var{power} will be a C expression of type @code{int}.
7124
7125@findex ASM_OUTPUT_MAX_SKIP_ALIGN
7126@item ASM_OUTPUT_MAX_SKIP_ALIGN (@var{stream}, @var{power}, @var{max_skip})
7127A C statement to output to the stdio stream @var{stream} an assembler
7128command to advance the location counter to a multiple of 2 to the
7129@var{power} bytes, but only if @var{max_skip} or fewer bytes are needed to
7130satisfy the alignment request.  @var{power} and @var{max_skip} will be
7131a C expression of type @code{int}.
7132@end table
7133
7134@need 3000
7135@node Debugging Info
7136@section Controlling Debugging Information Format
7137
7138@c prevent bad page break with this line
7139This describes how to specify debugging information.
7140
7141@menu
7142* All Debuggers::      Macros that affect all debugging formats uniformly.
7143* DBX Options::        Macros enabling specific options in DBX format.
7144* DBX Hooks::          Hook macros for varying DBX format.
7145* File Names and DBX:: Macros controlling output of file names in DBX format.
7146* SDB and DWARF::      Macros for SDB (COFF) and DWARF formats.
7147* VMS Debug::          Macros for VMS debug format.
7148@end menu
7149
7150@node All Debuggers
7151@subsection Macros Affecting All Debugging Formats
7152
7153@c prevent bad page break with this line
7154These macros affect all debugging formats.
7155
7156@table @code
7157@findex DBX_REGISTER_NUMBER
7158@item DBX_REGISTER_NUMBER (@var{regno})
7159A C expression that returns the DBX register number for the compiler
7160register number @var{regno}.  In the default macro provided, the value
7161of this expression will be @var{regno} itself.  But sometimes there are
7162some registers that the compiler knows about and DBX does not, or vice
7163versa.  In such cases, some register may need to have one number in the
7164compiler and another for DBX@.
7165
7166If two registers have consecutive numbers inside GCC, and they can be
7167used as a pair to hold a multiword value, then they @emph{must} have
7168consecutive numbers after renumbering with @code{DBX_REGISTER_NUMBER}.
7169Otherwise, debuggers will be unable to access such a pair, because they
7170expect register pairs to be consecutive in their own numbering scheme.
7171
7172If you find yourself defining @code{DBX_REGISTER_NUMBER} in way that
7173does not preserve register pairs, then what you must do instead is
7174redefine the actual register numbering scheme.
7175
7176@findex DEBUGGER_AUTO_OFFSET
7177@item DEBUGGER_AUTO_OFFSET (@var{x})
7178A C expression that returns the integer offset value for an automatic
7179variable having address @var{x} (an RTL expression).  The default
7180computation assumes that @var{x} is based on the frame-pointer and
7181gives the offset from the frame-pointer.  This is required for targets
7182that produce debugging output for DBX or COFF-style debugging output
7183for SDB and allow the frame-pointer to be eliminated when the
7184@option{-g} options is used.
7185
7186@findex DEBUGGER_ARG_OFFSET
7187@item DEBUGGER_ARG_OFFSET (@var{offset}, @var{x})
7188A C expression that returns the integer offset value for an argument
7189having address @var{x} (an RTL expression).  The nominal offset is
7190@var{offset}.
7191
7192@findex PREFERRED_DEBUGGING_TYPE
7193@item PREFERRED_DEBUGGING_TYPE
7194A C expression that returns the type of debugging output GCC should
7195produce when the user specifies just @option{-g}.  Define
7196this if you have arranged for GCC to support more than one format of
7197debugging output.  Currently, the allowable values are @code{DBX_DEBUG},
7198@code{SDB_DEBUG}, @code{DWARF_DEBUG}, @code{DWARF2_DEBUG},
7199@code{XCOFF_DEBUG}, @code{VMS_DEBUG}, and @code{VMS_AND_DWARF2_DEBUG}.
7200
7201When the user specifies @option{-ggdb}, GCC normally also uses the
7202value of this macro to select the debugging output format, but with two
7203exceptions.  If @code{DWARF2_DEBUGGING_INFO} is defined and
7204@code{LINKER_DOES_NOT_WORK_WITH_DWARF2} is not defined, GCC uses the
7205value @code{DWARF2_DEBUG}.  Otherwise, if @code{DBX_DEBUGGING_INFO} is
7206defined, GCC uses @code{DBX_DEBUG}.
7207
7208The value of this macro only affects the default debugging output; the
7209user can always get a specific type of output by using @option{-gstabs},
7210@option{-gcoff}, @option{-gdwarf-1}, @option{-gdwarf-2}, @option{-gxcoff},
7211or @option{-gvms}.
7212@end table
7213
7214@node DBX Options
7215@subsection Specific Options for DBX Output
7216
7217@c prevent bad page break with this line
7218These are specific options for DBX output.
7219
7220@table @code
7221@findex DBX_DEBUGGING_INFO
7222@item DBX_DEBUGGING_INFO
7223Define this macro if GCC should produce debugging output for DBX
7224in response to the @option{-g} option.
7225
7226@findex XCOFF_DEBUGGING_INFO
7227@item XCOFF_DEBUGGING_INFO
7228Define this macro if GCC should produce XCOFF format debugging output
7229in response to the @option{-g} option.  This is a variant of DBX format.
7230
7231@findex DEFAULT_GDB_EXTENSIONS
7232@item DEFAULT_GDB_EXTENSIONS
7233Define this macro to control whether GCC should by default generate
7234GDB's extended version of DBX debugging information (assuming DBX-format
7235debugging information is enabled at all).  If you don't define the
7236macro, the default is 1: always generate the extended information
7237if there is any occasion to.
7238
7239@findex DEBUG_SYMS_TEXT
7240@item DEBUG_SYMS_TEXT
7241Define this macro if all @code{.stabs} commands should be output while
7242in the text section.
7243
7244@findex ASM_STABS_OP
7245@item ASM_STABS_OP
7246A C string constant, including spacing, naming the assembler pseudo op to
7247use instead of @code{"\t.stabs\t"} to define an ordinary debugging symbol.
7248If you don't define this macro, @code{"\t.stabs\t"} is used.  This macro
7249applies only to DBX debugging information format.
7250
7251@findex ASM_STABD_OP
7252@item ASM_STABD_OP
7253A C string constant, including spacing, naming the assembler pseudo op to
7254use instead of @code{"\t.stabd\t"} to define a debugging symbol whose
7255value is the current location.  If you don't define this macro,
7256@code{"\t.stabd\t"} is used.  This macro applies only to DBX debugging
7257information format.
7258
7259@findex ASM_STABN_OP
7260@item ASM_STABN_OP
7261A C string constant, including spacing, naming the assembler pseudo op to
7262use instead of @code{"\t.stabn\t"} to define a debugging symbol with no
7263name.  If you don't define this macro, @code{"\t.stabn\t"} is used.  This
7264macro applies only to DBX debugging information format.
7265
7266@findex DBX_NO_XREFS
7267@item DBX_NO_XREFS
7268Define this macro if DBX on your system does not support the construct
7269@samp{xs@var{tagname}}.  On some systems, this construct is used to
7270describe a forward reference to a structure named @var{tagname}.
7271On other systems, this construct is not supported at all.
7272
7273@findex DBX_CONTIN_LENGTH
7274@item DBX_CONTIN_LENGTH
7275A symbol name in DBX-format debugging information is normally
7276continued (split into two separate @code{.stabs} directives) when it
7277exceeds a certain length (by default, 80 characters).  On some
7278operating systems, DBX requires this splitting; on others, splitting
7279must not be done.  You can inhibit splitting by defining this macro
7280with the value zero.  You can override the default splitting-length by
7281defining this macro as an expression for the length you desire.
7282
7283@findex DBX_CONTIN_CHAR
7284@item DBX_CONTIN_CHAR
7285Normally continuation is indicated by adding a @samp{\} character to
7286the end of a @code{.stabs} string when a continuation follows.  To use
7287a different character instead, define this macro as a character
7288constant for the character you want to use.  Do not define this macro
7289if backslash is correct for your system.
7290
7291@findex DBX_STATIC_STAB_DATA_SECTION
7292@item DBX_STATIC_STAB_DATA_SECTION
7293Define this macro if it is necessary to go to the data section before
7294outputting the @samp{.stabs} pseudo-op for a non-global static
7295variable.
7296
7297@findex DBX_TYPE_DECL_STABS_CODE
7298@item DBX_TYPE_DECL_STABS_CODE
7299The value to use in the ``code'' field of the @code{.stabs} directive
7300for a typedef.  The default is @code{N_LSYM}.
7301
7302@findex DBX_STATIC_CONST_VAR_CODE
7303@item DBX_STATIC_CONST_VAR_CODE
7304The value to use in the ``code'' field of the @code{.stabs} directive
7305for a static variable located in the text section.  DBX format does not
7306provide any ``right'' way to do this.  The default is @code{N_FUN}.
7307
7308@findex DBX_REGPARM_STABS_CODE
7309@item DBX_REGPARM_STABS_CODE
7310The value to use in the ``code'' field of the @code{.stabs} directive
7311for a parameter passed in registers.  DBX format does not provide any
7312``right'' way to do this.  The default is @code{N_RSYM}.
7313
7314@findex DBX_REGPARM_STABS_LETTER
7315@item DBX_REGPARM_STABS_LETTER
7316The letter to use in DBX symbol data to identify a symbol as a parameter
7317passed in registers.  DBX format does not customarily provide any way to
7318do this.  The default is @code{'P'}.
7319
7320@findex DBX_MEMPARM_STABS_LETTER
7321@item DBX_MEMPARM_STABS_LETTER
7322The letter to use in DBX symbol data to identify a symbol as a stack
7323parameter.  The default is @code{'p'}.
7324
7325@findex DBX_FUNCTION_FIRST
7326@item DBX_FUNCTION_FIRST
7327Define this macro if the DBX information for a function and its
7328arguments should precede the assembler code for the function.  Normally,
7329in DBX format, the debugging information entirely follows the assembler
7330code.
7331
7332@findex DBX_LBRAC_FIRST
7333@item DBX_LBRAC_FIRST
7334Define this macro if the @code{N_LBRAC} symbol for a block should
7335precede the debugging information for variables and functions defined in
7336that block.  Normally, in DBX format, the @code{N_LBRAC} symbol comes
7337first.
7338
7339@findex DBX_BLOCKS_FUNCTION_RELATIVE
7340@item DBX_BLOCKS_FUNCTION_RELATIVE
7341Define this macro if the value of a symbol describing the scope of a
7342block (@code{N_LBRAC} or @code{N_RBRAC}) should be relative to the start
7343of the enclosing function.  Normally, GCC uses an absolute address.
7344
7345@findex DBX_USE_BINCL
7346@item DBX_USE_BINCL
7347Define this macro if GCC should generate @code{N_BINCL} and
7348@code{N_EINCL} stabs for included header files, as on Sun systems.  This
7349macro also directs GCC to output a type number as a pair of a file
7350number and a type number within the file.  Normally, GCC does not
7351generate @code{N_BINCL} or @code{N_EINCL} stabs, and it outputs a single
7352number for a type number.
7353@end table
7354
7355@node DBX Hooks
7356@subsection Open-Ended Hooks for DBX Format
7357
7358@c prevent bad page break with this line
7359These are hooks for DBX format.
7360
7361@table @code
7362@findex DBX_OUTPUT_LBRAC
7363@item DBX_OUTPUT_LBRAC (@var{stream}, @var{name})
7364Define this macro to say how to output to @var{stream} the debugging
7365information for the start of a scope level for variable names.  The
7366argument @var{name} is the name of an assembler symbol (for use with
7367@code{assemble_name}) whose value is the address where the scope begins.
7368
7369@findex DBX_OUTPUT_RBRAC
7370@item DBX_OUTPUT_RBRAC (@var{stream}, @var{name})
7371Like @code{DBX_OUTPUT_LBRAC}, but for the end of a scope level.
7372
7373@findex DBX_OUTPUT_ENUM
7374@item DBX_OUTPUT_ENUM (@var{stream}, @var{type})
7375Define this macro if the target machine requires special handling to
7376output an enumeration type.  The definition should be a C statement
7377(sans semicolon) to output the appropriate information to @var{stream}
7378for the type @var{type}.
7379
7380@findex DBX_OUTPUT_FUNCTION_END
7381@item DBX_OUTPUT_FUNCTION_END (@var{stream}, @var{function})
7382Define this macro if the target machine requires special output at the
7383end of the debugging information for a function.  The definition should
7384be a C statement (sans semicolon) to output the appropriate information
7385to @var{stream}.  @var{function} is the @code{FUNCTION_DECL} node for
7386the function.
7387
7388@findex DBX_OUTPUT_STANDARD_TYPES
7389@item DBX_OUTPUT_STANDARD_TYPES (@var{syms})
7390Define this macro if you need to control the order of output of the
7391standard data types at the beginning of compilation.  The argument
7392@var{syms} is a @code{tree} which is a chain of all the predefined
7393global symbols, including names of data types.
7394
7395Normally, DBX output starts with definitions of the types for integers
7396and characters, followed by all the other predefined types of the
7397particular language in no particular order.
7398
7399On some machines, it is necessary to output different particular types
7400first.  To do this, define @code{DBX_OUTPUT_STANDARD_TYPES} to output
7401those symbols in the necessary order.  Any predefined types that you
7402don't explicitly output will be output afterward in no particular order.
7403
7404Be careful not to define this macro so that it works only for C@.  There
7405are no global variables to access most of the built-in types, because
7406another language may have another set of types.  The way to output a
7407particular type is to look through @var{syms} to see if you can find it.
7408Here is an example:
7409
7410@smallexample
7411@{
7412  tree decl;
7413  for (decl = syms; decl; decl = TREE_CHAIN (decl))
7414    if (!strcmp (IDENTIFIER_POINTER (DECL_NAME (decl)),
7415                 "long int"))
7416      dbxout_symbol (decl);
7417  @dots{}
7418@}
7419@end smallexample
7420
7421@noindent
7422This does nothing if the expected type does not exist.
7423
7424See the function @code{init_decl_processing} in @file{c-decl.c} to find
7425the names to use for all the built-in C types.
7426
7427Here is another way of finding a particular type:
7428
7429@c this is still overfull.  --mew 10feb93
7430@smallexample
7431@{
7432  tree decl;
7433  for (decl = syms; decl; decl = TREE_CHAIN (decl))
7434    if (TREE_CODE (decl) == TYPE_DECL
7435        && (TREE_CODE (TREE_TYPE (decl))
7436            == INTEGER_CST)
7437        && TYPE_PRECISION (TREE_TYPE (decl)) == 16
7438        && TYPE_UNSIGNED (TREE_TYPE (decl)))
7439@group
7440      /* @r{This must be @code{unsigned short}.}  */
7441      dbxout_symbol (decl);
7442  @dots{}
7443@}
7444@end group
7445@end smallexample
7446
7447@findex NO_DBX_FUNCTION_END
7448@item NO_DBX_FUNCTION_END
7449Some stabs encapsulation formats (in particular ECOFF), cannot handle the
7450@code{.stabs "",N_FUN,,0,0,Lscope-function-1} gdb dbx extension construct.
7451On those machines, define this macro to turn this feature off without
7452disturbing the rest of the gdb extensions.
7453
7454@end table
7455
7456@node File Names and DBX
7457@subsection File Names in DBX Format
7458
7459@c prevent bad page break with this line
7460This describes file names in DBX format.
7461
7462@table @code
7463@findex DBX_WORKING_DIRECTORY
7464@item DBX_WORKING_DIRECTORY
7465Define this if DBX wants to have the current directory recorded in each
7466object file.
7467
7468Note that the working directory is always recorded if GDB extensions are
7469enabled.
7470
7471@findex DBX_OUTPUT_MAIN_SOURCE_FILENAME
7472@item DBX_OUTPUT_MAIN_SOURCE_FILENAME (@var{stream}, @var{name})
7473A C statement to output DBX debugging information to the stdio stream
7474@var{stream} which indicates that file @var{name} is the main source
7475file---the file specified as the input file for compilation.
7476This macro is called only once, at the beginning of compilation.
7477
7478This macro need not be defined if the standard form of output
7479for DBX debugging information is appropriate.
7480
7481@findex DBX_OUTPUT_MAIN_SOURCE_DIRECTORY
7482@item DBX_OUTPUT_MAIN_SOURCE_DIRECTORY (@var{stream}, @var{name})
7483A C statement to output DBX debugging information to the stdio stream
7484@var{stream} which indicates that the current directory during
7485compilation is named @var{name}.
7486
7487This macro need not be defined if the standard form of output
7488for DBX debugging information is appropriate.
7489
7490@findex DBX_OUTPUT_MAIN_SOURCE_FILE_END
7491@item DBX_OUTPUT_MAIN_SOURCE_FILE_END (@var{stream}, @var{name})
7492A C statement to output DBX debugging information at the end of
7493compilation of the main source file @var{name}.
7494
7495If you don't define this macro, nothing special is output at the end
7496of compilation, which is correct for most machines.
7497
7498@findex DBX_OUTPUT_SOURCE_FILENAME
7499@item DBX_OUTPUT_SOURCE_FILENAME (@var{stream}, @var{name})
7500A C statement to output DBX debugging information to the stdio stream
7501@var{stream} which indicates that file @var{name} is the current source
7502file.  This output is generated each time input shifts to a different
7503source file as a result of @samp{#include}, the end of an included file,
7504or a @samp{#line} command.
7505
7506This macro need not be defined if the standard form of output
7507for DBX debugging information is appropriate.
7508@end table
7509
7510@need 2000
7511@node SDB and DWARF
7512@subsection Macros for SDB and DWARF Output
7513
7514@c prevent bad page break with this line
7515Here are macros for SDB and DWARF output.
7516
7517@table @code
7518@findex SDB_DEBUGGING_INFO
7519@item SDB_DEBUGGING_INFO
7520Define this macro if GCC should produce COFF-style debugging output
7521for SDB in response to the @option{-g} option.
7522
7523@findex DWARF_DEBUGGING_INFO
7524@item DWARF_DEBUGGING_INFO
7525Define this macro if GCC should produce dwarf format debugging output
7526in response to the @option{-g} option.
7527
7528@findex DWARF2_DEBUGGING_INFO
7529@item DWARF2_DEBUGGING_INFO
7530Define this macro if GCC should produce dwarf version 2 format
7531debugging output in response to the @option{-g} option.
7532
7533To support optional call frame debugging information, you must also
7534define @code{INCOMING_RETURN_ADDR_RTX} and either set
7535@code{RTX_FRAME_RELATED_P} on the prologue insns if you use RTL for the
7536prologue, or call @code{dwarf2out_def_cfa} and @code{dwarf2out_reg_save}
7537as appropriate from @code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_PROLOGUE} if you don't.
7538
7539@findex DWARF2_FRAME_INFO
7540@item DWARF2_FRAME_INFO
7541Define this macro to a nonzero value if GCC should always output
7542Dwarf 2 frame information.  If @code{DWARF2_UNWIND_INFO}
7543(@pxref{Exception Region Output} is nonzero, GCC will output this
7544information not matter how you define @code{DWARF2_FRAME_INFO}.
7545
7546@findex LINKER_DOES_NOT_WORK_WITH_DWARF2
7547@item LINKER_DOES_NOT_WORK_WITH_DWARF2
7548Define this macro if the linker does not work with Dwarf version 2.
7549Normally, if the user specifies only @option{-ggdb} GCC will use Dwarf
7550version 2 if available; this macro disables this.  See the description
7551of the @code{PREFERRED_DEBUGGING_TYPE} macro for more details.
7552
7553@findex DWARF2_GENERATE_TEXT_SECTION_LABEL
7554@item DWARF2_GENERATE_TEXT_SECTION_LABEL
7555By default, the Dwarf 2 debugging information generator will generate a
7556label to mark the beginning of the text section.  If it is better simply
7557to use the name of the text section itself, rather than an explicit label,
7558to indicate the beginning of the text section, define this macro to zero.
7559
7560@findex DWARF2_ASM_LINE_DEBUG_INFO
7561@item DWARF2_ASM_LINE_DEBUG_INFO
7562Define this macro to be a nonzero value if the assembler can generate Dwarf 2
7563line debug info sections.  This will result in much more compact line number
7564tables, and hence is desirable if it works.
7565
7566@findex PUT_SDB_@dots{}
7567@item PUT_SDB_@dots{}
7568Define these macros to override the assembler syntax for the special
7569SDB assembler directives.  See @file{sdbout.c} for a list of these
7570macros and their arguments.  If the standard syntax is used, you need
7571not define them yourself.
7572
7573@findex SDB_DELIM
7574@item SDB_DELIM
7575Some assemblers do not support a semicolon as a delimiter, even between
7576SDB assembler directives.  In that case, define this macro to be the
7577delimiter to use (usually @samp{\n}).  It is not necessary to define
7578a new set of @code{PUT_SDB_@var{op}} macros if this is the only change
7579required.
7580
7581@findex SDB_GENERATE_FAKE
7582@item SDB_GENERATE_FAKE
7583Define this macro to override the usual method of constructing a dummy
7584name for anonymous structure and union types.  See @file{sdbout.c} for
7585more information.
7586
7587@findex SDB_ALLOW_UNKNOWN_REFERENCES
7588@item SDB_ALLOW_UNKNOWN_REFERENCES
7589Define this macro to allow references to unknown structure,
7590union, or enumeration tags to be emitted.  Standard COFF does not
7591allow handling of unknown references, MIPS ECOFF has support for
7592it.
7593
7594@findex SDB_ALLOW_FORWARD_REFERENCES
7595@item SDB_ALLOW_FORWARD_REFERENCES
7596Define this macro to allow references to structure, union, or
7597enumeration tags that have not yet been seen to be handled.  Some
7598assemblers choke if forward tags are used, while some require it.
7599@end table
7600
7601@need 2000
7602@node VMS Debug
7603@subsection Macros for VMS Debug Format
7604
7605@c prevent bad page break with this line
7606Here are macros for VMS debug format.
7607
7608@table @code
7609@findex VMS_DEBUGGING_INFO
7610@item VMS_DEBUGGING_INFO
7611Define this macro if GCC should produce debugging output for VMS
7612in response to the @option{-g} option.  The default behavior for VMS
7613is to generate minimal debug info for a traceback in the absence of
7614@option{-g} unless explicitly overridden with @option{-g0}.  This
7615behavior is controlled by @code{OPTIMIZATION_OPTIONS} and
7616@code{OVERRIDE_OPTIONS}.
7617@end table
7618
7619@node Cross-compilation
7620@section Cross Compilation and Floating Point
7621@cindex cross compilation and floating point
7622@cindex floating point and cross compilation
7623
7624While all modern machines use 2's complement representation for integers,
7625there are a variety of representations for floating point numbers.  This
7626means that in a cross-compiler the representation of floating point numbers
7627in the compiled program may be different from that used in the machine
7628doing the compilation.
7629
7630@findex atof
7631Because different representation systems may offer different amounts of
7632range and precision, the cross compiler cannot safely use the host
7633machine's floating point arithmetic.  Therefore, floating point constants
7634must be represented in the target machine's format.  This means that the
7635cross compiler cannot use @code{atof} to parse a floating point constant;
7636it must have its own special routine to use instead.  Also, constant
7637folding must emulate the target machine's arithmetic (or must not be done
7638at all).
7639
7640The macros in the following table should be defined only if you are cross
7641compiling between different floating point formats.
7642
7643Otherwise, don't define them.  Then default definitions will be set up which
7644use @code{double} as the data type, @code{==} to test for equality, etc.
7645
7646You don't need to worry about how many times you use an operand of any
7647of these macros.  The compiler never uses operands which have side effects.
7648
7649@table @code
7650@findex REAL_VALUE_TYPE
7651@item REAL_VALUE_TYPE
7652A macro for the C data type to be used to hold a floating point value
7653in the target machine's format.  Typically this would be a
7654@code{struct} containing an array of @code{int}.
7655
7656@findex REAL_VALUES_EQUAL
7657@item REAL_VALUES_EQUAL (@var{x}, @var{y})
7658A macro for a C expression which compares for equality the two values,
7659@var{x} and @var{y}, both of type @code{REAL_VALUE_TYPE}.
7660
7661@findex REAL_VALUES_LESS
7662@item REAL_VALUES_LESS (@var{x}, @var{y})
7663A macro for a C expression which tests whether @var{x} is less than
7664@var{y}, both values being of type @code{REAL_VALUE_TYPE} and
7665interpreted as floating point numbers in the target machine's
7666representation.
7667
7668@findex REAL_VALUE_LDEXP
7669@findex ldexp
7670@item REAL_VALUE_LDEXP (@var{x}, @var{scale})
7671A macro for a C expression which performs the standard library
7672function @code{ldexp}, but using the target machine's floating point
7673representation.  Both @var{x} and the value of the expression have
7674type @code{REAL_VALUE_TYPE}.  The second argument, @var{scale}, is an
7675integer.
7676
7677@findex REAL_VALUE_FIX
7678@item REAL_VALUE_FIX (@var{x})
7679A macro whose definition is a C expression to convert the target-machine
7680floating point value @var{x} to a signed integer.  @var{x} has type
7681@code{REAL_VALUE_TYPE}.
7682
7683@findex REAL_VALUE_UNSIGNED_FIX
7684@item REAL_VALUE_UNSIGNED_FIX (@var{x})
7685A macro whose definition is a C expression to convert the target-machine
7686floating point value @var{x} to an unsigned integer.  @var{x} has type
7687@code{REAL_VALUE_TYPE}.
7688
7689@findex REAL_VALUE_RNDZINT
7690@item REAL_VALUE_RNDZINT (@var{x})
7691A macro whose definition is a C expression to round the target-machine
7692floating point value @var{x} towards zero to an integer value (but still
7693as a floating point number).  @var{x} has type @code{REAL_VALUE_TYPE},
7694and so does the value.
7695
7696@findex REAL_VALUE_UNSIGNED_RNDZINT
7697@item REAL_VALUE_UNSIGNED_RNDZINT (@var{x})
7698A macro whose definition is a C expression to round the target-machine
7699floating point value @var{x} towards zero to an unsigned integer value
7700(but still represented as a floating point number).  @var{x} has type
7701@code{REAL_VALUE_TYPE}, and so does the value.
7702
7703@findex REAL_VALUE_ATOF
7704@item REAL_VALUE_ATOF (@var{string}, @var{mode})
7705A macro for a C expression which converts @var{string}, an expression of
7706type @code{char *}, into a floating point number in the target machine's
7707representation for mode @var{mode}.  The value has type
7708@code{REAL_VALUE_TYPE}.
7709
7710@findex REAL_INFINITY
7711@item REAL_INFINITY
7712Define this macro if infinity is a possible floating point value, and
7713therefore division by 0 is legitimate.
7714
7715@findex REAL_VALUE_ISINF
7716@findex isinf
7717@item REAL_VALUE_ISINF (@var{x})
7718A macro for a C expression which determines whether @var{x}, a floating
7719point value, is infinity.  The value has type @code{int}.
7720By default, this is defined to call @code{isinf}.
7721
7722@findex REAL_VALUE_ISNAN
7723@findex isnan
7724@item REAL_VALUE_ISNAN (@var{x})
7725A macro for a C expression which determines whether @var{x}, a floating
7726point value, is a ``nan'' (not-a-number).  The value has type
7727@code{int}.  By default, this is defined to call @code{isnan}.
7728@end table
7729
7730@cindex constant folding and floating point
7731Define the following additional macros if you want to make floating
7732point constant folding work while cross compiling.  If you don't
7733define them, cross compilation is still possible, but constant folding
7734will not happen for floating point values.
7735
7736@table @code
7737@findex REAL_ARITHMETIC
7738@item REAL_ARITHMETIC (@var{output}, @var{code}, @var{x}, @var{y})
7739A macro for a C statement which calculates an arithmetic operation of
7740the two floating point values @var{x} and @var{y}, both of type
7741@code{REAL_VALUE_TYPE} in the target machine's representation, to
7742produce a result of the same type and representation which is stored
7743in @var{output} (which will be a variable).
7744
7745The operation to be performed is specified by @var{code}, a tree code
7746which will always be one of the following: @code{PLUS_EXPR},
7747@code{MINUS_EXPR}, @code{MULT_EXPR}, @code{RDIV_EXPR},
7748@code{MAX_EXPR}, @code{MIN_EXPR}.
7749
7750@cindex overflow while constant folding
7751The expansion of this macro is responsible for checking for overflow.
7752If overflow happens, the macro expansion should execute the statement
7753@code{return 0;}, which indicates the inability to perform the
7754arithmetic operation requested.
7755
7756@findex REAL_VALUE_NEGATE
7757@item REAL_VALUE_NEGATE (@var{x})
7758A macro for a C expression which returns the negative of the floating
7759point value @var{x}.  Both @var{x} and the value of the expression
7760have type @code{REAL_VALUE_TYPE} and are in the target machine's
7761floating point representation.
7762
7763There is no way for this macro to report overflow, since overflow
7764can't happen in the negation operation.
7765
7766@findex REAL_VALUE_TRUNCATE
7767@item REAL_VALUE_TRUNCATE (@var{mode}, @var{x})
7768A macro for a C expression which converts the floating point value
7769@var{x} to mode @var{mode}.
7770
7771Both @var{x} and the value of the expression are in the target machine's
7772floating point representation and have type @code{REAL_VALUE_TYPE}.
7773However, the value should have an appropriate bit pattern to be output
7774properly as a floating constant whose precision accords with mode
7775@var{mode}.
7776
7777There is no way for this macro to report overflow.
7778
7779@findex REAL_VALUE_TO_INT
7780@item REAL_VALUE_TO_INT (@var{low}, @var{high}, @var{x})
7781A macro for a C expression which converts a floating point value
7782@var{x} into a double-precision integer which is then stored into
7783@var{low} and @var{high}, two variables of type @var{int}.
7784
7785@item REAL_VALUE_FROM_INT (@var{x}, @var{low}, @var{high}, @var{mode})
7786@findex REAL_VALUE_FROM_INT
7787A macro for a C expression which converts a double-precision integer
7788found in @var{low} and @var{high}, two variables of type @var{int},
7789into a floating point value which is then stored into @var{x}.
7790The value is in the target machine's representation for mode @var{mode}
7791and has the type @code{REAL_VALUE_TYPE}.
7792@end table
7793
7794@node Mode Switching
7795@section Mode Switching Instructions
7796@cindex mode switching
7797The following macros control mode switching optimizations:
7798
7799@table @code
7800@findex OPTIMIZE_MODE_SWITCHING
7801@item OPTIMIZE_MODE_SWITCHING (@var{entity})
7802Define this macro if the port needs extra instructions inserted for mode
7803switching in an optimizing compilation.
7804
7805For an example, the SH4 can perform both single and double precision
7806floating point operations, but to perform a single precision operation,
7807the FPSCR PR bit has to be cleared, while for a double precision
7808operation, this bit has to be set.  Changing the PR bit requires a general
7809purpose register as a scratch register, hence these FPSCR sets have to
7810be inserted before reload, i.e.@: you can't put this into instruction emitting
7811or @code{MACHINE_DEPENDENT_REORG}.
7812
7813You can have multiple entities that are mode-switched, and select at run time
7814which entities actually need it.  @code{OPTIMIZE_MODE_SWITCHING} should
7815return nonzero for any @var{entity} that needs mode-switching.
7816If you define this macro, you also have to define
7817@code{NUM_MODES_FOR_MODE_SWITCHING}, @code{MODE_NEEDED},
7818@code{MODE_PRIORITY_TO_MODE} and @code{EMIT_MODE_SET}.
7819@code{NORMAL_MODE} is optional.
7820
7821@findex NUM_MODES_FOR_MODE_SWITCHING
7822@item NUM_MODES_FOR_MODE_SWITCHING
7823If you define @code{OPTIMIZE_MODE_SWITCHING}, you have to define this as
7824initializer for an array of integers.  Each initializer element
7825N refers to an entity that needs mode switching, and specifies the number
7826of different modes that might need to be set for this entity.
7827The position of the initializer in the initializer - starting counting at
7828zero - determines the integer that is used to refer to the mode-switched
7829entity in question.
7830In macros that take mode arguments / yield a mode result, modes are
7831represented as numbers 0 @dots{} N @minus{} 1.  N is used to specify that no mode
7832switch is needed / supplied.
7833
7834@findex MODE_NEEDED
7835@item MODE_NEEDED (@var{entity}, @var{insn})
7836@var{entity} is an integer specifying a mode-switched entity.  If
7837@code{OPTIMIZE_MODE_SWITCHING} is defined, you must define this macro to
7838return an integer value not larger than the corresponding element in
7839@code{NUM_MODES_FOR_MODE_SWITCHING}, to denote the mode that @var{entity} must
7840be switched into prior to the execution of @var{insn}.
7841
7842@findex NORMAL_MODE
7843@item NORMAL_MODE (@var{entity})
7844If this macro is defined, it is evaluated for every @var{entity} that needs
7845mode switching.  It should evaluate to an integer, which is a mode that
7846@var{entity} is assumed to be switched to at function entry and exit.
7847
7848@findex MODE_PRIORITY_TO_MODE
7849@item MODE_PRIORITY_TO_MODE (@var{entity}, @var{n})
7850This macro specifies the order in which modes for @var{entity} are processed.
78510 is the highest priority, @code{NUM_MODES_FOR_MODE_SWITCHING[@var{entity}] - 1} the
7852lowest.  The value of the macro should be an integer designating a mode
7853for @var{entity}.  For any fixed @var{entity}, @code{mode_priority_to_mode}
7854(@var{entity}, @var{n}) shall be a bijection in 0 @dots{}
7855@code{num_modes_for_mode_switching[@var{entity}] - 1}.
7856
7857@findex EMIT_MODE_SET
7858@item EMIT_MODE_SET (@var{entity}, @var{mode}, @var{hard_regs_live})
7859Generate one or more insns to set @var{entity} to @var{mode}.
7860@var{hard_reg_live} is the set of hard registers live at the point where
7861the insn(s) are to be inserted.
7862@end table
7863
7864@node Target Attributes
7865@section Defining target-specific uses of @code{__attribute__}
7866@cindex target attributes
7867@cindex machine attributes
7868@cindex attributes, target-specific
7869
7870Target-specific attributes may be defined for functions, data and types.
7871These are described using the following target hooks; they also need to
7872be documented in @file{extend.texi}.
7873
7874@deftypevr {Target Hook} {const struct attribute_spec *} TARGET_ATTRIBUTE_TABLE
7875If defined, this target hook points to an array of @samp{struct
7876attribute_spec} (defined in @file{tree.h}) specifying the machine
7877specific attributes for this target and some of the restrictions on the
7878entities to which these attributes are applied and the arguments they
7879take.
7880@end deftypevr
7881
7882@deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_COMP_TYPE_ATTRIBUTES (tree @var{type1}, tree @var{type2})
7883If defined, this target hook is a function which returns zero if the attributes on
7884@var{type1} and @var{type2} are incompatible, one if they are compatible,
7885and two if they are nearly compatible (which causes a warning to be
7886generated).  If this is not defined, machine-specific attributes are
7887supposed always to be compatible.
7888@end deftypefn
7889
7890@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SET_DEFAULT_TYPE_ATTRIBUTES (tree @var{type})
7891If defined, this target hook is a function which assigns default attributes to
7892newly defined @var{type}.
7893@end deftypefn
7894
7895@deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_MERGE_TYPE_ATTRIBUTES (tree @var{type1}, tree @var{type2})
7896Define this target hook if the merging of type attributes needs special
7897handling.  If defined, the result is a list of the combined
7898@code{TYPE_ATTRIBUTES} of @var{type1} and @var{type2}.  It is assumed
7899that @code{comptypes} has already been called and returned 1.  This
7900function may call @code{merge_attributes} to handle machine-independent
7901merging.
7902@end deftypefn
7903
7904@deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_MERGE_DECL_ATTRIBUTES (tree @var{olddecl}, tree @var{newdecl})
7905Define this target hook if the merging of decl attributes needs special
7906handling.  If defined, the result is a list of the combined
7907@code{DECL_ATTRIBUTES} of @var{olddecl} and @var{newdecl}.
7908@var{newdecl} is a duplicate declaration of @var{olddecl}.  Examples of
7909when this is needed are when one attribute overrides another, or when an
7910attribute is nullified by a subsequent definition.  This function may
7911call @code{merge_attributes} to handle machine-independent merging.
7912
7913@findex TARGET_DLLIMPORT_DECL_ATTRIBUTES
7914If the only target-specific handling you require is @samp{dllimport} for
7915Windows targets, you should define the macro
7916@code{TARGET_DLLIMPORT_DECL_ATTRIBUTES}.  This links in a function
7917called @code{merge_dllimport_decl_attributes} which can then be defined
7918as the expansion of @code{TARGET_MERGE_DECL_ATTRIBUTES}.  This is done
7919in @file{i386/cygwin.h} and @file{i386/i386.c}, for example.
7920@end deftypefn
7921
7922@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_INSERT_ATTRIBUTES (tree @var{node}, tree *@var{attr_ptr})
7923Define this target hook if you want to be able to add attributes to a decl
7924when it is being created.  This is normally useful for back ends which
7925wish to implement a pragma by using the attributes which correspond to
7926the pragma's effect.  The @var{node} argument is the decl which is being
7927created.  The @var{attr_ptr} argument is a pointer to the attribute list
7928for this decl.  The list itself should not be modified, since it may be
7929shared with other decls, but attributes may be chained on the head of
7930the list and @code{*@var{attr_ptr}} modified to point to the new
7931attributes, or a copy of the list may be made if further changes are
7932needed.
7933@end deftypefn
7934
7935@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_FUNCTION_ATTRIBUTE_INLINABLE_P (tree @var{fndecl})
7936@cindex inlining
7937This target hook returns @code{true} if it is ok to inline @var{fndecl}
7938into the current function, despite its having target-specific
7939attributes, @code{false} otherwise.  By default, if a function has a
7940target specific attribute attached to it, it will not be inlined.
7941@end deftypefn
7942
7943@node Misc
7944@section Miscellaneous Parameters
7945@cindex parameters, miscellaneous
7946
7947@c prevent bad page break with this line
7948Here are several miscellaneous parameters.
7949
7950@table @code
7951@item PREDICATE_CODES
7952@findex PREDICATE_CODES
7953Define this if you have defined special-purpose predicates in the file
7954@file{@var{machine}.c}.  This macro is called within an initializer of an
7955array of structures.  The first field in the structure is the name of a
7956predicate and the second field is an array of rtl codes.  For each
7957predicate, list all rtl codes that can be in expressions matched by the
7958predicate.  The list should have a trailing comma.  Here is an example
7959of two entries in the list for a typical RISC machine:
7960
7961@smallexample
7962#define PREDICATE_CODES \
7963  @{"gen_reg_rtx_operand", @{SUBREG, REG@}@},  \
7964  @{"reg_or_short_cint_operand", @{SUBREG, REG, CONST_INT@}@},
7965@end smallexample
7966
7967Defining this macro does not affect the generated code (however,
7968incorrect definitions that omit an rtl code that may be matched by the
7969predicate can cause the compiler to malfunction).  Instead, it allows
7970the table built by @file{genrecog} to be more compact and efficient,
7971thus speeding up the compiler.  The most important predicates to include
7972in the list specified by this macro are those used in the most insn
7973patterns.
7974
7975For each predicate function named in @code{PREDICATE_CODES}, a
7976declaration will be generated in @file{insn-codes.h}.
7977
7978@item SPECIAL_MODE_PREDICATES
7979@findex SPECIAL_MODE_PREDICATES
7980Define this if you have special predicates that know special things
7981about modes.  Genrecog will warn about certain forms of
7982@code{match_operand} without a mode; if the operand predicate is
7983listed in @code{SPECIAL_MODE_PREDICATES}, the warning will be
7984suppressed.
7985
7986Here is an example from the IA-32 port (@code{ext_register_operand}
7987specially checks for @code{HImode} or @code{SImode} in preparation
7988for a byte extraction from @code{%ah} etc.).
7989
7990@smallexample
7991#define SPECIAL_MODE_PREDICATES \
7992  "ext_register_operand",
7993@end smallexample
7994
7995@findex CASE_VECTOR_MODE
7996@item CASE_VECTOR_MODE
7997An alias for a machine mode name.  This is the machine mode that
7998elements of a jump-table should have.
7999
8000@findex CASE_VECTOR_SHORTEN_MODE
8001@item CASE_VECTOR_SHORTEN_MODE (@var{min_offset}, @var{max_offset}, @var{body})
8002Optional: return the preferred mode for an @code{addr_diff_vec}
8003when the minimum and maximum offset are known.  If you define this,
8004it enables extra code in branch shortening to deal with @code{addr_diff_vec}.
8005To make this work, you also have to define INSN_ALIGN and
8006make the alignment for @code{addr_diff_vec} explicit.
8007The @var{body} argument is provided so that the offset_unsigned and scale
8008flags can be updated.
8009
8010@findex CASE_VECTOR_PC_RELATIVE
8011@item CASE_VECTOR_PC_RELATIVE
8012Define this macro to be a C expression to indicate when jump-tables
8013should contain relative addresses.  If jump-tables never contain
8014relative addresses, then you need not define this macro.
8015
8016@findex CASE_DROPS_THROUGH
8017@item CASE_DROPS_THROUGH
8018Define this if control falls through a @code{case} insn when the index
8019value is out of range.  This means the specified default-label is
8020actually ignored by the @code{case} insn proper.
8021
8022@findex CASE_VALUES_THRESHOLD
8023@item CASE_VALUES_THRESHOLD
8024Define this to be the smallest number of different values for which it
8025is best to use a jump-table instead of a tree of conditional branches.
8026The default is four for machines with a @code{casesi} instruction and
8027five otherwise.  This is best for most machines.
8028
8029@findex WORD_REGISTER_OPERATIONS
8030@item WORD_REGISTER_OPERATIONS
8031Define this macro if operations between registers with integral mode
8032smaller than a word are always performed on the entire register.
8033Most RISC machines have this property and most CISC machines do not.
8034
8035@findex LOAD_EXTEND_OP
8036@item LOAD_EXTEND_OP (@var{mode})
8037Define this macro to be a C expression indicating when insns that read
8038memory in @var{mode}, an integral mode narrower than a word, set the
8039bits outside of @var{mode} to be either the sign-extension or the
8040zero-extension of the data read.  Return @code{SIGN_EXTEND} for values
8041of @var{mode} for which the
8042insn sign-extends, @code{ZERO_EXTEND} for which it zero-extends, and
8043@code{NIL} for other modes.
8044
8045This macro is not called with @var{mode} non-integral or with a width
8046greater than or equal to @code{BITS_PER_WORD}, so you may return any
8047value in this case.  Do not define this macro if it would always return
8048@code{NIL}.  On machines where this macro is defined, you will normally
8049define it as the constant @code{SIGN_EXTEND} or @code{ZERO_EXTEND}.
8050
8051@findex SHORT_IMMEDIATES_SIGN_EXTEND
8052@item SHORT_IMMEDIATES_SIGN_EXTEND
8053Define this macro if loading short immediate values into registers sign
8054extends.
8055
8056@findex FIXUNS_TRUNC_LIKE_FIX_TRUNC
8057@item FIXUNS_TRUNC_LIKE_FIX_TRUNC
8058Define this macro if the same instructions that convert a floating
8059point number to a signed fixed point number also convert validly to an
8060unsigned one.
8061
8062@findex MOVE_MAX
8063@item MOVE_MAX
8064The maximum number of bytes that a single instruction can move quickly
8065between memory and registers or between two memory locations.
8066
8067@findex MAX_MOVE_MAX
8068@item MAX_MOVE_MAX
8069The maximum number of bytes that a single instruction can move quickly
8070between memory and registers or between two memory locations.  If this
8071is undefined, the default is @code{MOVE_MAX}.  Otherwise, it is the
8072constant value that is the largest value that @code{MOVE_MAX} can have
8073at run-time.
8074
8075@findex SHIFT_COUNT_TRUNCATED
8076@item SHIFT_COUNT_TRUNCATED
8077A C expression that is nonzero if on this machine the number of bits
8078actually used for the count of a shift operation is equal to the number
8079of bits needed to represent the size of the object being shifted.  When
8080this macro is nonzero, the compiler will assume that it is safe to omit
8081a sign-extend, zero-extend, and certain bitwise `and' instructions that
8082truncates the count of a shift operation.  On machines that have
8083instructions that act on bit-fields at variable positions, which may
8084include `bit test' instructions, a nonzero @code{SHIFT_COUNT_TRUNCATED}
8085also enables deletion of truncations of the values that serve as
8086arguments to bit-field instructions.
8087
8088If both types of instructions truncate the count (for shifts) and
8089position (for bit-field operations), or if no variable-position bit-field
8090instructions exist, you should define this macro.
8091
8092However, on some machines, such as the 80386 and the 680x0, truncation
8093only applies to shift operations and not the (real or pretended)
8094bit-field operations.  Define @code{SHIFT_COUNT_TRUNCATED} to be zero on
8095such machines.  Instead, add patterns to the @file{md} file that include
8096the implied truncation of the shift instructions.
8097
8098You need not define this macro if it would always have the value of zero.
8099
8100@findex TRULY_NOOP_TRUNCATION
8101@item TRULY_NOOP_TRUNCATION (@var{outprec}, @var{inprec})
8102A C expression which is nonzero if on this machine it is safe to
8103``convert'' an integer of @var{inprec} bits to one of @var{outprec}
8104bits (where @var{outprec} is smaller than @var{inprec}) by merely
8105operating on it as if it had only @var{outprec} bits.
8106
8107On many machines, this expression can be 1.
8108
8109@c rearranged this, removed the phrase "it is reported that".  this was
8110@c to fix an overfull hbox.  --mew 10feb93
8111When @code{TRULY_NOOP_TRUNCATION} returns 1 for a pair of sizes for
8112modes for which @code{MODES_TIEABLE_P} is 0, suboptimal code can result.
8113If this is the case, making @code{TRULY_NOOP_TRUNCATION} return 0 in
8114such cases may improve things.
8115
8116@findex STORE_FLAG_VALUE
8117@item STORE_FLAG_VALUE
8118A C expression describing the value returned by a comparison operator
8119with an integral mode and stored by a store-flag instruction
8120(@samp{s@var{cond}}) when the condition is true.  This description must
8121apply to @emph{all} the @samp{s@var{cond}} patterns and all the
8122comparison operators whose results have a @code{MODE_INT} mode.
8123
8124A value of 1 or @minus{}1 means that the instruction implementing the
8125comparison operator returns exactly 1 or @minus{}1 when the comparison is true
8126and 0 when the comparison is false.  Otherwise, the value indicates
8127which bits of the result are guaranteed to be 1 when the comparison is
8128true.  This value is interpreted in the mode of the comparison
8129operation, which is given by the mode of the first operand in the
8130@samp{s@var{cond}} pattern.  Either the low bit or the sign bit of
8131@code{STORE_FLAG_VALUE} be on.  Presently, only those bits are used by
8132the compiler.
8133
8134If @code{STORE_FLAG_VALUE} is neither 1 or @minus{}1, the compiler will
8135generate code that depends only on the specified bits.  It can also
8136replace comparison operators with equivalent operations if they cause
8137the required bits to be set, even if the remaining bits are undefined.
8138For example, on a machine whose comparison operators return an
8139@code{SImode} value and where @code{STORE_FLAG_VALUE} is defined as
8140@samp{0x80000000}, saying that just the sign bit is relevant, the
8141expression
8142
8143@smallexample
8144(ne:SI (and:SI @var{x} (const_int @var{power-of-2})) (const_int 0))
8145@end smallexample
8146
8147@noindent
8148can be converted to
8149
8150@smallexample
8151(ashift:SI @var{x} (const_int @var{n}))
8152@end smallexample
8153
8154@noindent
8155where @var{n} is the appropriate shift count to move the bit being
8156tested into the sign bit.
8157
8158There is no way to describe a machine that always sets the low-order bit
8159for a true value, but does not guarantee the value of any other bits,
8160but we do not know of any machine that has such an instruction.  If you
8161are trying to port GCC to such a machine, include an instruction to
8162perform a logical-and of the result with 1 in the pattern for the
8163comparison operators and let us know at @email{gcc@@gcc.gnu.org}.
8164
8165Often, a machine will have multiple instructions that obtain a value
8166from a comparison (or the condition codes).  Here are rules to guide the
8167choice of value for @code{STORE_FLAG_VALUE}, and hence the instructions
8168to be used:
8169
8170@itemize @bullet
8171@item
8172Use the shortest sequence that yields a valid definition for
8173@code{STORE_FLAG_VALUE}.  It is more efficient for the compiler to
8174``normalize'' the value (convert it to, e.g., 1 or 0) than for the
8175comparison operators to do so because there may be opportunities to
8176combine the normalization with other operations.
8177
8178@item
8179For equal-length sequences, use a value of 1 or @minus{}1, with @minus{}1 being
8180slightly preferred on machines with expensive jumps and 1 preferred on
8181other machines.
8182
8183@item
8184As a second choice, choose a value of @samp{0x80000001} if instructions
8185exist that set both the sign and low-order bits but do not define the
8186others.
8187
8188@item
8189Otherwise, use a value of @samp{0x80000000}.
8190@end itemize
8191
8192Many machines can produce both the value chosen for
8193@code{STORE_FLAG_VALUE} and its negation in the same number of
8194instructions.  On those machines, you should also define a pattern for
8195those cases, e.g., one matching
8196
8197@smallexample
8198(set @var{A} (neg:@var{m} (ne:@var{m} @var{B} @var{C})))
8199@end smallexample
8200
8201Some machines can also perform @code{and} or @code{plus} operations on
8202condition code values with less instructions than the corresponding
8203@samp{s@var{cond}} insn followed by @code{and} or @code{plus}.  On those
8204machines, define the appropriate patterns.  Use the names @code{incscc}
8205and @code{decscc}, respectively, for the patterns which perform
8206@code{plus} or @code{minus} operations on condition code values.  See
8207@file{rs6000.md} for some examples.  The GNU Superoptizer can be used to
8208find such instruction sequences on other machines.
8209
8210You need not define @code{STORE_FLAG_VALUE} if the machine has no store-flag
8211instructions.
8212
8213@findex FLOAT_STORE_FLAG_VALUE
8214@item FLOAT_STORE_FLAG_VALUE (@var{mode})
8215A C expression that gives a nonzero @code{REAL_VALUE_TYPE} value that is
8216returned when comparison operators with floating-point results are true.
8217Define this macro on machine that have comparison operations that return
8218floating-point values.  If there are no such operations, do not define
8219this macro.
8220
8221@findex Pmode
8222@item Pmode
8223An alias for the machine mode for pointers.  On most machines, define
8224this to be the integer mode corresponding to the width of a hardware
8225pointer; @code{SImode} on 32-bit machine or @code{DImode} on 64-bit machines.
8226On some machines you must define this to be one of the partial integer
8227modes, such as @code{PSImode}.
8228
8229The width of @code{Pmode} must be at least as large as the value of
8230@code{POINTER_SIZE}.  If it is not equal, you must define the macro
8231@code{POINTERS_EXTEND_UNSIGNED} to specify how pointers are extended
8232to @code{Pmode}.
8233
8234@findex FUNCTION_MODE
8235@item FUNCTION_MODE
8236An alias for the machine mode used for memory references to functions
8237being called, in @code{call} RTL expressions.  On most machines this
8238should be @code{QImode}.
8239
8240@findex INTEGRATE_THRESHOLD
8241@item INTEGRATE_THRESHOLD (@var{decl})
8242A C expression for the maximum number of instructions above which the
8243function @var{decl} should not be inlined.  @var{decl} is a
8244@code{FUNCTION_DECL} node.
8245
8246The default definition of this macro is 64 plus 8 times the number of
8247arguments that the function accepts.  Some people think a larger
8248threshold should be used on RISC machines.
8249
8250@findex STDC_0_IN_SYSTEM_HEADERS
8251@item STDC_0_IN_SYSTEM_HEADERS
8252In normal operation, the preprocessor expands @code{__STDC__} to the
8253constant 1, to signify that GCC conforms to ISO Standard C@.  On some
8254hosts, like Solaris, the system compiler uses a different convention,
8255where @code{__STDC__} is normally 0, but is 1 if the user specifies
8256strict conformance to the C Standard.
8257
8258Defining @code{STDC_0_IN_SYSTEM_HEADERS} makes GNU CPP follows the host
8259convention when processing system header files, but when processing user
8260files @code{__STDC__} will always expand to 1.
8261
8262@findex SCCS_DIRECTIVE
8263@item SCCS_DIRECTIVE
8264Define this if the preprocessor should ignore @code{#sccs} directives
8265and print no error message.
8266
8267@findex NO_IMPLICIT_EXTERN_C
8268@item NO_IMPLICIT_EXTERN_C
8269Define this macro if the system header files support C++ as well as C@.
8270This macro inhibits the usual method of using system header files in
8271C++, which is to pretend that the file's contents are enclosed in
8272@samp{extern "C" @{@dots{}@}}.
8273
8274@findex HANDLE_PRAGMA
8275@item HANDLE_PRAGMA (@var{getc}, @var{ungetc}, @var{name})
8276This macro is no longer supported.  You must use
8277@code{REGISTER_TARGET_PRAGMAS} instead.
8278
8279@findex REGISTER_TARGET_PRAGMAS
8280@findex #pragma
8281@findex pragma
8282@item REGISTER_TARGET_PRAGMAS (@var{pfile})
8283Define this macro if you want to implement any target-specific pragmas.
8284If defined, it is a C expression which makes a series of calls to
8285@code{cpp_register_pragma} for each pragma, with @var{pfile} passed as
8286the first argument to to these functions.  The macro may also do any
8287setup required for the pragmas.
8288
8289The primary reason to define this macro is to provide compatibility with
8290other compilers for the same target.  In general, we discourage
8291definition of target-specific pragmas for GCC@.
8292
8293If the pragma can be implemented by attributes then you should consider
8294defining the target hook @samp{TARGET_INSERT_ATTRIBUTES} as well.
8295
8296Preprocessor macros that appear on pragma lines are not expanded.  All
8297@samp{#pragma} directives that do not match any registered pragma are
8298silently ignored, unless the user specifies @option{-Wunknown-pragmas}.
8299
8300@deftypefun void cpp_register_pragma (cpp_reader *@var{pfile}, const char *@var{space}, const char *@var{name}, void (*@var{callback}) (cpp_reader *))
8301
8302Each call to @code{cpp_register_pragma} establishes one pragma.  The
8303@var{callback} routine will be called when the preprocessor encounters a
8304pragma of the form
8305
8306@smallexample
8307#pragma [@var{space}] @var{name} @dots{}
8308@end smallexample
8309
8310@var{space} is the case-sensitive namespace of the pragma, or
8311@code{NULL} to put the pragma in the global namespace.  The callback
8312routine receives @var{pfile} as its first argument, which can be passed
8313on to cpplib's functions if necessary.  You can lex tokens after the
8314@var{name} by calling @code{c_lex}.  Tokens that are not read by the
8315callback will be silently ignored.  The end of the line is indicated by
8316a token of type @code{CPP_EOF}.
8317
8318For an example use of this routine, see @file{c4x.h} and the callback
8319routines defined in @file{c4x-c.c}.
8320
8321Note that the use of @code{c_lex} is specific to the C and C++
8322compilers.  It will not work in the Java or Fortran compilers, or any
8323other language compilers for that matter.  Thus if @code{c_lex} is going
8324to be called from target-specific code, it must only be done so when
8325building the C and C++ compilers.  This can be done by defining the
8326variables @code{c_target_objs} and @code{cxx_target_objs} in the
8327target entry in the @file{config.gcc} file.  These variables should name
8328the target-specific, language-specific object file which contains the
8329code that uses @code{c_lex}.  Note it will also be necessary to add a
8330rule to the makefile fragment pointed to by @code{tmake_file} that shows
8331how to build this object file.
8332@end deftypefun
8333
8334@findex HANDLE_SYSV_PRAGMA
8335@findex #pragma
8336@findex pragma
8337@item HANDLE_SYSV_PRAGMA
8338Define this macro (to a value of 1) if you want the System V style
8339pragmas @samp{#pragma pack(<n>)} and @samp{#pragma weak <name>
8340[=<value>]} to be supported by gcc.
8341
8342The pack pragma specifies the maximum alignment (in bytes) of fields
8343within a structure, in much the same way as the @samp{__aligned__} and
8344@samp{__packed__} @code{__attribute__}s do.  A pack value of zero resets
8345the behavior to the default.
8346
8347The weak pragma only works if @code{SUPPORTS_WEAK} and
8348@code{ASM_WEAKEN_LABEL} are defined.  If enabled it allows the creation
8349of specifically named weak labels, optionally with a value.
8350
8351@findex HANDLE_PRAGMA_PACK_PUSH_POP
8352@findex #pragma
8353@findex pragma
8354@item HANDLE_PRAGMA_PACK_PUSH_POP
8355Define this macro (to a value of 1) if you want to support the Win32
8356style pragmas @samp{#pragma pack(push,@var{n})} and @samp{#pragma
8357pack(pop)}.  The @samp{pack(push,@var{n})} pragma specifies the maximum alignment
8358(in bytes) of fields within a structure, in much the same way as the
8359@samp{__aligned__} and @samp{__packed__} @code{__attribute__}s do.  A
8360pack value of zero resets the behavior to the default.  Successive
8361invocations of this pragma cause the previous values to be stacked, so
8362that invocations of @samp{#pragma pack(pop)} will return to the previous
8363value.
8364
8365@findex DOLLARS_IN_IDENTIFIERS
8366@item DOLLARS_IN_IDENTIFIERS
8367Define this macro to control use of the character @samp{$} in identifier
8368names.  0 means @samp{$} is not allowed by default; 1 means it is allowed.
83691 is the default; there is no need to define this macro in that case.
8370This macro controls the compiler proper; it does not affect the preprocessor.
8371
8372@findex NO_DOLLAR_IN_LABEL
8373@item NO_DOLLAR_IN_LABEL
8374Define this macro if the assembler does not accept the character
8375@samp{$} in label names.  By default constructors and destructors in
8376G++ have @samp{$} in the identifiers.  If this macro is defined,
8377@samp{.} is used instead.
8378
8379@findex NO_DOT_IN_LABEL
8380@item NO_DOT_IN_LABEL
8381Define this macro if the assembler does not accept the character
8382@samp{.} in label names.  By default constructors and destructors in G++
8383have names that use @samp{.}.  If this macro is defined, these names
8384are rewritten to avoid @samp{.}.
8385
8386@findex DEFAULT_MAIN_RETURN
8387@item DEFAULT_MAIN_RETURN
8388Define this macro if the target system expects every program's @code{main}
8389function to return a standard ``success'' value by default (if no other
8390value is explicitly returned).
8391
8392The definition should be a C statement (sans semicolon) to generate the
8393appropriate rtl instructions.  It is used only when compiling the end of
8394@code{main}.
8395
8396@item NEED_ATEXIT
8397@findex NEED_ATEXIT
8398Define this if the target system lacks the function @code{atexit}
8399from the ISO C standard.  If this macro is defined, a default definition
8400will be provided to support C++.  If @code{ON_EXIT} is not defined,
8401a default @code{exit} function will also be provided.
8402
8403@item ON_EXIT
8404@findex ON_EXIT
8405Define this macro if the target has another way to implement atexit
8406functionality without replacing @code{exit}.  For instance, SunOS 4 has
8407a similar @code{on_exit} library function.
8408
8409The definition should be a functional macro which can be used just like
8410the @code{atexit} function.
8411
8412@item EXIT_BODY
8413@findex EXIT_BODY
8414Define this if your @code{exit} function needs to do something
8415besides calling an external function @code{_cleanup} before
8416terminating with @code{_exit}.  The @code{EXIT_BODY} macro is
8417only needed if @code{NEED_ATEXIT} is defined and @code{ON_EXIT} is not
8418defined.
8419
8420@findex INSN_SETS_ARE_DELAYED
8421@item INSN_SETS_ARE_DELAYED (@var{insn})
8422Define this macro as a C expression that is nonzero if it is safe for the
8423delay slot scheduler to place instructions in the delay slot of @var{insn},
8424even if they appear to use a resource set or clobbered in @var{insn}.
8425@var{insn} is always a @code{jump_insn} or an @code{insn}; GCC knows that
8426every @code{call_insn} has this behavior.  On machines where some @code{insn}
8427or @code{jump_insn} is really a function call and hence has this behavior,
8428you should define this macro.
8429
8430You need not define this macro if it would always return zero.
8431
8432@findex INSN_REFERENCES_ARE_DELAYED
8433@item INSN_REFERENCES_ARE_DELAYED (@var{insn})
8434Define this macro as a C expression that is nonzero if it is safe for the
8435delay slot scheduler to place instructions in the delay slot of @var{insn},
8436even if they appear to set or clobber a resource referenced in @var{insn}.
8437@var{insn} is always a @code{jump_insn} or an @code{insn}.  On machines where
8438some @code{insn} or @code{jump_insn} is really a function call and its operands
8439are registers whose use is actually in the subroutine it calls, you should
8440define this macro.  Doing so allows the delay slot scheduler to move
8441instructions which copy arguments into the argument registers into the delay
8442slot of @var{insn}.
8443
8444You need not define this macro if it would always return zero.
8445
8446@findex MACHINE_DEPENDENT_REORG
8447@item MACHINE_DEPENDENT_REORG (@var{insn})
8448In rare cases, correct code generation requires extra machine
8449dependent processing between the second jump optimization pass and
8450delayed branch scheduling.  On those machines, define this macro as a C
8451statement to act on the code starting at @var{insn}.
8452
8453@findex MULTIPLE_SYMBOL_SPACES
8454@item MULTIPLE_SYMBOL_SPACES
8455Define this macro if in some cases global symbols from one translation
8456unit may not be bound to undefined symbols in another translation unit
8457without user intervention.  For instance, under Microsoft Windows
8458symbols must be explicitly imported from shared libraries (DLLs).
8459
8460@findex MD_ASM_CLOBBERS
8461@item MD_ASM_CLOBBERS (@var{clobbers})
8462A C statement that adds to @var{clobbers} @code{STRING_CST} trees for
8463any hard regs the port wishes to automatically clobber for all asms.
8464
8465@findex MAX_INTEGER_COMPUTATION_MODE
8466@item MAX_INTEGER_COMPUTATION_MODE
8467Define this to the largest integer machine mode which can be used for
8468operations other than load, store and copy operations.
8469
8470You need only define this macro if the target holds values larger than
8471@code{word_mode} in general purpose registers.  Most targets should not define
8472this macro.
8473
8474@findex MATH_LIBRARY
8475@item MATH_LIBRARY
8476Define this macro as a C string constant for the linker argument to link
8477in the system math library, or @samp{""} if the target does not have a
8478separate math library.
8479
8480You need only define this macro if the default of @samp{"-lm"} is wrong.
8481
8482@findex LIBRARY_PATH_ENV
8483@item LIBRARY_PATH_ENV
8484Define this macro as a C string constant for the environment variable that
8485specifies where the linker should look for libraries.
8486
8487You need only define this macro if the default of @samp{"LIBRARY_PATH"}
8488is wrong.
8489
8490@findex TARGET_HAS_F_SETLKW
8491@item TARGET_HAS_F_SETLKW
8492Define this macro if the target supports file locking with fcntl / F_SETLKW@.
8493Note that this functionality is part of POSIX@.
8494Defining @code{TARGET_HAS_F_SETLKW} will enable the test coverage code
8495to use file locking when exiting a program, which avoids race conditions
8496if the program has forked.
8497
8498@findex MAX_CONDITIONAL_EXECUTE
8499@item MAX_CONDITIONAL_EXECUTE
8500
8501A C expression for the maximum number of instructions to execute via
8502conditional execution instructions instead of a branch.  A value of
8503@code{BRANCH_COST}+1 is the default if the machine does not use cc0, and
85041 if it does use cc0.
8505
8506@findex IFCVT_MODIFY_TESTS
8507@item IFCVT_MODIFY_TESTS
8508A C expression to modify the tests in @code{TRUE_EXPR}, and
8509@code{FALSE_EXPR} for use in converting insns in @code{TEST_BB},
8510@code{THEN_BB}, @code{ELSE_BB}, and @code{JOIN_BB} basic blocks to
8511conditional execution.  Set either @code{TRUE_EXPR} or @code{FALSE_EXPR}
8512to a null pointer if the tests cannot be converted.
8513
8514@findex IFCVT_MODIFY_INSN
8515@item IFCVT_MODIFY_INSN
8516A C expression to modify the @code{PATTERN} of an @code{INSN} that is to
8517be converted to conditional execution format.
8518
8519@findex IFCVT_MODIFY_FINAL
8520@item IFCVT_MODIFY_FINAL
8521A C expression to perform any final machine dependent modifications in
8522converting code to conditional execution in the basic blocks
8523@code{TEST_BB}, @code{THEN_BB}, @code{ELSE_BB}, and @code{JOIN_BB}.
8524
8525@findex IFCVT_MODIFY_CANCEL
8526@item IFCVT_MODIFY_CANCEL
8527A C expression to cancel any machine dependent modifications in
8528converting code to conditional execution in the basic blocks
8529@code{TEST_BB}, @code{THEN_BB}, @code{ELSE_BB}, and @code{JOIN_BB}.
8530@end table
8531
8532@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_INIT_BUILTINS ()
8533Define this hook if you have any machine-specific built-in functions
8534that need to be defined.  It should be a function that performs the
8535necessary setup.
8536
8537Machine specific built-in functions can be useful to expand special machine
8538instructions that would otherwise not normally be generated because
8539they have no equivalent in the source language (for example, SIMD vector
8540instructions or prefetch instructions).
8541
8542To create a built-in function, call the function @code{builtin_function}
8543which is defined by the language front end.  You can use any type nodes set
8544up by @code{build_common_tree_nodes} and @code{build_common_tree_nodes_2};
8545only language front ends that use those two functions will call
8546@samp{TARGET_INIT_BUILTINS}.
8547@end deftypefn
8548
8549@deftypefn {Target Hook} rtx TARGET_EXPAND_BUILTIN (tree @var{exp}, rtx @var{target}, rtx @var{subtarget}, enum machine_mode @var{mode}, int @var{ignore})
8550
8551Expand a call to a machine specific built-in function that was set up by
8552@samp{TARGET_INIT_BUILTINS}.  @var{exp} is the expression for the
8553function call; the result should go to @var{target} if that is
8554convenient, and have mode @var{mode} if that is convenient.
8555@var{subtarget} may be used as the target for computing one of
8556@var{exp}'s operands.  @var{ignore} is nonzero if the value is to be
8557ignored.  This function should return the result of the call to the
8558built-in function.
8559@end deftypefn
8560
8561@table @code
8562@findex MD_CAN_REDIRECT_BRANCH
8563@item MD_CAN_REDIRECT_BRANCH(@var{branch1}, @var{branch2})
8564
8565Take a branch insn in @var{branch1} and another in @var{branch2}.
8566Return true if redirecting @var{branch1} to the destination of
8567@var{branch2} is possible.
8568
8569On some targets, branches may have a limited range.  Optimizing the
8570filling of delay slots can result in branches being redirected, and this
8571may in turn cause a branch offset to overflow.
8572
8573@findex ALLOCATE_INITIAL_VALUE
8574@item ALLOCATE_INITIAL_VALUE(@var{hard_reg})
8575
8576When the initial value of a hard register has been copied in a pseudo
8577register, it is often not necessary to actually allocate another register
8578to this pseudo register, because the original hard register or a stack slot
8579it has been saved into can be used.  @code{ALLOCATE_INITIAL_VALUE}, if
8580defined, is called at the start of register allocation once for each
8581hard register that had its initial value copied by using
8582@code{get_func_hard_reg_initial_val} or @code{get_hard_reg_initial_val}.
8583Possible values are @code{NULL_RTX}, if you don't want
8584to do any special allocation, a @code{REG} rtx---that would typically be
8585the hard register itself, if it is known not to be clobbered---or a
8586@code{MEM}.
8587If you are returning a @code{MEM}, this is only a hint for the allocator;
8588it might decide to use another register anyways.
8589You may use @code{current_function_leaf_function} in the definition of the
8590macro, functions that use @code{REG_N_SETS}, to determine if the hard
8591register in question will not be clobbered.
8592
8593@findex TARGET_OBJECT_SUFFIX
8594@item TARGET_OBJECT_SUFFIX
8595Define this macro to be a C string representing the suffix for object
8596files on your target machine.  If you do not define this macro, GCC will
8597use @samp{.o} as the suffix for object files.
8598
8599@findex TARGET_EXECUTABLE_SUFFIX
8600@item TARGET_EXECUTABLE_SUFFIX
8601Define this macro to be a C string representing the suffix to be
8602automatically added to executable files on your target machine.  If you
8603do not define this macro, GCC will use the null string as the suffix for
8604executable files.
8605
8606@findex COLLECT_EXPORT_LIST
8607@item COLLECT_EXPORT_LIST
8608If defined, @code{collect2} will scan the individual object files
8609specified on its command line and create an export list for the linker.
8610Define this macro for systems like AIX, where the linker discards
8611object files that are not referenced from @code{main} and uses export
8612lists.
8613
8614@end table
8615